802506
376
Verklein
Vergroot
Pagina terug
1/415
Pagina verder
OWNER'S MANUAL
Operation
Maintenance
Specifications
All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time of
publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make
changes at any time without prior notice and without obligation
to incorporate such changes so that our policy of continual
product improvement may be carried out.
This manual applies to all models of this vehicle and includes
descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard
equipment. As a result, you may find material in this manual
that does not apply to your specific vehicle.
This booklet is not intended to be a substitute for the Owner’s
Manual given in QR Code provided at the backside of the cover
page.
Grand i10 NIOS / Aura
Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering
the vehicle. Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations
established by the Department of Transportation and other government
agencies in your country.
CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO YOUR HYUNDAI
Your vehicle is equipped with electronic fuel injection and other electronic
components. It is possible for an improperly installed/adjusted two-way radio
or cellular telephone to adversely affect electronic systems. For this reason,
we recommend that you carefully follow the radio manufacturer’s instructions
or consult your HYUNDAI dealer for precautionary measures or special
instructions if you choose to install one of these devices.
7:2ǘ:$<5$',225&(//8/$5
TELEPHONE INSTALLATION
This manual includes information titled as DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION and
NOTICE.
These titles indicate the following:
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in
death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE WARNING
Table of Contents
Hyundai Warranty Policy
Vehicle Information
Safety System
Instrument Cluster
Driving Your Vehicle
Driver Assistance System
Emergency Situations
Maintenance
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Convenience Features
FOREWORD
Thank you for choosing HYUNDAI. We are pleased to welcome you to the growing
number of discriminating people who drive HYUNDAI. The advanced engineering and
high-quality construction of each HYUNDAI we build is something of which we’re very
proud.
Your Owner’s Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new
HYUNDAI. It is suggested that you read it carefully because the information it contains
can contribute greatly to the satisfaction you receive from your new car.
The manufacturer also recommends that service and maintenance on your vehicle be
performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
HYUNDAI MOTOR COMPANY
Note : Because future owners will also need the information included in this manual,
if you sell this HYUNDAI, please leave the manual in the vehicle for their use.
Thank you.
CAUTION
Severe engine and transmission damage may result from the use of poor quality
fuels and lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications. You must always use
high quality fuels and lubricants that meet the specifications listed in the Vehicle
Specifications section of the Owner’s Manual.
Copyright 2023 HYUNDAI Motor Company. All rights reserved. No part of this
publication may be reproduced, stored in any retrieval system or transmitted in
any form or by any means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI Motor
Company.
Gasoline engine
Unleaded
Your new vehicle is designed to perform optimally using unleaded fuel having an
Octane Rating of RON (Research Octane Number) 91 / AKI (Anti-Knock Index) 87 or
higher. (Do not use methanol blended fuels)
Your new vehicle is designed to obtain maximum performance with UNLEADED FUEL,
as well as minimize exhaust emissions and spark plug fouling.
NOTICE
NEVER USE LEADED FUEL. The use of leaded fuel is detrimental to the catalytic
converter and will damage the engine control system’s oxygen sensor and affect
emission control.
Also, severe wear and crack of piston ring, valve, etc. may occur and knocking noise
may be heard from your engine.
Never add any fuel system cleaning agents to the fuel tank other than what has
been specified (We recommend that you consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealers
for details.)
WARNING
Do not “top off” after the nozzle automatically shuts off when refueling.
Always check that the fuel cap is installed securely to prevent fuel spillage in the
event of an accident.
Gasoline containing alcohol and
methanol
Gasohol, a mixture of gasoline and
ethanol (also known as grain alcohol),
and gasoline or gasohol containing
methanol (also known as wood alcohol)
are being marketed along with or instead
of leaded or unleaded gasoline.
Do not use gasohol containing more
than 20% ethanol, and do not use
gasoline or gasohol containing any
methanol. Either of these fuels may
cause drivability problems and damage
to the fuel system, engine control
system and emission control system.
Discontinue using gasohol of any kind if
drivability problems occur.
Vehicle damage or driveability
problems may not be covered by the
manufacturer’s warranty if they result
from the use of:
1. Gasohol containing more than 20%
ethanol.
2. Gasoline or gasohol containing
methanol.
3. Leaded fuel or leaded gasohol.
CAUTION
Never use gasohol which contains
methanol. Discontinue use of any
gasohol product which impairs
drivability.
Using Fuel Additives
Using fuel additives such as:
- Silicone fuel additive
- MMT (Manganese, Mn) fuel additive
- Ferrocene (iron-based) fuel additive
- Other metallic-based fuel additives
May result in cylinder misfire, poor
acceleration, engine stalling, engine
plugging, heavy knocking noise, damage
to the catalyst, or abnormal corrosion,
and may cause damage to the engine
resulting in a reduction in the overall
life of the powertrain. The Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) may illuminate.
NOTICE
Damage to the fuel system or
performance problem caused by the
use of these fuels may not be covered
by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Use of MTBE
HYUNDAI recommends avoiding fuels
containing MTBE (Methyl Tertiary Butyl
Ether) over 15.0% vol. (Oxygen Content
2.7% weight) in your vehicle.
Fuel containing MTBE over 15.0%
vol. (Oxygen Content 2.7% weight)
may reduce vehicle performance and
produce vapor lock or hard starting.
CAUTION
Your New Vehicle Limited Warranty
may not cover damage to the
fuel system and any performance
problems that are caused by the use
of fuels containing methanol or fuels
containing MTBE (Methyl Tertiary Butyl
Ether) over 15.0% vol. (Oxygen Content
2.7% weight.)
Do not use methanol
Fuels containing methanol (wood
alcohol) should not be used in your
vehicle. This type of fuel can reduce
vehicle performance and damage
components of the fuel system, engine
control system and emission control
system.
Fuel Additives
HYUNDAI recommends that you use
unleaded gasoline which has an Octane
Rating of RON (Research Octane
Number) 91 / AKI (Anti-Knock Index) 87
or higher.
For customers who do not use good
quality gasolines including fuel additives
regularly, and have problems starting or
the engine does not run smoothly, one
bottle of additives added to the fuel tank
at every 10,000 km.
Additives are available from your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with
information on how to use them. Do not
mix other additives.
Operation in foreign countries
If you are going to drive your vehicle in
another country, be sure to:
• Observe all regulations regarding
registration and insurance.
Determine that acceptable fuel is
available.
This vehicle should not be modified.
Modification of your vehicle could
affect its performance, safety or
durability and may even violate
governmental safety and emissions
regulations.
In addition, damage or performance
problems resulting from any
modification may not be covered
under warranty.
If you use unauthorized electronic
devices, it may cause the vehicle to
operate abnormally, wire damage,
battery discharge and fire. For your
safety, do not use unauthorized
electronic devices.
No special break-in period is needed. By
following a few simple precautions for
the first 1,000 km (600 miles), you may
add to the performance, economy and
life of your vehicle:
Do not race the engine.
While driving, avoid sudden
acceleration.
Do not maintain a single speed for
long periods of time, either fast or
slow.
Varying the engine speed is needed to
properly break-in the engine.
Avoid hard stops, except in
emergencies, to allow the brakes to
seat properly.
Fuel economy and engine
performance may vary depending
on vehicle break-in process and be
stabilized after 6,000 km (4,000
miles). New engines may consume
more oil during the vehicle break-in
period.
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS 9(+,&/(%5($.ǘ,1
PROCESS
Hyundai Warranty Policy
+\XQGDL1HZ9HKLFOH:DUUDQW\
5HSODFHPHQW3DUWV:DUUDQW\
+\XQGDL([WHQGHG:DUUDQW\
/DERXU)UHH6HUYLFHRI9HKLFOH
+\XQGDL5RDG6LGH$VVLVWDQFH
/DERXU)UHH6HUYLFH&RXSRQV
1

+\XQGDL:DUUDQW\3ROLF\
HYUNDAI NEW VEHICLE WARRANTY
+\XQGDL0RWRU,QGLD/LPLWHGKHUHLQ
DIWHU FDOOHG ŕ+0,/Ŗ ZDUUDQWV WKDW
HDFKQHZ +\XQGDLYHKLFOHVROG VKDOO
EH IUHH IURP DQ\ GHIHFWV LQ PDWHULDO
DQGZRUNPDQVKLSXQGHUQRUPDOXVH
DQGPDLQWHQDQFHVXEMHFWWRWKHIRO
ORZLQJ WHUPV DQG FRQGLWLRQV
1. Warranty Period
7KLV ZDUUDQW\ IRU K\XQGDL YHKLFOH
VKDOOH[LVWIRUDSHULRGRIPRQWKV
.PVIURPWKHGDWHRIGHOLY
HU\ZKLFKVRHYHULVHDUOLHUWRWKHILUVW
SXUFKDVHU 7KLV ZDUUDQW\ LV WUDQVIHU
DEOHWRVXEVHTXHQWRZQHUIRUWKHUH
PDLQLQJ ZDUUDQW\ SHULRG 7KLV ZDU
UDQW\ LV DSSOLFDEOH RQO\ LQ ,QGLD DQG
QRWWUDQVIHUDEOHWRDQ\RWKHUFRXQWU\
2. What is covered
([FHSW DV SURYLGHG LQ SDUDJUDSK 
KHUHRI RXU $XWKRUL]HG 'HDOHUV VKDOO
HLWKHUUHSDLURUUHSODFHDQ\+\XQGDL
JHQXLQHSDUWWKDWLVDFNQRZOHGJHGE\
+0,/ WR EH GHIHFWLYH LQ PDWHULDO RU
ZRUNPDQVKLSZLWKLQWKHZDUUDQW\SH
ULRG VWLSXODWHG DERYH DW QR FRVW WR
WKHRZQHURIWKH+\XQGDLYHKLFOHIRU
SDUWVRUODERXU6XFKGHIHFWLYHSDUWV
ZKLFK KDYH EHHQ UHSODFHG ZLOO EH
FRPHWKHSURSHUW\RI+0,/
3. What is not covered
This warranty shall not apply to:
1RUPDO PDLQWHQDQFH VHUYLFHV
RWKHU WKDQ WKH WKUHH ODERXU IUHH
VHUYLFHV LQFOXGLQJ ZLWKRXW OLP
LWDWLRQ FOHDQLQJ DQG SROLVKLQJ
PLQRU DGMXVWPHQWV HQJLQH WXQ
LQJ RLOIOXLG FKDQJHV ILOWHUV UH
SOHQLVKPHQW IDVWHQHU UHWLJKWHQ
LQJ ZKHHO EDODQFLQJ ZKHHO
DOLJQPHQW DQG W\UH URWDWLRQ HWF
5HSODFHPHQWRISDUWVDVDUHVXOW
RIQRUPDOZHDUDQGWHDUVXFKDV
VSDUN SOXJV EHOWV EUDNH SDGV
DQG OLQLQJV FOXWFK GLVFIDFLQJ
ILOWHUVZLSHUEODGHVEXOEVIXVHV
HWF
Damage or failure resulting from
1HJOLJHQFH RI SURSHU PDLQWH
QDQFHDVUHTXLUHGLQWKLV2ZQHUŔV
0DQXDODQG6HUYLFH%RRNOHW
0LVXVH DEXVH DFFLGHQW WKHIW
IORRGLQJRUILUH
8VHRILPSURSHURULQVXIILFLHQWIX
HOIOXLGVRUOXEULFDQWV
8VH RI SDUWV RWKHU WKDQ +\XQGDL
*HQXLQH3DUWV
$Q\ GHYLFH DQGRU DFFHVVRULHV
QRWVXSSOLHGE\+0,/
0RGLILFDWLRQV DOWHUDWLRQV WDP
SHULQJRULPSURSHUUHSDLU
3DUWV XVHG LQ DSSOLFDWLRQV RI
ZKLFKWKH\ZHUHQRWGHVLJQHGRU
QRWDSSURYHGE\+0,/
6OLJKW LUUHJXODULWLHV QRW UHF
RJQLVHG DV DIIHFWLQJ TXDOLW\ RU
IXQFWLRQRIWKHYHKLFOHRUSDUWV
VXFK DV VOLJKW QRLVH RU
YLEUDWLRQVRU LWHPV FRQVLGHUHG
FKDUDFWHULVWLFRIWKHYHKLFOH
$LUERUQH ŕIDOORXWŖ ,QGXVWULDOIDOO
RXW DFLG UDLQ KDLO DQG ZLQG
VWRUPVRURWKHU$FWVRI*RG
3DLQWVFUDWFKHVGHQWVRUVLPLODU
SDLQWRUERG\GDPDJH
$FWLRQ RI URDG HOHPHQWV VDQG
JUDYHOGXVWRUURDGGHEULVZKLFK
UHVXOWVLQVWRQHFKLSSLQJRISDLQW
-3
0
or glass.
Incidental or consequential dam-
ages, including without limita-
tion, loss of time, inconvenience,
loss of use of vehicle or commer-
cial loss.
This warranty is the entire war-
ranty given by HMIL for Hyundai
vehicles and no dealer or its or his
agent or employee is authorized
to extend or enlarge this warranty
and no dealer or its or his agent
or employee is authorized to
make any oral warranty on HMIL’s
behalf.
HMIL reserves the right to make
any change in design or make
any improvement on the vehicle
at any time without any obliga-
tion to make the same change on
vehicles previously sold.
HMIL reserves the right for the fi-
nal decision in all warranty mat-
ters.
Owner’s Responsibilities
Proper use, maintenance and care
of vehicle in accordance with the
instructions contained in this
Owner’s Manual and Service
Booklet. If the vehicle is subject
to severe usage conditions, su-
such as operation in extremely
dusty, rough, more repeated
short distance driving or heavy
city traffic during hot weather,
maintenance of vehicle should
be done more frequently as men-
tioned in this Owner’s Manual
and Service Booklet
Retention of maintenance service
records. It may be necessary for
the customer to show that the re-
quired maintenance has been
performed, as specified in this
Owner’s Manual and Service
Booklet.
Delivery of the vehicle during reg-
ular service business hours to
any authorized Hyundai Dealer to
obtain warranty service.
In order to maintain the validity of
this Basic Warranty, the vehicle
must be serviced by Hyundai Au-
thorized workshop in accordance
to the Owner’s Manual and Ser-
vice Booklet.
PARTS REPLACEMENT WARǢ
RANTY
Hyundai Motor India Limited herein-
after called “HMIL, warrants that
each new Hyundai Genuine replace-
ment part purchased from and in-
stalled by Hyundai Authorized Dealer
shall be free from any defects in ma-
terial or workmanship, unde normal
use and maintenance, subject to the
following terms and conditions
1. Warranty period
This warranty shall exist for a period
of 6 months or until the vehicle has
been driven for a distance of 10,000
Kilometers from the date of installa-
tion of replacement part by Hyundai
Authorized Dealer, whichever occurs
first.
Audio Video Navigation System, Bat-
teries, Tyres & Tubes and Audio Sys-
tems, originally equipped on Hyundai
vehicles are warranted directly by the
respective manufacturers and not by
HMIL.

+\XQGDL:DUUDQW\3ROLF\
2. What is covered
2XU $XWKRUL]HG 'HDOHUV VKDOO HLWKHU
UHSDLURUUHSODFHDQ\+\XQGDLJHQX
LQH SDU OLVWHG LQ SDUDJUDSK  KHUHRI
WKDWLVDFNQRZOHGJHGE\+0,/WREH
GHIHFWLYHLQPDWHULDORUZRUNPDQVKLS
ZLWKLQWKHZDUUDQW\SHULRGVWLSXODWHG
DERYH DIWHU H[DPLQDWLRQV FDUULHG
RXWWRFRQILUPWKDWQRQHRIWKHRULJL
DOVHWWLQJVKDYHEHHQWDPSHUHGZLWK
DWQRFRVWWRWKHRZQHURIWKH+\XQG
DL YHKLFOH IRU SDUWV RU ODERXU 6XFK
GHIHFWLYH SDUWV ZKLFK KDYH EHHQ UH
SODFHG ZLOO EHFRPH WKH SURSHUW\ RI
+0,/
 What is not covered
7KLVZDUUDQW\VKDOOQRWDSSO\WR
1RUPDO PDLQWHQDQFH VHUYLFHV RI
SDUWV VXFK DV FOHDQLQJ DGMXVW
PHQW RU UHSODFHPHQW LH VSDUN
SOXJV WKDW DUH RLO IRXOHG OHDG
IRXOHG RU ZKLFK IDLO GXH WR WKH
XVHRIORZJUDGHIXHO
3DUWVWKDWIDLOGXHWRDEXVHPLV
XVH QHJOHFW DOWHUDWLRQ RU DFFL
GHQWRUZKLFKKDYHEHHQLPSURS
HUO\OXEULFDWHGRUUHSDLUHG
3DUWV XVHG LQ DSSOLFDWLRQV IRU
ZKLFKWKH\ZHUHQRWGHVLJQHGRU
DSSURYHGE\+0,/
)DLOXUH GXH WR QRUPDO ZHDU RI
SDUWV
'LUHFWRULQGLUHFWIDLOXUHVFDXVHG
E\PLVXVHDQGLPSURSHUPDLQWH
QDQFHRIYHKLFOH
$Q\YHKLFOHRQZKLFKWKHRGRPH
WHU UHDGLQJ KDV EHHQ DOWHUHG VR
WKDWPLOHDJHFDQQRWEHDFFXUDWH
O\GHWHUPLQHG
,QFLGHQWDORUFRQVHTXHQWLDOGDP
DJHV LQFOXGLQJ ZLWKRXW OLPLWD
WLRQORVVRIWLPHLQFRQYHQLHQFH
ORVVRIXVHRIYHKLFOHRUFRPPHU
FLDOORVV
7KLV ZDUUDQW\ LV WKH HQWLUH ZDUUDQW\
JLYHQ E\ +0,/ IRU +\XQGDL UHSODFH
PHQWSDUWVDQGQRGHDOHURULWVRUKLV
DJHQW RU HPSOR\HH LV DXWKRUL]HG WR
H[WHQG RU HQODUJH WKLV ZDUUDQW\ DQG
QR GHDOHU RU LWV RU KLV DJHQW RU HP
SOR\HHLVDXWKRUL]HGWRPDNHDQ\RUDO
ZDUUDQW\ RQ +0,/ŔV EHKDOI +0,/ UH
VHUYHVWKHULJKWIRUWKHILQDOGHFLVLRQ
LQDOOZDUUDQW\PDWWHUV
Owner’s Responsibility :
3URSHU XVH PDLQWHQDQFH DQG UH
RIWKHYHKLFOHLQDFFRUGDQFHZLWK
WKHLQVWUXFWLRQVFRQWDLQHGLQWKH
2ZQHUŔV 0DQXDO DQG 6HUYLFH
%RRNOHW.
5HWHQWLRQ RI PDLQWHQDQFH VHU
YLFHUHFRUGV,WPD\EHQHFHVVDU\
IRUWKHFXVWRPHUWRVKRZWKDWWKH
UHTXLUHG PDLQWHQDQFH KDV EHHQ
SHUIRUPHG DV VSHFLILHG LQ WKLV
2ZQHUŔV 0DQXDO DQG 6HUYLFH
%RRNOHW
5HWHQWLRQRIWKHFXVWRPHUŔVFRS\
RI WKH RULJLQDO UHSDLU RUGHU DQG
LWVLQYRLFHELOODJDLQVWZKLFKWKH
SDUWZDVUHSODFHG
'HOLYHU\ RI WKH YHKLFOH GXULQJ
UHJXODUVHUYLFHEXVLQHVVKRXUVWR
WKH VDPH +\XQGDL $XWKRUL]HG
'HDOHUZKRKDGVROGDQGLQVWDOOHG
WKHUHSODFHPHQWSDUW
,QRUGHUWRPDLQWDLQWKHYDOLGLW\RI
WKLV 3DUWV UHSODFHPHQW :DUUDQW\
WKH YHKLFOH PXVW EH VHUYLFHG E\
+\XQGDL $XWKRUL]HG ZRUNVKRS LQ
DFFRUGDQFHWRWKH2ZQHUŔV0DQXDO
DQG6HUYLFH%RRNOHW

Labour Free Service of Vehicle
<RXU YHKLFOH LV HQWLWOHG IRU ILUVW
WKUHHODERXUIUHHVHUYLFHVRI3HULRGLF
0DLQWHQDQFH6FKHGXOH3063OHDVH
UHIHU SDJH  IRU ODERXU IUHH
VHUYLFH FRXSRQV DQG SDJH  IRU
306VHUYLFHV
NOTICE
$OO &RQVXPDEOHV :KHHO $OLJQPHQW
DQG  RU 3DUW 5HSODFHPHQW LI QRW
FRYHUHG LQ ZDUUDQW\ LI UHTXLUHG
DUH FKDUJHDEOHWRWKHFXVWRPHUV
HYUNDAI EXTENDED WARRANTY*
+0,/ RIIHUV RSWLRQDO SDLG H[WHQGHG
ZDUUDQW\ RQ VHOHFWHGPRGHOV LQ DG
GLWLRQ WR WKH EDVLF QHZ YHKLFOH ZDU
UDQW\ )RU PRUH GHWDLOV RQ +\XQGDL
([WHQGHG :DUUDQW\ SOHDVH FDOO WKH
QHDUHVWGHDOHURURXUWROOIUHHQXPEHU

Conditions apply
We are pleased to introduce you to our 24 X 7 Hyundai Road Side Assistance Programme
Our Road Side Assistance number is : 1800 102 4645 (toll free),
(0124)2564645 (call charges apply)
Hyundai Roadside assistance is a 24 X 7 emergency support provided in the event of any mechanical/electrical
breakdown and/or road traffic accident of a vehicle.
Covered Events & Benefits *
Break Down/Accident Roadside repair or vehicle recovery in case of
breakdown/road traffic accident
Tire Related Tire Puncture – Replacement of Punctured tire with the
spare tire
Battery Related Dead Battery –Jump Start
Key Related Locked keys, lost keys or broken vehicle keys
Terms and Conditions
1) The Service is applicable for 3 years from the date of sale
2) The 24 X 7 Road Side Assistance is available up to a nearest Hyundai Authorised
dealer workshop
3) The Service is applicable for a condition in which the vehicle has been immobile
4) Cost of parts replacement is not included, unless covered under Hyundai Warranty
5) Cost of repairs made to your vehicle is not included, unless it is covered under
Hyundai Warranty.
6) For Online retail RSA & Complete TnC’s, kindly visit:
https://hyundai.awpassistance.in/
* Terms and Conditions apply.
-
+\XQGDL:DUUDQW\3ROLF\
-7
RO Number
Dealer/HASC code
RO Number
Dealer/HASC code
RO Number
Dealer/HASC code

/DERXU)UHH6HUYLFH
&RXSRQ
UG/DERXU)UHH6HUYLFH
&&RXSRQ
 /DERXU)UHH6HUYLFH
&&RXSRQ
/DERXU)UHH6HUYLFHVDUHYDOLGDWDOO+\XQGDLGHDOHUVKLSVGHDOHUEUDQFKHVDQGDXWKRUL]HGVHUYLFH&HQWUHV
  
     

BW~hPW vUBWhPW ~UBWiPW BWhPW
 9Ws/WP~hzhxv @W|U /xvW @W|U /xvW AW|U /xvW  9Yt0YRj{jyw AY}V 0ywY
 
9 @ @  J0CfMaVk_YYwjMqDMw]YRMYyjq
 CYYkwddYMMRmrkwnMdYMwVOyy 9
+ + " 2fMYt 9
@ $ 5Yo]hpY~?Yyoywp
9 9 9 % 5Yo]hpYRMjVdY0jYWpywp
 -fMRyMq-MwjY?W~xoxvp
+ +

5YoMwmMi]hpY?Wxoxvo
o9@ o9@ o9@  5ywYM{YwkywqkwmMdYOMqrlyjw 9
9 9  5YopiwYfyYMwVRywwYRjyw 9
9 9 9

0jYfMaOyy 9
o9@ o9@ o9@  5rkVrYMmMdY 9
5ywMwVYKfYYrOYM~kwdOfY q9A
9 9 9 " 5ywMwVYMViTVtOMmY{MV 9
9 9 9 $ ?MmjwdOMmYVjRfyYy{YMiyw 9
%
JfYYp(pidwtYw*MoMwRiwd
 GY{YYRywVkkywyMjyw
 
9 : 9  *yoMwVwywRfMiMwVOyV 9
9 : 9  <OjRMYqyRmfkwdY ;
: 9  (rrYrYRjRMqYtV~kYOYqMrYwMy 9
9 + @  JMwjwdqjdfy{YMkyw70C .gYSn 9
9 : 9  3jwojdffywdMdY 9
 
 1vbhvWxio^hoW'
 1vbhvWDhsivb+eKhvNWo
 (hPoWKvW~^hpW~>W~xpxvoZ
 (h~QoXLvX~ 5hoX~/hXXoxvo
 )KWPxvUhixvzWPi^hPbKh
! DexoWNxU>Wxoxvo
" BzK~mzob>Wxoxvo
# HKoWPpWK~KvPW
& 8xWIKPPs16@H6EJ6D
 +~KvmPKWWvhpKhxvexW
 FvhxvWhUpWUKszW~zooW
 >xWWW~hvb^oiUKvUoWKmKbW
 )KmW+oPe[phU
 1vbhvWPxxoKv
 =KvKpKvKoW[phU
! (xsKhP+HD/+DKvKoW[phU
 
" JhzW~izWNpKUWKeW~`hU
# )KmW+oPf\~XXzoLoXLmLcX
& 4Wo^hopW~PKz
 +ohsKWPxvxpKh[ioW~
 ,eXQm(,Xs~X\~hcXLvQxsz~Xx~
 +xxoivbWs pWKmKbW 9 9 9
" (ppYMOYpy{YMjyw 9

      o9@
 
$ AyMVY
  
)

 
 
vUBWhPW
@W|U /xvW
9
9
9
9
9
9
r9@
9
9
q;A
D@
9

9
9
9
9
q;A
~UBWhPW
@W|U /xvW
9
9
@
9
9
9
9
q;A
9
9
o9A
DA
9

9
9
9
9
o;@
-8
Reqd. Done Reqd. Done Reqd. Done Reqd. Done Reqd. Done Reqd. Done
A C
1 Engine oil & filter* I R R 24 4WD Shaft differential Transfer case oil** - - -
2 Engine Timing Chain / belt - - - 25 Steering gear rack, linkage and boots I I I
3 Air cleaner filter (Petrol only)* - C C 26 Exhaust system I I I
4 Air cleaner filter (T-Gdi only)* - C R 27 Fuel filter (Petrol only) - - -
5 Air cleaner Filter (Diesel only)* - C R 28 Fuel filter cartridge (Diesel only)* - - R
6 Battery condition & specific gravity I I I 29 Charcoal Canister (Petrol only) - - -
7 Throttle body (Petrol only) - - - 30 Fuel tank air filter (if equipped) (Petrol only)** - - -
8 Spark plugs (Petrol only) - C C 31 Front & rear suspension (linkages & ball joints) I I I
9 Valve clearance I (IR) I (IR) I (IR) 32 Fuel lines, hoses and connections I I I
10 Hoses (Vaccum/ EGR/ VGT/ WGT) - I I 33 Driveshafts & boots I I I
11 Crankcase ventilation hose I I I 34 Fluid leakages I I I
12 Tensioner/idler/damper pulley I (IR) I (IR) I (IR) 35 Front and rear wheel bearing & bushes I (IR) I (IR) I (IR)
13 Power steering fluid and leakages** - - - 36 Front and rear disc/drum brakes & pads I I I
14 Brake/Clutch fluid I I I 37 Parking brake (disc, shoe & operation) I I I
15 Engine coolant I I I 38 Wheel alignment & balancing* - I (IR) I (IR)
16 Manual transaxle fluid - - - 39 Tyre pressure, condition & rotation* - I, TR I, TR
17 Automatic/CVT/IVT/DCT/iMT transaxle fluid** - - - D
B40 Bolt and nuts on chasis and body I I I
18 Wiper (wiper blade, washer fluid) I I I 41 Lubricate locks & hinges I L L
19 Brake/Clutch (free play & leakages) I I I 42 All electrical systems (drive belts, alternator) I I I
20 Fuel filler cap - I I 43 Warning lights operation & GDS system check I I I
21 Climate control air filter* I C R 44 Ext & int. lights, horn & gauges I I I
22 Check AC system (refrigerant/compressor) I I I 45 Sunroof operation (if equipped) C C C
23 Cooling system & leakage I I I 46 All seat belt operation I I I
47 Road test I (IR) I (IR) I (IR)
**If Applicable
1st Service - 1,500 km/2 months
2nd Service - 10,000 km/12 months
3rd Service - 20,000 km/24 months
CHECK LIST FOR FREE SERVICE 1,500 KM - 20,000 KM
A - ADD I - INSPECT C - CLEAN R - REPLACE L - LUBRICATE I (IR) - INSPECT IF REQUIRED TR - TYRE ROTATION
(AFTER INSPECTION, ADD, REPAIR OR REPLACE IF NECESSARY)
No. Item Description 1st Service 2nd Service 3rd Service No. Item Description
VEHICLE ON FLOOR
*All consumables are chargeable to the customer(s)
1st Service 2nd Service 3rd Service
ENGINE BAY VEHICLE ON LIFT
FINAL CHECKS
+\XQGDL:DUUDQW\3ROLF\
Exterior overview (front view) ........................................................................ 2-2
Exterior overview (rear view) .........................................................................2-4
Interior overview .............................................................................................2-6
Center console overview .................................................................................2-7
Engine compartment overview .....................................................................2-8
Dimensions ......................................................................................................2-9
Engine specification .......................................................................................2-9
Bulb wattage ..................................................................................................2-10
Tires and wheels ............................................................................................2-12
Recommended lubricants and capacities ...................................................2-13
Recommended SAE viscosity number ...................................................................2-14
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ............................................................2-15
Vehicle certification label ..............................................................................2-15
Tire specification and pressure label ............................................................2-16
Engine number ...............................................................................................2-16
Air conditioner compressor label .................................................................2-16
2. Vehicle Information
2
2-2
Vehicle Information
1. Hood ..............................................................................................................................................5-29
2. Headlight ............................................................................................................................5-36, 9-68
3. Position light* .....................................................................................................................5-36, 9-68
4. Daytime running light* or daytime running light/position light* .................................5-40, 9-68
5. Tires and wheels ..........................................................................................................................9-41
6. Outside rearview mirror ..............................................................................................................5-23
7. Front windshield wiper blades ....................................................................................................9-34
8. Windows .......................................................................................................................................5-25
* : if equipped
(;7(5,2529(59,(:ǣ)52179,(:Ǥ
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAI3012001
OAI3012001
5 Door
5 Door
2-3
02
1. Hood ..............................................................................................................................................5-29
2. Headlight ............................................................................................................................5-36, 9-68
3. Position light* .....................................................................................................................5-36, 9-68
4. Daytime running light* or daytime running light/position light* .................................5-40, 9-68
5. Tires and wheels ..........................................................................................................................9-41
6. Outside rearview mirror ..............................................................................................................5-23
7. Front windshield wiper blades ....................................................................................................9-34
8. Windows .......................................................................................................................................5-25
* : if equipped
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAI3012025
OAI3012025
4 Door
4 Door
2-4
Vehicle Information
1. Antenna* ........................................................................................................................................5-77
2. Doors..............................................................................................................................................5-14
3. Fuel filler door ..............................................................................................................................5-33
4. High mounted stop light .............................................................................................................9-75
5. Rear window wiper blade* ..........................................................................................................9-36
6. Wide-rear view camera* ...............................................................................................................7-6
7. Tailgate ..........................................................................................................................................5-30
8. Rear ultrasonic sensors* ...............................................................................................................7-8
9. Rear combination light ................................................................................................................9-72
10. Rear reflex reflector ...................................................................................................................9-72
11. License plate light .......................................................................................................................9-75
* : if equipped
(;7(5,2529(59,(:ǣ5($59,(:Ǥ
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAI3012002
OAI3012002
5 Door
5 Door
2-5
02
1. Antenna* ........................................................................................................................................5-77
2. Doors..............................................................................................................................................5-14
3. Fuel filler door ..............................................................................................................................5-33
4. High mounted stop light .............................................................................................................9-75
5. Trunk .............................................................................................................................................5-32
6. Wide-rear view camera* ...............................................................................................................7-6
7. Rear ultrasonic sensors* ................................................................................................................7-8
8. Rear combination light ................................................................................................................9-72
9. Rear reflex reflector .....................................................................................................................9-72
10. License plate light ......................................................................................................................9-75
* : if equipped
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAI3019026I
OAI3019026I
4 Door
4 Door
2-6
Vehicle Information
,17(5,2529(59,(:
1. Door lock/unlock button.............................................................................................................. 5-16
2. Outside rearview mirror control switch*....................................................................................5-23
3. Outside rearview mirror folding switch* ....................................................................................5-24
4. Central door lock/unlock switch .................................................................................................5-17
5. Power window switches ..............................................................................................................5-25
6. Power window lock switch .........................................................................................................5-27
7. Headlight leveling device* ..........................................................................................................5-39
8. ESC (Electronic Stability Control) OFF button* ........................................................................ 6-30
9. Fuse box .......................................................................................................................................9-53
10. Key ignition switch .......................................................................................................................6-4
Engine Start/Stop button* ...........................................................................................................6-7
11. Steering wheel ............................................................................................................................ 5-19
12. Hood release lever......................................................................................................................5-29
13. Fuel filler door opener................................................................................................................5-33
14. Seats ..............................................................................................................................................3-4
* : if equipped
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAI3013003
OAI3013003
2-7
02
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAI3013004
OAI3013004
&(17(5&2162/(29(59,(:
1. Wipers and Washers ................................5-43
2. Light control/Turn signals ...................... 5-36
3. Instrument cluster .....................................4-2
4. Horn .......................................................... 5-21
5. Steering wheel audio controls* ..............5-78
6. Driving assist button .................................7-2
7. Driver’s airbag .........................................3-44
8. Infotainment system* ..............................5-77
9. Hazard warning flasher switch .................8-2
10. Climate control system* .......................5-46
11. USB charger* ...........................................5-73
12. Power outlet* ..........................................5-72
13. USB port* ................................................5-77
14. Shift lever .......................................6-12, 6-15
15. Passenger's front airbag*......................3-44
16. Glove box ................................................5-70
17. Rear Power outlet* .................................5-72
Rear USB charger* ..................................5-73
* : if equipped
2-8
Vehicle Information
1. Engine coolant reservoir ..............................................................................................................9-23
2. Engine oil filler cap .....................................................................................................................9-20
3. Brake/clutch* fluid reservoir ......................................................................................................9-26
4. Air cleaner ...................................................................................................................................9-30
5. Fuse box ......................................................................................................................................9-54
6. Battery .........................................................................................................................................9-37
7. Windshield washer fluid reservoir ..............................................................................................9-28
8. Radiator cap .................................................................................................................................9-24
9. Engine oil dipstick .......................................................................................................................9-20
(1*,1(&203$570(1729(59,(:
The actual engine room in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAI3089001
OAI3089001
Gasoline Engine (G 1.2 MPI)
Gasoline Engine (G 1.2 MPI)
2-9
02
',0(16,216
(1*,1(63(&,),&$7,21
Item mm (in)
Overall length 3,815 (150.2)
Overall width 1,680 (66.1)
Overall height 1,520 (59.8)
Front tread 165/70 R14 1,488 (58.6)
175/60 R15 1,476 (58.1)
Rear tread 165/70 R14 1,503 (59.2)
175/60 R15 1,491 (58.7)
Wheelbase 2,450 (96.5)
Item Gasoline Engine
1.2 MPI
Displacement cc 1,197
Bore x Stroke mm 71 x 75.6
Firing order In-line
No. of cylinders 4
5 Door
Item mm (in)
Overall length 3,995 (157.3)
Overall width 1,680 (66.1)
Overall height 1,520 (59.8)
Front tread 165/70 R14 1,488 (58.6)
175/60 R15 1,476 (58.1)
Rear tread 165/70 R14 1,503 (59.2)
175/60 R15 1,491 (58.7)
Wheelbase 2,450 (96.5)
4 Door
2-10
Vehicle Information
%8/%:$77$*(
* : If equipped
Type A : MFR (Multi Focus Reflector) headlight
Type B : Bi-Function projection headlight
Light Bulb Bulb type Wattage
Front
Type A
Headlight (high/low) H19 60/55
Parking (Position) light W5W 5
Parking (Position) light LED LED
Turn signal light PY21W 21
Daytime Running Light (DRL) * LED LED
Type B
Headlight (high/low) HB3 60
Parking (Position) light/
Daytime Running Light (if equipped) LED LED
Turn signal light PY21W 21
Side repeater light * WY5W 5
Side repeater light (outside mirror) * LED LED
Rear
Tail light LED LED
Stop light P21W 21
Turn signal light PY21W 21
Back up light W16W 16
Reflex reflector - -
High mounted stop light* W5W 20
License plate light W5W 10
Interior Room lamp FESTOON 8
Luggage room lamp * FESTOON 8
5 Door
2-11
02
Light Bulb Bulb type Wattage
Front
Type A
Headlight (high/low) H19 60/55
Parking (Position) light W5W 5
Parking (Position) light LED LED
Turn signal light PY21W 21
Daytime Running Light (DRL) * LED LED
Type B
Headlight (high/low) HB3 60
Parking (Position) light/
Daytime Running Light (if equipped) LED LED
Turn signal light PY21W 21
Side repeater light * WY5W 5
Side repeater light (outside mirror) * LED LED
Rear
Tail light LED LED
Stop light P21/5W 21
Turn signal light PY21W 21
Back up light W16W 16
Reflex reflector - -
High mounted stop light * LED LED
License plate light W5W 10
Interior Front room lamp FESTOON 8
Center room lamp FESTOON 8
Luggage room lamp * FESTOON 5
4 Door
* : If equipped
Type A : MFR (Multi Focus Reflector) headlight
Type B : Bi-Function projection headlight
2-12
Vehicle Information
7,5(6$1':+((/6
Type Tire size Wheel size
Inflation pressure kPa (psi) Wheel lug nut
torque kgf·m
(lbf·ft, N·m)
Normal load *1Maximum load
Front Rear Front Rear
Full size
tire 165/70R 14 5.0J X 14 240
(35) 230
(33) 250
(36) 250
(36) 11~13
(79~94, 107~127)
175/60R 15 5.5J X 15
Spare tire 165/70R 14 5.0J X 14 250 (35)
155/80R 13 4.5J X 13
NOTICE
It is permissible to add 20 kPa (3 psi) to the standard tire pressure specification if
colder temperatures are expected soon. Tires typically lose 7 kPa (1 psi) for every
7°C (12°F) temperature drop. If extreme temperature variations are expected,
recheck your tire pressure as necessary to keep them properly inflated.
An air pressure generally decreases, as you drive up to a high-altitude area above
sea level. Thus, if you plan to drive a high-altitude area, check the tire pressures
in advance. If necessary, inflate them to a proper level (Air inflation per altitude:
+10 kPa/1 km (+2.4 psi/1 mile).
Spare wheel are intended for emergency purpose.
Only Steel wheel is provided as spare wheel. Spare tires can be from any
manuafacturer.
CAUTION
When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle.
Using tires of a different size can damage the related parts or make it work
irregularly.
*1 : Normal load : Up to 3 persons
2-13
02
5(&200(1'('/8%5,&$176$1'&$3$&,7,(6
To help achieve proper engine and powertrain performance and durability, use only
lubricants of the proper quality. The correct lubricants also help promote engine
efficiency that results in improved fuel economy.
These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in your vehicle.
Lubricant Volume Classification
Engine oil *1 *2
(drain and refill) 3.6 l
(3.80 US qt.) API Latest (ILSAC Latest)
Manual Transmission fluid 1.3 ~ 1.4 l
(1.38~1.48 US qt.) API Serviced GL-4, SAE 70W,
TGO-9
(HYUNDAI genuine transmission
fluid)
Automated Manual
Transmission fluid aŢ
(1.16~1.27 US qt.)
Coolant 5.32 l
(5.62 US qt.) MIXTURE, Antifreeze with water
(Ethylene glycol base coolant for
aluminum radiator)
Brake/Clutch fluid 0.7~0.8 l
(0.7~0.8 US qt.) FMVSS116 DOT-4
Fuel *337 l
(9.8 US gal.) -
*1 : Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on the next page.
*2 : Engine oils labeled Energy Conserving Oil are now available. Along with other additional
benefits, they contribute to fuel economy by reducing the amount of fuel necessary to
overcome engine friction. Often, these improvements are difficult to measure in everyday
driving, but in a year’s time, they can offer significant cost and energy savings.
*3 : The fuel filling capacity mentioned is less than the actual fuel tank capacity. The extra
capacity in the tank is provided to cater the vapour creation of fuel, to prevent leakage of
volatile organic compounds and fuel into the atmosphere. Further, it is recommended that do
not fill the tank after auto cut-off at the fuel station during filling fuel.
2-14
Vehicle Information
Recommended SAE viscosity
number
CAUTION
Always be sure to clean the area around
any filler plug, drain plug, or dipstick
before checking or draining any
lubricant. This is especially important
in dusty or sandy areas and when the
vehicle is used on unpaved roads.
Cleaning the plug and dipstick areas
will prevent dirt and grit from entering
the engine and other mechanisms that
could be damaged.
Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has
an effect on fuel economy and cold
weather operating (engine start
and engine oil flowability). Lower
viscosity engine oils can provide
better fuel economy and cold weather
performance, however, higher viscosity
engine oils are required for satisfactory
lubrication in hot weather.
Using oils of any viscosity other than
those recommended could result in
engine damage.
When choosing an oil, consider the
range of temperature your vehicle
will be operated in before the next
oil change. Proceed to select the
recommended oil viscosity from the
chart.
Temperature Range for SAE Viscosity Numbers
Temperature °C -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50
(°F) -10 0 20 40 60 80 100 120
Petrol Engine Oil
20W-50
15W-40
10W-30
0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30
*1 : For better fuel economy, it is recommended to use the engine oil of a viscosity grade SAE
0W-20 (API Latest (ILSAC Latest)). However, if the engine oil is not available in your country,
select the proper engine oil using the engine oil viscosity chart.
2-15
02
9(+,&/(,'(17,),&$7,21
180%(5ǣ9,1Ǥ
9(+,&/(&(57,),&$7,21
/$%(/ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OAI3019020
OAI3019020
The vehicle identification number (VIN)
is the number used in registering your
vehicle and in all legal matters pertaining
to its ownership, etc.
The number is punched on the floor
under the front right seat. To check the
number, pull out the slit part of carpet.
OAI3019022
OAI3019022
The vehicle certification label attached
on the driver’s (or front passenger’s) side
center pillar gives the vehicle
identification number (VIN).
2-16
Vehicle Information
7,5(63(&,),&$7,21$1'
35(6685(/$%(/
OAI3019023
OAI3019023
The tires supplied on your new
vehicle are chosen to provide the best
performance for normal driving.
The tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar gives the tire pressures
recommended for your vehicle.
(1*,1(180%(5
OAH2088004
OAH2088004
The engine number is stamped on the
engine block as shown in the drawing.
$,5&21',7,21(5
&2035(6625/$%(/
OHC081001
OHC081001
A compressor label informs you the type
of compressor your vehicle is equipped
with such as model, supplier part num-
ber, production number, refrigerant (1)
and refrigerant oil (2).
Important safety precautions ........................................................................3-2
Always wear your seat belt ........................................................................................3-2
Restrain all children ....................................................................................................3-2
Airbag hazards ............................................................................................................3-2
Driver distraction ........................................................................................................3-2
Control your speed .................................................................................................... 3-3
Keep your vehicle in safe condition ......................................................................... 3-3
Seats ................................................................................................................3-4
Front seats ..................................................................................................................3-7
Rear seats ..................................................................................................................3-11
Seat belts ........................................................................................................3-15
Seat Belt Warning Light ...........................................................................................3-16
Pre-tensioner seat belt ............................................................................................3-21
Additional seat belt safety precautions ..................................................................3-23
Care of seat belts......................................................................................................3-25
Child restraint system ...................................................................................3-26
Using a child restraint system ................................................................................3-28
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS) .............................................................. 3-29
Airbag - Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) .......................................... 3-37
How does the airbag system operate ....................................................................3-38
Do not install a child restraint on the front passenger’s seat ...............................3-40
Airbag warning and indicator ..................................................................................3-41
SRS components and functions .............................................................................3-42
Driver’s and passenger’s front airbag ....................................................................3-45
Side airbag ............................................................................................................... 3-47
Curtain airbag ..........................................................................................................3-48
SRS Care ..................................................................................................................3-55
Airbag warning label ...............................................................................................3-58
3. Safety System
This chapter provides you with important information about how to protect
yourself and your passengers. It explains how to properly use your seats and seat
belts, and how your airbags work.
Additionally, this chapter explains how to properly restrain infants and children in
your vehicle.
3
3-2
Safety System
You will find many safety precautions
and recommendations throughout this
section, and throughout this manual.
The safety precautions in this section are
among the most important.
Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all
types of accidents. Airbags are designed
to supplement seat belts, not replace
them. So even though your vehicle is
equipped with airbags, ALWAYS make
sure you and your passengers wear the
seat belts, and wear them properly.
Restrain all children
All children under age 13 ride in your
vehicle should be restrained properly
in a rear seat, not the front seat. Infants
and small children should be restrained
in an appropriate child restraint. Larger
children should use a booster seat with
the lap/shoulder belt until they can use
the seat belt properly without a booster
seat.
Airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can
also cause serious or fatal injuries to
occupants who sit too close to them, or
who are not properly restrained. Infants,
young children, and short adults are at
the greatest risk of being injured by an
inflating airbag. Follow all instructions
and warnings in this manual.
Driver distraction
Driver distraction presents a serious and
potentially deadly danger, especially for
inexperienced drivers. Safety should be
the first concern when behind the wheel
and drivers need to be aware of the wide
array of potential distractions, such as
drowsiness, reaching for objects, eating,
personal grooming, other passengers,
and using cellular phones.
Drivers can become distracted when
they take their eyes and attention off
the road or their hands off the wheel to
focus on activities other than driving. To
reduce your risk of distraction and an
accident:
ALWAYS set up your mobile devices
(for example, MP3 players, phones,
navigation units, etc.) when your
vehicle is parked or safely stopped.
ONLY use your mobile device when
allowed by laws and conditions permit
safe use.
NEVER text or email while driving.
Most countries have laws prohibiting
drivers from texting. Some countries
and cities also prohibit drivers from
using handheld phones.
NEVER let the use of a mobile device
distract you from driving. You have a
responsibility to your passengers and
others on the road to always drive
safely, with your hands on the wheel
as well as your eyes and attention on
the road.
IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
3-3
03
Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in
crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the
higher the speed, the greater the risk,
but serious injuries can also occur at
lower speeds. Never drive faster than is
safe for current conditions, regardless of
the maximum speed posted.
Keep your vehicle in safe
condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical
failure can be extremely hazardous. To
reduce the possibility of such problems,
check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly
scheduled maintenance.
3-4
Safety System
Front seats
1. Forward and backward
2. Seatback angle
3. Seat height adjustment*
4. Headrest*
Rear seats
5. Headrest (outboard)*
6. Armrest*
7. Seatback folding (5 Door)
* : if equipped
The actual feature in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAI3039037I
OAI3039037I
SEATS
Passenger's Side
Passenger's Side
Rear Seat
Rear Seat
Driver's Side
Driver's Side
3-5
03
WARNING
Loose objects
Loose objects in the driver’s foot area
could interfere with the operation of
the foot pedals, possibly causing an
accident. Do not place anything under
the front seats.
WARNING
Uprighting seat
When you return the seatback to its
upright position, hold the seatback and
return it slowly and be sure there are
no other occupants around the seat. If
the seatback is returned without being
held and controlled, the back of the
seat could move forward or backward
resulting in accidental injury.
WARNING
Driver responsibility for passengers
Riding in a vehicle with seatback
reclined could lead to serious or fatal
injury in an accident. If a seat is reclined
during an accident, the occupant’s hips
may slide under the lap portion of the
seat belt applying great force to the
unprotected abdomen. The protection
of your restraint system (seat belt
and airbags) is greatly reduced by
reclining your seat. Serious or fatal
internal injuries could result. The driver
must advise the passenger to keep
the seatback in an upright position
whenever the vehicle is in motion.
WARNING
Do not use a sitting cushion that
reduces friction between the seat and
passenger. The passenger’s hips may
slide under the lap portion of the seat
belt during an accident or a sudden
stop. Serious or fatal internal injuries
could result because the seat belt can’t
operate normally.
WARNING
Driver’s seat
Never attempt to adjust seat while
the vehicle is moving. This could
result in loss of control, and an
accident causing death, serious
injury, or property damage.
Do not allow anything to interfere
with the normal position of the
seatback. Storing items against
a seatback or in any other way
interfering with proper locking of
a seatback could result in serious
or fatal injury in a sudden stop or
collision.
Always drive and ride with your
seatback upright and the lap portion
of the seat belt snug and low across
the hips. This is the best position to
protect you in case of an accident.
In order to avoid unnecessary and
perhaps severe airbag injuries,
always sit as far back as possible
from the steering wheel while
maintaining comfortable control of
the vehicle.
3-6
Safety System
WARNING
Rear seatbacks
The rear seatback must be securely
latched. If not, passengers and
objects could be thrown forward
resulting in serious injury or death
in the event of a sudden stop or
collision.
Luggage and other cargo should be
laid flat in the cargo area. If objects
are large, heavy, or must be piled,
they must be secured. Under no
circumstances should cargo be piled
higher than the seatbacks. Failure to
follow these warnings cou ld result in
serious injury or death in the event of
a sudden stop, collision or rollover.
No passenger should ride in the cargo
area or sit or lie on folded seatbacks
while the vehicle is moving. All
passengers must be properly seated
in seats and restrained properly while
riding.
When resetting the seatback to
the upright position, make sure it
is securely latched by pushing it
forward and backwards.
To avoid the possibility of burns,
do not remove the carpet in the
cargo area. Emission control devices
beneath this floor generate high
temperatures.
WARNING
After adjusting the seat, always check
that it is securely locked into place by
attempting to move the seat forward
or backward without using the lock
release lever. Sudden or unexpected
movement of the driver’s seat could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle
resulting in an accident.
WARNING
Do not adjust the seat while wearing
seat belts. Moving the seat cushion
forward may cause strong pressure
on the abdomen.
Use extreme caution so that hands
or other objects are not caught in the
seat mechanisms while the seat is
moving.
Do not put a cigarette lighter on the
floor or seat. When you operate the
seat, gas may gush out of the lighter
and cause fire.
If there are occupants in the rear
seats, be careful while adjusting the
front seat position.
3-7
03
Front seats
OAI3039002
OAI3039002
Forward and rearward
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Pull the seat slide adjustment lever up
and hold it.
2. Slide the seat to the position you
desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seat is locked in place.
Adjust the seat before driving, and make
sure the seat is locked securely by trying
to move forward and rearward without
using the lever. If the seat moves, it is
not locked properly.
OAI3039003
OAI3039003
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Lean forward slightly and lift up on the
seatback recline lever.
2. Carefully lean back on the seat and
adjust the seatback of the seat to the
position you desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seatback is locked in place. (The lever
MUST return to its original position for
the seatback to lock.)
OAI3039004
OAI3039004
Seat height adjustment (for driver’s
seat, if equipped)
To change the height of the seat, move
the lever upwards or downwards.
To lower the seat, push the lever down
several times.
To raise the seat, pull the lever up
several times.
3-8
Safety System
Headrest
OAH2038004
OAH2038004
The driver’s and front passenger’s seats
are equipped with a headrest for the
occupant’s safety and comfort.
The headrest not only provides comfort
for the driver and front passenger, but
also helps to protect the head and neck
in the event of a collision.
WARNING
To help reduce the risk of serious
injury or death in an accident, take the
following precautions when adjusting
your headrests:
Always properly adjust the headrests
for all passengers BEFORE starting
the vehicle.
NEVER let anyone ride in a seat with
the headrests removed or reversed.
OLF034072N
OLF034072N
Adjust the headrests so the middle of
the headrests is at the same height as
the height of the top of the eyes.
NEVER adjust the headrest position
of the driver’s seat when the vehicle
is in motion.
Adjust the headrest as close to the
passenger’s head as possible. Do
not use a seat cushion that holds the
body away from the seatback.
Make sure the headrest locks into
position after adjusting it.
NOTICE
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or pull
on the headrests.
3-9
03
OLF034015
OLF034015
NOTICE
If you recline the seatback towards the
front with the head restraint and seat
at top most position, the head restraint
may come in contact with the sunvisor
or other parts of the vehicle.
OAI3039005
OAI3039005
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the headrest, pull it up to
the desired position (1). To lower the
headrest, push and hold the release
button (2) on the headrest support
and lower the headrest to the desired
position (3).
OQXI039006
OQXI039006
Removal/Reinstall (if equipped)
To remove the headrest:
1. Recline the seatback (2) with the
recline lever (1).
2. Raise headrest as far as it can go.
3. Press the headrest release button (3)
while pulling the headrest up (4).
WARNING
NEVER allow anyone to ride in a seat
with the headrest removed.
3-10
Safety System
OAI3039032
OAI3039032
To reinstall the headrest :
1. Put the headrest poles (2) into the
holes while pressing the release
button (1).
2. Adjust the headrest to the appropriate
height.
3. Adjust the seatback (4) forward using
the recline lever (3).
WARNING
Always make sure the headrest locks
into position after reinstalling and
adjusting it properly.
Seatback pocket (if equipped)
OAI3039033
OAI3039033
The seatback pocket is provided on
the back of the driver’s and/or front
passenger’s seatback.
WARNING
Seatback pockets
Do not put heavy or sharp objects in the
seatback pockets. In an accident, they
could come loose from the pocket and
injure vehicle occupants.
3-11
03
Rear seats
Headrest
OQXI039009
OQXI039009
The rear seats are equipped with
headrests in the outboard seating
positions for the occupant’s safety and
comfort.
The headrest not only provides comfort
for passengers, but also helps to protect
the head and neck in the event of a
collision.
WARNING
To help reduce the risk of serious
injury or death in an accident, take the
following precautions when adjusting
your headrests:
Always properly adjust the headrests
for all passengers BEFORE starting
the vehicle.
NEVER let anyone ride in a seat with
the headrests removed.
OLF034072N
OLF034072N
Adjust the headrests so the middle of
the headrests is at the same height as
the height of the top of the eyes.
NEVER adjust the headrest position
of the driver’s seat when the vehicle
is in motion.
Adjust the headrest as close to the
passenger’s head as possible. Do
not use a seat cushion that holds the
body away from the seatback.
Make sure the headrest locks into
position after adjusting it.
NOTICE
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or pull
on the headrests.
3-12
Safety System
OAI3039008
OAI3039008
Adjusting the height up and down
(if equipped)
To raise the headrest, pull it up (1).
To lower the headrest, push and hold
the release button (2) on the headrest
support and lower the headrest (3).
OAI3039009
OAI3039009
Removal (if equipped)
To remove the headrest, raise it as far as
it can go then press the release button
(1) while pulling upward (2).
To reinstall the headrest, put the
headrest poles (3) into the holes while
pressing the release button (1). Then
adjust it to the appropriate height.
WARNING
Make sure the headrest locks in
position after adjusting it to properly
protect the occupants.
Armrest (4 Door, if equipped)
OAI3039014
OAI3039014
The armrest is located in the center of
the rear seat. Pull the armrest down from
the seatback to use it.
You will find cup holders on the center
armrest.
Folding the rear seat
(5 Door, if equipped)
The rear seatbacks (or cushions) may be
folded to facilitate carrying long items or
to increase the luggage capacity of the
vehicle.
WARNING
Never allow passengers to sit on top
of the folded down seatback while
the vehicle is moving as this is not a
proper seating position and no seat
belts are available for use. This could
result in serious injury or death in
case of an accident or sudden stop.
Objects carried on the folded down
seatback should not extend higher
than the top of the front seats. This
could allow cargo to slide forward
and cause injury or damage during
sudden stops.
3-13
03
1. Set the front seatback to the upright
position and if necessary, slide the
front seat forward.
2. Lower the rear headrests to the lowest
position (if equipped with adjustable
headrests).
OAI3039010
OAI3039010
3. Insert the rear lap/shoulder belt plate
into the holder on the side trim. It will
prevent the lap/shoulder belt from
interfering with the seatback when
folding.
OAI3039011
OAI3039011
OAI3039012
OAI3039012
4. Pull up both sides of the seatback
lever and fold the seatback toward the
front of the vehicle.
To use the rear seat, lift and push up the
seatback backward. Push the seatback
firmly until it clicks into place. Make sure
the seatback is locked in place.
When returning the rear seatbacks to
the upright position, remember to return
the rear shoulder belts to their proper
position.
i Information
If you are not able to pull out the seat belt
from the retractor, firmly pull the belt out
and release it. Then you will be able to
pull the belt out smoothly.
3-14
Safety System
WARNING
When you return the rear seatback to
its upright position after being folded
down:
Be careful not to damage the seat belt
webbing or buckle. Do not allow the
seat belt webbing or buckle to get
caught or pinched in the rear seat.
Ensure that the seatback is completely
locked into its upright position by
pushing on the top of the seatback.
Otherwise, in an accident or sudden
stop, the seat could fold down and
allow cargo to enter the passenger
compartment, which could result in
serious injury or death.
NOTICE
When returning the rear seatbacks
to the upright position, remember to
return the rear shoulder belts to their
proper position.
Routing the seat belt webbing
through the rear seat belt guides will
help keep the seat belts from being
trapped behind or under the seats.
WARNING
Cargo
Cargo should always be secured to
prevent it from being thrown about the
vehicle in a collision and causing injury
to the vehicle occupants. Do not place
objects in the rear seats, since they
cannot be properly secured and may hit
the front seat occupants in a collision.
WARNING
Cargo loading
Make sure the engine is off, the
Automated manual transmission is in
N (Neutral) or the Manual transmission
is in R (Reverse) or 1st, and the parking
brake is securely applied whenever
loading or unloading cargo. Failure
to take these steps may allow the
vehicle to move if the shift lever
is inadvertently moved to another
position.
3-15
03
SEAT BELTS
WARNING
For maximum restraint system
protection, the seat belts must
always be used whenever the car is
moving.
Seat belts are most effective when
seatbacks are in the upright position.
Children age 12 and under must
always be properly restrained in the
rear seat. Never allow children to
ride in the front passenger seat. If
a child over 12 must be seated in
the front seat, move the seat as far
back as possible. And the child must
always be restrained in the seat
properly.
Never wear the shoulder belt under
your arm or behind your back. An
improperly positioned shoulder
belt can cause serious injuries in
a crash. The shoulder belt should
be positioned midway over your
shoulder across your collarbone.
Never wear a seat belt over fragile
objects. If there is a sudden stop or
impact, the seat belt can damage it.
Avoid wearing twisted seat belts. A
twisted belt can’t do its job as well. In
a collision, it could even cut into you.
Be sure the belt webbing is straight
and not twisted.
Be careful not to damage the belt
webbing or hardware. If the belt
webbing or hardware is damaged,
replace it.
WARNING
Seat belts are designed to bear upon
the bony structure of the body, and
should be worn low across the front
of the pelvis or the pelvis, chest and
shoulders, as applicable; wearing
the lap section of the belt across the
abdominal area must be avoided.
Seat belts should be adjusted as firmly
as possible, consistent with comfort, to
provide the protection for which they
have been designed.
A slack belt will greatly reduce the
protection afforded to the wearer.
Care should be taken to avoid
contamination of the webbing with
polishes, oils and chemicals, and
particularly battery acid. Cleaning
may safely be carried out using mild
soap and water. The belt should be
replaced if webbing becomes frayed,
contaminated or damaged.
It is essential to replace the entire
assembly after it has been worn in a
severe impact even if damage to the
assembly is not obvious. Belts should
not be worn with straps twisted. Each
belt assembly must only be used by
one occupant; it is dangerous to put a
belt around a child being carried on the
occupant’s lap.
3-16
Safety System
WARNING
No modifications or additions
should be made by the user which
will either prevent the seat belt
adjusting devices from operating to
remove slack, or prevent the seat
belt assembly from being adjusted to
remove slack.
When you fasten the seat belt, be
careful not to latch the seat belt
in buckles of other seat. It’s very
dangerous and you may not be
protected by the seat belt properly.
Do not unfasten the seat belt and
do not fasten and unfasten the seat
belt repeatedly while driving. This
could result in loss of control, and
an accident causing death, serious
injury, or property damage.
When fastening the seat belt, make
sure that the seat belt does not pass
over objects that are hard or can
break easily.
Make sure there is nothing in the
buckle interfering with the seat
belt latch mechanism, because any
materials in the buckle can cause the
seat belt not to be fastened securely.
Seat Belt Warning Light
Driver’s seat belt warning
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster
1GQA2083
1GQA2083
As a reminder to the driver, the driver’s
seat belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds each time you
turn the ignition switch or Engine Start/
Stop button ON regardless of seat belt
fastening.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened or you unfasten the seat belt
when you drive under 20 km/h (12 mph)
or stop, the corresponding warning light
will illuminate.
If you start to drive without the seat
belt fastened or you unfasten the seat
belt when you drive 20 km/h (12 mph)
and faster, the warning light will blink
and warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds.
When the seat belt is unfastened during
driving, the warning light will illuminate
when the speed is under 20 km/h (12
mph).
When the speed is 20 km/h (12 mph)
and faster, the warning light will blink
and warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds.
3-17
03
Front passenger’s seat belt warning
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster
1GQA2083
1GQA2083
As a reminder to the front passenger,
the front passenger’s seat belt warning
lights will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you turn the ignition
switch or Engine Start/Stop button ON
regardless of belt fastening.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened or you unfasten the seat belt
when you drive under 20 km/h (12 mph)
or stop, the corresponding warning light
will illuminate.
If you start to drive without the seat
belt fastened or you unfasten the seat
belt when you drive 20 km/h (12 mph)
and faster, the warning light will blink
and warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds.
When the seat belt is fastened during
driving, the warning light will illuminate
when the speed is under 20 km/h (12
mph). When the speed is 20 km/h (12
mph) and faster, the warning light will
blink and warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds.
WARNING
Riding in an improper position
adversely affects the front passenger’s
seat belt warning system. It is
important for the driver to instruct the
passenger to be seated properly as
instructed in this manual.
i Information
Although the front passenger seat is not
occupied, the seat belt warning light
will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.
The front passenger’s seat belt warning
may operate when luggage is placed on
the front passenger seat.
3-18
Safety System
Rear passenger’s seat belt warning
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster
1GQA2083
1GQA2083
For rear left and right side seat
As a reminder to the rear passenger,
the rear passenger’s seat belt warning
lights will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you turn the ignition
switch or Engine Start/Stop button ON
regardless of belt fastening.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened or you unfasten the seat belt
when you drive under 20 km/h (12 mph),
the corresponding warning light will
continue to illuminate until you fasten
the seat belt.
If you continue to drive without the seat
belt fastened or you unfasten the seat
belt when you drive 20 km/h (12 mph)
and faster, the seat belt warning chime
will sound for approximately 35 seconds
and the corresponding warning light will
blink.
When the seat belt is unfastened during
driving, the warning light will illuminate
when the speed is under 20 km/h (12
mph).
When the speed is 20 km/h (12 mph)
and faster, the warning light will blink
and warning chime will sound for
approximately 35 seconds.
WARNING
Riding in an improper position
adversely affects the rear passenger’s
seat belt warning system.
It is important for the driver to instruct
the passenger to properly be seated as
instructed in this manual.
i Information
Although the rear side passenger seat is
not occupied, the seat belt warning light
will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.
The rear side passenger’s seat belt
warning may operate when luggage,
laptop or other electronic device is
placed on the rear side passenger seat.
For rear center seat
As a reminder to the rear passenger,
the rear passenger’s seat belt warning
light will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you turn the ignition
switch or Engine Start/Stop button ON
regardless of belt fastening.
If the seat belt is not fastened when
the ignition switch or Engine Start/
Stop button is turned ON, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 70 seconds.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened or you unfasten the seat belt
when you drive under 20 km/h (12 mph),
the corresponding warning light will
continue to illuminate for approximately
70 seconds.
If you continue to drive without the seat
belt fastened or you unfasten the seat
belt when you drive over 20 km/h (12
mph), the seat belt warning chime will
sound for approximately 35 seconds
and the corresponding warning light will
blink.
If the rear door is opened or closed
under 10 km/h (6 mph), warning light
and warning sound does not work even
if driving over 20 km/h (12 mph).
3-19
03
Rear seat belt warning
As a reminder to the rear passenger,
the rear passenger seat belt warning
lights will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you turn the ignition
switch ONregardless of belt fastening.
Whether a passenger is seated or not,
if the seat belt is not fastened when the
ignition switch is turned ON, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 70 seconds.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened the corresponding warning
light will continue to illuminate for
approximately 70 seconds regardless of
the speed.
After wearing the seat belt, if you
unfasten it when you drive under 20
km/h (12.4 mi.), the corresponding
warning light will continue to illuminate
for approximately 70 seconds.
After wearing the seat belt, if you
unfasten it when you drive over 20 km/h
(12.4 mi.), the seat belt warning chime
will sound for approximately 35 seconds
and the corresponding warning light will
blink.
If the rear door is opened or closed
under 10 km/h (6.2 mi.), warning light
and warning sound do not work even if
driving over 20 km/h (12.4 mi.).
i Information
You can find the front passenger’s seat
belt warning light on the cluster.
Although the front passenger seat is not
occupied, the seat belt warning light
will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.
The front passenger’s seat belt warning
may operate when luggage is placed on
the front passenger seat.
Lap/shoulder belt
OHSS038101
OHSS038101
To fasten your seat belt:
To fasten your seat belt, pull it out of
the retractor and insert the metal tab
(1) into the buckle (2). There will be an
audible “click” when the tab locks into
the buckle.
OHSS038100
OHSS038100
You should place the lap belt (1) portion
across your hips and the shoulder belt
(2) portion across your chest.
The seat belt automatically adjusts to
the proper length only after the lap belt
portion is adjusted manually so that
it fits snugly around your hips. If you
lean forward in a slow and easy motion,
the belt will extend and let you move
around. If there is a sudden stop or
impact, however, the belt will lock into
position. It will also lock if you try to lean
forward too quickly.
i Information
If you are not able to pull out the safety
belt from the retractor, firmly pull the
belt out and release it. After release, you
will be able to pull the belt out smoothly.
3-20
Safety System
WARNING
Improperly positioned seat belts may
increase the risk of serious injury
in an accident.Take the following
precautions when adjusting the seat
belt:
Position the lap portion of the seat
belt as low as possible across your
hips, not on your waist, so that it
fits snugly.This allows your strong
pelvic bones to absorb the force of
the crash, reducing the chance of
internal injuries.
Position one arm under the shoulder
belt and the other over the belt, as
shown in the illustration.
Always position the shoulder belt
anchor into the locked position at the
appropriate height.
Never position the shoulder belt
across your neck or face.
OHSS038102
OHSS038102
WARNING
You should place the lap belt portion
as low as possible and snugly across
your hips, not on your waist. If the lap
belt is located too high on your waist, it
may increase the chance of injury in the
event of a collision. Both arms should
not be under or over the belt. Rather,
one should be over and the other
under, as shown in the illustration.
Never wear the seat belt under the arm
nearest the door.
OHSS038103
OHSS038103
To release the seat belt:
The seat belt is released by pressing
the release button (1) in the locking
buckle. When it is released, the belt
should automatically draw back into the
retractor.
If this does not happen, check the belt to
be sure it is not twisted, then try again.
3-21
03
3-point rear center seat belt
OAI3039041
OAI3039041
Insert the tongue plate (1) into the
buckle (2) until an audible “click” is
heard, indicating the latch is locked
make sure the belt is not twisted. When
using the rear center seat belt, the
buckle with the “CENTER” mark must be
used.
i Information
If you are not able to pull out the safety
belt from the retractor, firmly pull the
belt out and release it. After release, you
will be able to pull the belt out smoothly.
WARNING
Make sure that the seatback is locked
in place when using the rear center
seat belt.
If not, the seatback may move when
there is a sudden stop or collision,
which could result in serious injury.
Pre-tensioner seat belt
(if equipped)
OIB034039
OIB034039
Your vehicle is equipped with driver’s
and front passenger’s pre-tensioner
seat belts (retractor pre-tensioner).The
purpose of the pre-tensioner is to make
sure the seat belts fit tightly against the
occupant’s body in certain frontal or
side collision(s). The pre-tensioner seat
belts may be activated in crashes where
the frontal or side collision(s) is severe
enough, together with the airbags.
When the vehicle stops suddenly, or if
the occupant tries to lean forward too
quickly, the seat belt retractor will lock
into position. In certain frontal collisions,
the pre-tensioner will activate and pull
the seat belt into tighter contact against
the occupant’s body.
WARNING
For your safety, be sure that the belt
webbing is not loose or twisted and
always sit properly on your seat.
3-22
Safety System
WARNING
Always wear your seat belt and sit
properly in your seat.
Do not use the seat belt if it is loose
or twisted. A loose or twisted seat
belt will not protect you properly in
an accident.
Do not place anything near the
buckle. This may adversely affect
the buckle and cause it to function
improperly.
Always replace your pre-tensioners
after activation or an accident.
NEVER inspect, service, repair
or replace the pre-tensioners by
yourself. This must be done by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not hit the seat belt assemblies.
WARNING
Do not touch the pre-tensioner seat
belt assemblies for several minutes
after they have been activated. When
the pre-tensioner seat belt mechanism
deploys during a collision, the pre-
tensioner can become hot and can burn
you.
CAUTION
Body work on the front area of the
vehicle may damage the pre-tensioner
seat belt system. Therefore, we
recommend the system to be serviced
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OQX033061AU
OQX033061AU
The seat belt pre-tensioner system
consists mainly of the following
components. Their locations are shown
in the illustration:
(1) SRS airbag warning light
(2) Retractor pre-tensioner assembly
(3) SRS control module
3-23
03
NOTICE
The sensor that activates the SRS
control module is connected with
the pre–tensioner seat belts. The SRS
airbag warning light on the instrument
cluster will illuminate for approximately
6 seconds after the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position, and then it
should turn off. If the pre-tensioner is
not working properly, the warning light
will illuminate even if the SRS airbag is
not malfunctioning. If the warning light
does not illuminate, stays illuminated
or illuminates when the vehicle is
being driven, we recommend the pre-
tensioner seat belts and/or SRS control
module be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
i Information
Both the driver’s and front passenger’s
pre-tensioner seat belts may be
activated in certain frontal or side
collisions.
When the pre-tensioner seat belts are
activated, a loud noise may be heard
and fine dust, which may appear to be
smoke, may be visible in the passenger
compartment. These are normal
operating conditions and are not
hazardous.
Although it is non-toxic, the fine dust
may cause skin irritation so you should
not be inhaled for prolonged periods.
Wash all exposed skin areas thoroughly
after an accident in which the pre-
tensioner seat belts were activated.
Additional seat belt safety
precautions
Seat belt use during pregnancy
The seat belt should always be used
during pregnancy. The best way to
protect your unborn child is to protect
yourself by always wearing the seat
belt. Pregnant women should always
wear a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the
shoulder belt across your chest, routed
between your breasts and away from
your neck. Place the lap belt below your
belly so that it fits SNUGLY across your
hips and pelvic bone, under the rounded
part of the belly.
WARNING
Pregnant women and patients are
more vulnerable to any impacts on
the abdomen during an abrupt stop
or accident. If you are in an accident
while pregnant, consult your doctor.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to an unborn child during an
accident, pregnant women should
NEVER place the lap portion of the
seat belt above or over the area of
the abdomen where the unborn child
is located.
Seat belt use and children
Infant and small children
Most countries have Child Restraint
System laws which require children
to travel in approved Child Restraint
System devices, including booster seats.
The age at which seat belts can be used
instead of the Child Restraint System
differs among countries, so you should
be aware of the specific requirements
in your country, and where you are
travelling. Infant and Child Restraint
System must be properly placed and
installed in a rear seat. For more details,
refer to the “Child Restraint Systems”in
this chapter.
3-24
Safety System
WARNING
ALWAYS properly restrain infants and
small children in a Child Restraint
System appropriate for the child’s
height and weight. To reduce the risk
of serious injury or death to a child and
other passengers,NEVER hold a child
in your lap or arms when the vehicle
is moving.The violent forces created
during an accident will tear the child
from your arms and throw the child
against the interior of the vehicle.
Small children are best protected from
injury in an accident when properly
restrained in the rear seat by a Child
Restraint System that meets the
requirements of the Safety Standards of
your country. Before buying any Child
Restraint System, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets Safety
Standard of your country. The Child
Restraint System must be appropriate
for your child’s height and weight. Check
the label on the Child Restraint System
for this information. Refer to “Child
Restraint Systems” in this chapter.
Larger children
Children under age 13 and who are too
large for a booster seat should always
occupy the rear seat and use the
available lap/shoulder belts. A seat belt
should lie across the upper thighs and
be snug across the shoulder and chest
to restrain the child safely. Check belt fit
periodically. A child’s squirming could
put the belt out of position.In the event
of an accident, children are afforded the
best safety restrained by a proper Child
Restraint System in the rear seats.
If a larger child over age 13 must be
seated in the front seat, the child must
be securely restrained by the available
lap/shoulder belt and the seat should be
placed in the rearmost position. If the
shoulder belt portion slightly touches
the child’s neck or face, try placing the
child closer to the center of the vehicle.If
the shoulder belt still touches their face
or neck, they need to be returned to an
appropriate booster seat in the rear seat.
WARNING
Always make sure larger children’s
seat belts are worn and properly
adjusted.
NEVER allow the shoulder belt to
contact the child’s neck or face.
Do not allow more than one child to
use a single seat belt.
Seat belt use and injured people
A seat belt should be used when an
injured person is being transported.
Consult a physician for specific
recommendations.
One person per belt
Two people (including children) should
never attempt to use a single seat belt.
This could increase the severity of
injuries in case of an accident.
3-25
03
Do not lie down
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts
and/or airbags) is greatly reduced by
reclining your seatback. Seat belts must
be snug against your hips and chest
to work properly. During an accident,
you could be thrown into the seat belt,
causing neck or other injuries.
The more the seat back is reclined, the
greater the chance for the passenger’s
hips to slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck to strike the shoulder
belt.
WARNING
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious
or fatal injuries in the event of a
collision or sudden stop.
Driver and passengers should always
sit well back in their seats with the
seatbacks upright and should be
belted properly.
Care of seat belts
Seat belt systems should never be
disassembled or modified. In addition,
care should be taken to assure that
seat belts and belt hardware are not
damaged by seat hinges, doors or other
abuse.
Periodic inspection
All seat belts should be inspected
periodically for wear or damage of any
kind. Any damaged parts should be
replaced as soon as possible.
Keep belts clean and dry
Seat belts should be kept clean and
dry. If belts become dirty, they can be
cleaned by using a mild soap solution
and warm water. Bleach, dye, strong
detergents or abrasives should not be
used because they may damage and
weaken the fabric.
When to replace seat belts
The entire seat belt assembly or
assemblies should be replaced if the
vehicle has been involved in an accident.
This should be done even if no damage
is visible.We recommend that you
consult with an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
3-26
Safety System
CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Children riding in the car should sit
in the rear seat and must always be
properly restrained to minimize the
risk of injury in an accident, sudden
stop or sudden maneuver. According
to accident statistics, children are safer
when properly restrained in the rear
seats than in the front seat. Larger
children not in a child restraint should
use one of the seat belts provided.
You should be aware of the specific
requirements in your country. Child and/
or infant safety seats must be properly
placed and installed in the rear seat.
You must use a commercially available
child restraint system that meets the
requirements of the Safety Standards of
your country.
Child restraint systems are designed to
be secured in vehicle seats by the lap
belt portion of a lap/shoulder belt.
Children could be injured or killed in a
crash if their restraints are not properly
secured. For small children and babies, a
child seat or infant seat must be used.
Before buying a particular child restraint
system, make sure it fits your car seat
and seat belts, and fits your child. Follow
all the instructions provided by the
manufacturer when installing the child
restraint system.
WARNING
A child restraint system must be
placed in the rear seat. Never install
a child or infant seat on the front
passenger’s seat. Should an accident
occur and cause the passenger-side
airbag to deploy, it could severely
injure or kill an infant or child seated
in an infant or child seat. Thus, only
use a child restraint in the rear seat of
your vehicle.
A seat belt or child restraint system
can become very hot if it is left in a
closed vehicle on a sunny day, even
if the outside temperature does not
feel hot. Be sure to check the seat
cover and buckles before placing a
child there.
When the child restraint system is not
in use, store it in the luggage area or
fasten it with a seat belt so that it will
not be thrown forward in the case of
a sudden stop or an accident.
Children may be seriously injured
or killed by an inflating airbag. All
children, even those too large for
child restraints, must ride in the rear
seat.
3-27
03
WARNING
To reduce the chance of serious or fatal
injuries:
Children of all ages are safer when
restrained in the rear seat. A child
riding in the front passenger seat can
be forcefully struck by an inflating
airbag resulting in serious or fatal
injuries.
Always follow the instructions for
installation and use of the child
restraint maker.
Always make sure the child seat is
secured properly in the car and your
child is securely restrained in the
child seat.
Never hold a child in your arms or lap
when riding in a vehicle. The violent
forces created during a crash will tear
the child from your arms and throw
the child against the car’s interior.
Never put a seat belt over yourself
and a child. During a crash, the
belt could press deep into the child
causing serious internal injuries.
Never leave children unattended
in a vehicle - not even for a short
time. The car can heat up very
quickly, resulting in serious injuries
to children inside. Even very young
children may inadvertently cause the
vehicle to move, entangle themselves
in the windows, or lock themselves or
others inside the vehicle.
Never allow two children, or any two
persons, to use the same seat belt.
Children often squirm and reposition
themselves improperly. Never let
a child ride with the shoulder belt
under their arm or behind their back.
Always properly position and secure
children in rear seat.
Never allow a child to stand-up or
kneel on the seat or floorboard of a
moving vehicle. During a collision
or sudden stop, the child can be
violently thrown against the vehicles
interior, resulting in serious injury.
Never use an infant carrier or a
child safety seat that “hooks” over
a seatback, it may not provide
adequate security in an accident.
Seat belts can become very hot,
especially when the car is parked in
direct sunlight. Always check seat
belt buckles before fastening them
over a child.
After an accident, we recommend
that the system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If there is not enough space to place
the child restraint system because
of the driver’s seat, install the child
restraint system in the rear right seat.
3-28
Safety System
Using a child restraint system
CRS09
CRS09
Rearward-facing child restraint system
Rearward-facing child restraint system
Forward-facing child restraint system
Forward-facing child restraint system
OIB034017
OIB034017
For small children and babies, the use
of a child seat or infant seat is required.
This child seat or infant seat should be
of appropriate size for the child and it
should be installed in accordance with
the manufacturer’s instructions.
For safety reasons, we recommend that
the child restraint system is used in the
rear seats.
WARNING
Never place a rear-facing child restraint
in the front passenger seat, because of
the danger that an inflating passenger-
side airbag could impact the rear-
facing child restraint and kill the child.
WARNING
Child seat installation
A child can be seriously injured
or killed in a collision if the child
restraint is not properly anchored to
the car and the child is not properly
restrained in the child restraint.
Before installing the child restraint
system, read the instructions
supplied by the child restraint system
manufacturer.
If the seat belt does not operate
as described in this section, we
recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Failure to observe this manual’s
instructions regarding child restraint
system and the instructions provided
with the child restraint system could
increase the risk and/or severity of
injury in an accident.
3-29
03
Installing a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
WARNING
Before installing your Child Restraint
System always:
Read and follow the instructions
provided by the manufacturer of the
Child Restraint System.
Failure to follow all warnings and
instructions could increase the risk of
the SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH if an
accident occurs.
WARNING
If the vehicle headrest prevents proper
installation of a Child Restraint System
(as described in the Child Restraint
System manual), the headrest of the
respective seating position shall be
readjusted or entirely removed.
After selecting a proper Child Restraint
System and checking that the Child
Restraint System fits properly in the rear
of this vehicle, you are ready to install
the Child Restraint System according to
the manufacturer’s instruction. There are
three general steps in installing the Child
Restraint System properly:
Properly secure the Child Restraint
System to the vehicle. All Child
Restraint Systems must be secured to
the vehicle with the lap belt or lap part
of a lap/shoulder belt or with the top-
tether and/or ISOFIX anchorage.
Make sure the Child Restraint System
is firmly secured. After installing a
Child Restraint System to the vehicle,
push and pull the Child Restraint
System forward and from side-
to-side to verify that it is securely
attached to the vehicle seat. A Child
Restraint System secured with a seat
belt should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, some side-to-side
movement can be expected.
When installing a Child Restraint
System, adjust the vehicle seat (up
and down, forward and rearward)
so that your child fits in the Child
Restraint System in a comfortable
manner.
Secure the child in the Child
Restraint System. Make sure the
child is properly strapped in the Child
Restraint System according to the
Child Restraint System manufacturer’s
instructions.
WARNING
A Child Restraint System in a closed
vehicle can become very hot. To
prevent burns, check the seating
surface and buckles before placing
your child in the Child Restraint
System.
3-30
Safety System
ISOFIX anchorage and top-tether
anchorage (ISOFIX system) for
children (if equipped)
The ISOFIX system holds a Child
Restraint System during driving and in
an accident. This system is designed
to make installation of the Child
Restraint System easier and reduce
the possibility of improperly installing
your Child Restraint System. The ISOFIX
system uses anchors in the vehicle and
attachments on the Child Restraint
System. The ISOFIX system eliminates
the need to use seat belts to secure the
Child Restraint System to the rear seats.
ISOFIX anchors are metal bars built into
the vehicle. There are two lower anchors
for each ISOFIX seating position that will
accommodate a Child Restraint System
with lower attachments.
To use the ISOFIX system in your
vehicle, you must have a Child Restraint
System with ISOFIX attachments. (An
ISOFIX-Child Restraint System may only
be installed if it has vehicle-specific or
universal approval in accordance with
the requirements of ECE-R 44 or ECE-R
129.)
The Child Restraint System manufacturer
will provide you with instructions on how
to use the Child Restraint System with its
attachments for the lower anchorages.
OLM039035
OLM039035
ISOFIX anchorages have been provided
in the left and right outboard rear
seating positions. Their locations are
shown in the illustration. There are no
ISOFIX anchorages provided for the
center rear seating position.
WARNING
Do not attempt to install a Child
Restraint System using ISOFIX
anchorages in the rear center
seating position. There are no ISOFIX
anchorages provided for this seat.
Using the outboard seat anchorages,
for the CRS installation on the rear
center seating position, can damage
the anchorages which may break or fail
in a collision resulting in serious injury
or death.
3-31
03
OAI3039016
OAI3039016
The ISOFIX anchorages symbols are
located on the left and right rear seat
cushions to identify the position of the
ISOFIX anchorages in your vehicle (see
arrows in illustration).
OAI3039017
OAI3039017
Both rear outboard seats are equipped
with a pair of ISOFIX anchorages as well
as a corresponding top-tether anchorage
on the back side of the rear seats.
(Child Restraint Systems with universal
approval according to ECE-R44 or
ECE-R129 need to be fixed additionally
with a top-tether connected to the
corresponding top-tether anchorage
point on the back side of the rear seats.)
ISOFIX anchorages are located between
the seatback and the seat cushion of the
rear seat left and right outboard seating
positions.
Securing a Child Restraint System
with the “ISOFIX system”
To install a ISOFIX-compatible Child
Restraint System in either of the rear
outboard seating positions:
1. Move the seat belt buckle away from
the ISOFIX anchorages.
2. Move any other objects away from
the anchors that could prevent a
secure connection between the Child
Restraint System and the ISOFIX
anchorages.
3. Place the Child Restraint System on
the vehicle seat, then attach the seat
to the ISOFIX anchorages according to
the instructions provided by the Child
Restraint System manufacturer.
4. Follow the instructions of the Child
Restraint System’s manufacturer for
proper installation and connection
of the ISOFIX attachments on the
Child Restraint System to the ISOFIX
anchorages.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the ISOFIX system:
Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your Child
Restraint System.
To prevent the child from reaching
and taking hold of unretracted
seat belts, buckle all unused rear
seat belts and retract the seat belt
webbing behind the child. Children
can be strangled if a shoulder belt
becomes wrapped around their neck
and the seat belt tightens.
3-32
Safety System
NEVER attach more than one
Child Restraint System to a single
anchorage. This could cause the
anchor or attachment to come loose
or break.
Always have the ISOFIX system
inspected by your dealer after an
accident. An accident can damage
the ISOFIX system and may not
properly secure the Child Restraint
System.
Securing a Child Restraint System
with “Top-tether anchorage”
system (if equipped)
OAI3039034
OAI3039034
5 Door
5 Door
4 Door
4 Door
OAI3039038
OAI3039038
Top-tether anchorages for Child
Restraint Systems are located on the
floor of the luggage room (5 Door) or on
the package tray (4 Door).
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
installing the top-tether:
Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your Child
Restraint System.
NEVER attach more than one Child
Restraint System to a single top-
tether anchorage. This could cause
the anchorage or attachment to
come loose or break.
Do not attach the top-tether to
anything other than the correct top-
tether anchorage. It may not work
properly if attached to something
else.
Child Restraint System anchorages
are designed to withstand only those
loads imposed by correctly fitted
Child Restraint Systems. Do not use
them for adult seat belts, harnesses,
or for attaching other items or
equipment to the vehicle.
3-33
03
OAI3039018
OAI3039018
To install the top-tether :
1. Route the Child Restraint System
top-tether over the Child Restraint
System seatback. Route the top-tether
under the headrest and between the
headrest posts, or route the top-tether
over the top of the vehicle seatback.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
2. Connect the top-tether to the top-
tether anchorage, then tighten
the top-tether according to the
instructions of your Child Restraint
System’s manufacturer to firmly
attach the Child Restraint System to
the seat.
3. Check that the Child Restraint System
is securely attached to the seat by
pushing and pulling the seat forward
and from side-to-side.
3-34
Safety System
Child Seat Restraint Suitability for Seat Position using the Seat Belt
Suitability of each seating position for “universal” category belted Child Restraint Systems according to ECE regulations
Use Child Restraint Systems that have been officially approved and are appropriate for your children.
When using the Child Restraint Systems, refer to the following table.
Mass Group Size Class Fixture
Vehicle ISOFIX Positions
Front
Passenger 2nd row
Outboard Left Center Outboard Right
Carrycot F ISO/L1 N/A X N/A X
G ISO/L2 N/A X N/A X
0 : UP to 10 kg E ISO/R1 N/A IL N/A IL
0+ : UP to 13 kg E ISO/R1 N/A IL N/A IL
D ISO/R2 N/A IL N/A IL
C ISO/R3 N/A IL N/A IL
I : 9 to 18 kg
D ISO/R2 N/A IL N/A IL
C ISO/R3 N/A IL N/A IL
B ISO/F2 N/A IUF, IL N/A IUF, IL
B1 ISO/F2X N/A IUF, IL N/A IUF, IL
A ISO/F3 N/A IUF, IL N/A IUF, IL
IUF = Suitable for ISOFIX forward child restraints systems of universal category approved for use in the mass group.
IL = Suitable for particular ISOFIX child restraints systems (CRS) given in the attached list. These ISOFIX CRS are those of the
“specific vehicle”, “restricted” or “semi-universal” categories.
X = ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint system in this mass group and/or this size class.
3-35
03
Installing a child restraint system by
lap/shoulder belt
E2MS103005
E2MS103005
To install a child restraint system on the
outboard or center rear seats, do the
following:
1. Place the child restraint system in
the seat and route the lap/shoulder
belt around or through the restraint,
following the restraint manufacturer’s
instructions. Be sure the seat belt
webbing is not twisted.
E2BLD310
E2BLD310
2. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch
into the buckle. Listen for the distinct
“Click” sound.
Position the release button so that it is
easy to access in case of an emergency.
MMSA3030
MMSA3030
3. Buckle the seat belt and allow the
seat belt to take up any slack. After
installation of the child restraint
system, try to move it in all directions
to be sure the child restraint system is
securely installed.
If you need to tighten the belt, pull more
webbing toward the retractor. When you
unbuckle the seat belt and allow it to
retract, the retractor will automatically
revert back to its normal seated
passenger emergency locking usage
condition.
3-36
Safety System
Child Seat Restraint for Vehicle ISOFIX Positions
Suitability of each seating position for ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems according to ECE regulations.
Use Child Restraint Systems that have been officially approved and are appropriate for your children.
When using the Child Restraint Systems, refer to the following table.
Mass Group
Seating Position (or other side)
Front Passenger Rear Outboard Rear Centre Immediate
Outboard
Immediate
Centre
Group 0 Up to 10 kg X U X - -
Group 0+ Up to 13 kg X U X - -
Group I 9 to 18 kg X U X - -
Group II 15 to 25 kg X U X - -
Group III 22 to 36 kg X U X - -
U = Suitable for “universal” category Child Restraints Systems approved for use in this mass group.
UF = Suitable for forward facing “universal” category restraints for use in this mass group.
X = Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
3-37
03
$,5%$*ǘ6833/(0(17$/5(675$,176<67(0ǣ656Ǥ
1. Driver’s front airbag
2. Passenger’s front airbag
3. Side airbag
4. Curtain airbag*
* : if equipped
The actual airbags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAI3039019
OAI3039019
3-38
Safety System
WARNING
Even in vehicles with airbags, you
and your passengers must always
wear the safety belts provided
in order to minimize the risk and
severity of injury in the event of a
collision or rollover.
SRS and pretensioners contain
explosive chemicals.
If scraping a vehicle without
removing SRS and pretensioners
from a vehicle, it may cause fire.
Before scraping a vehicle, we
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Keep the SRS parts and wirings away
from water or any liquid. If the SRS
components are inoperative due to
exposure to water or liquids, it may
cause fire or severe injury.
How does the airbag system
operate
Airbags are activated (able to inflate
if necessary) only when the ignition
switch is placed to the ON or START
position.
Airbags inflate instantly in the event of
serious frontal or side collision in order
to help protect the occupants from
serious physical injury.
There is no single speed at which the
airbags will inflate.
Generally, airbags are designed to
inflate based upon the severity of a
collision and its direction. These two
factors determine whether the sensors
produce an electronic deployment/
inflation signal.
Airbag deployment depends on a
number of factors including vehicle
speed, angles of impact and the
density and stiffness of the vehicles or
objects which your vehicle hits in the
collision. The determining, factors are
not limited to those mentioned above.
The front airbags will completely
inflate and deflate in an instant.
It is virtually impossible for you to see
the airbags inflate during an accident.
It is much more likely that you will
simply see the deflated airbags
hanging out of their storage
compartments after the collision.
3-39
03
In order to help provide protection
in a severe collision, the airbags
must inflate rapidly. The speed of
airbag inflation is a consequence
of extremely short time in which a
collision occurs and the need to get
the airbag between the occupant
and the vehicle structures before the
occupant impacts those structures.
This speed of inflation reduces the risk
of serious or life-threatening injuries
in a severe collision and is thus a
necessary part of airbag design.
However, airbag inflation can also
cause injuries which can include facial
abrasions, bruises and broken bones
because the inflation speed also
causes the airbags to expand with a
great deal of force.
There are even circumstances under
which contact with the steering
wheel airbag can cause fatal injuries,
especially if the occupant is positioned
excessively close to the steering
wheel.
WARNING
To avoid severe personal injury or
death caused by deploying airbags in
a collision, the driver should sit as far
back from the steering wheel airbag
as possible. The front passenger
should always move their seat as far
back as possible and sit back in their
seat.
Airbag inflates instantly in an event
of a collision, passengers may be
injured by the airbag expansion force
if they are not in a proper position.
Airbag inflation may cause injuries
including facial or bodily abrasions,
injuries from broken glasses or burns.
3-40
Safety System
Noise and smoke
When the airbags inflate, they make a
loud noise and they leave smoke and
powder in the air inside of the vehicle.
This is normal and is a result of the
ignition of the airbag inflator. After the
airbag inflates, you may feel substantial
discomfort in breathing due to the
contact of your chest with both the
seat belt and the airbag, as well as from
breathing the smoke and powder. Open
your doors and/or windows as soon as
possible after impact in order to reduce
discomfort and prevent prolonged
exposure to the smoke and powder.
Though smoke and powder are non-
toxic, it may cause irritation to the skin
(eyes, nose and throat, etc.). If this is
the case, wash and rinse with cold water
immediately and consult with the doctor
if the symptom persists.
WARNING
When the airbags deploy, the airbag
related parts in the steering wheel
are very hot. To prevent injury, do not
touch the airbag storage area’s internal
components immediately after an
airbag has inflated.
Do not install a child restraint on
the front passenger’s seat
(if equipped)
OYDESA2042
OYDESA2042
Never place a rear-facing child restraint
in the front passenger’s seat. If the
airbag deploys, it would impact the rear-
facing child restraint, causing serious or
fatal injury.
In addition, do not place front-facing
child restraints in the front passenger’s
seat either. If the front passenger airbag
inflates, it would cause serious or fatal
injuries to the child.
3-41
03
WARNING
NEVER use a rearward facing child
restraint on a seat protected by an
ACTIVE Airbag in front of it, DEATH
or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can
occur.
Never put a child restraint in the
front passenger’s seat. If the front
passenger airbag inflates, it would
cause serious or fatal injuries.
Airbag warning and indicator
Airbag warning light
:ǘ
:ǘ
The purpose of the airbag warning light
in your instrument panel is to alert you
of a potential problem with your airbag -
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS).
When the ignition switch is turned ON,
the warning light should illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds, then go off.
Have the system checked if:
The light does not turn on briefly when
you turn the ignition ON.
The light stays on after illuminating for
approximately 6 seconds.
The light comes on while the vehicle is
in motion.
The light blinks when the ignition
switch is in ON position.
3-42
Safety System
SRS components and functions
OBI3030006
OBI3030006
The SRS consists of the following
components:
(1) Driver’s front airbag module
(2) Passenger’s front airbag module
(3) Pre-tensioner seatbelt system
(4) Airbag warning light
(5) SRS control module (SRSCM)
(6) Front impact Sensor
(7) Side airbag modules
(8) Curtain airbag modules *
(9) Side impact sensors
* : if equipped
The SRSCM continuously monitors all
SRS components while the ignition
switch is ON to determine if a crash
impact is severe enough to require
airbag deployment or pre-tensioner seat
belt deployment.
The SRS airbag warning light on the
instrument panel will illuminate for
about 6 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned to the ON position, after which
the airbag warning light should go out.
WARNING
If any of the following conditions
occurs, this indicates a malfunction
of the SRS. We recommend that the
system be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
The light does not turn on briefly
when you turn the ignition ON.
The light stays on after illuminating
for approximately 6 seconds.
The light comes on while the vehicle
is in motion.
The light blinks when the ignition
switch is in ON position.
3-43
03
B240B01L
B240B01L
Driver's front airbag (1)
Driver's front airbag (1)
The airbag modules are located both in
the center of the steering wheel and in
the front passenger’s panel above the
glove box. When the SRSCM detects a
sufficiently severe impact to the front of
the vehicle, it will automatically deploy
the front airbags.
B240B02L
B240B02L
Driver's front airbag (2)
Driver's front airbag (2)
Upon deployment, tear seams molded
directly into the pad covers will separate
under pressure from the expansion
of the airbags. Further opening of the
covers then allows full inflation of the
airbags.
B240B03L
B240B03L
Driver's front airbag (3)
Driver's front airbag (3)
A fully inflated airbag, in combination
with a properly worn seat belt, slows the
driver’s or the passenger’s forward
motion, reducing the risk of head and
chest injury.
After complete inflation, the airbag
immediately starts deflating, enabling
the driver to maintain forward visibility
and the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
3-44
Safety System
B240B05L
B240B05L
Passenger’s front airbag
Passenger’s front airbag
WARNING
Do not install or place any
accessories (drink holder, cassette
holder, sticker, etc.) on the front
passenger’s panel above the glove
box in a vehicle with a passenger’s
airbag. Such objects may become
dangerous projectiles and cause
injury if the passenger’s airbag
inflates.
When installing a container of liquid
air freshener inside the vehicle, do
not place it near the instrument
cluster nor on the instrument panel
surface.
It may become a dangerous projectile
and cause injury if the passenger’s
airbag inflates.
WARNING
If an airbag deploys, there may
be a loud noise followed by a fine
dust released in the vehicle. These
conditions are normal and are not
hazardous - the airbags are packed in
this fine powder. The dust generated
during airbag deployment may
cause skin or eye irritation as well as
aggravate asthma for some persons.
Always wash all exposed skin areas
thoroughly with cold water and a
mild soap after an accident in which
the airbags were deployed.
The SRS can function only when the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
Before you replace a fuse or
disconnect a battery terminal, turn
the ignition switch to the OFF/LOCK
position and remove the ignition key.
Never remove or replace the airbag
related fuse(s) when the ignition
switch is in the ON position. Failure to
heed this warning will cause the SRS
airbag warning light to illuminate.
3-45
03
Driver’s and passenger’s front
airbag
OAI3033020
OAI3033020
Driver’s front airbag
Driver’s front airbag
Passenger’s front airbag
Passenger’s front airbag
OAI3039021
OAI3039021
Your vehicle is equipped with a
Supplemental Restraint (Airbag) System
and lap/shoulder belts at both the driver
and passenger seating positions.
The indications of the system’s presence
are the letters “Airbag” engraved on the
airbag pad cover in the steering wheel
and the passenger’s side front panel pad
above the glove box.
The SRS consists of airbags installed
under the pad covers in the center of the
steering wheel and the passenger’s side
front panel above the glove box.
The purpose of the SRS is to provide
the vehicle’s driver and/or the front
passenger with additional protection
than that offered by the seat belt system
alone in case of a frontal impact of
sufficient severity.
WARNING
Always use seat belts and child
restraints – every trip, every time,
everyone! Airbags inflate with
considerable force and in the blink of
an eye. Seat belts help keep occupants
in proper position to obtain maximum
benefit from the airbag. Even with
airbags, improperly and unbelted
occupants can be severely injured
when the airbag inflates. Always follow
the precautions about seat belts,
airbags and occupant safety contained
in this manual.
To reduce the chance of serious or
fatal injuries and receive the maximum
safety benefit from your restraint
system:
Never place a child in any child or
booster seat in the front seat.
ABC – Always Buckle Children in the
back seat. It is the safest place for
children of any age to ride.
Airbags can injure occupants
improperly positioned in the front
seats.
Move your seat as far back as
practical from the front airbags,
while still maintaining control of the
vehicle.
You and your passengers should
never sit or lean unnecessarily close
to the airbags. Improperly positioned
drivers and passengers can be
severely injured by inflating airbags.
3-46
Safety System
Never lean against the door or center
console – always sit in an upright
position.
No objects (such as crash pad cover,
cellular phone holder, cup holder,
air fresheners or stickers) should
be placed over or near the airbag
modules on the steering wheel,
instrument panel, windshield glass,
and the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box. Such objects
could cause harm if the vehicle is in
a crash severe enough to cause the
airbags to deploy.
Do not attach any objects on the
front windshield and inside mirror.
Do not tamper with or disconnect
SRS wiring or other components
of the SRS system. Doing so could
result in injury, due to accidental
deployment of the airbags or by
rendering the SRS inoperative.
If the SRS airbag warning light
remains illuminated while the vehicle
is being driven, we recommend
that the system be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Airbags can only be used once – we
recommend that the system be
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
The SRS is designed to deploy the
front airbags only when an impact is
sufficiently severe. Additionally, the
airbags will only deploy once. Seat
belts must be worn at all times.
Front airbags are not intended to
deploy in side-impact, rear-impact
or rollover crashes. In addition, front
airbags will not deploy in frontal
crashes below the deployment
threshold.
A child restraint system must never
be placed in the front seat. The infant
or child could be severely injured or
killed by an airbag deployment in
case of an accident.
Children age 12 and under must
always be properly restrained in the
rear seat. Never allow children to ride
in the front passenger seat. If a child
over 12 must be seated in the front
seat, move the seat as far back as
possible. And the child must always
be restrained in the seat properly.
For maximum safety protection in
all types of crashes, all occupants
including the driver should always
wear their seat belts whether or not
an airbag is also provided at their
seating position to minimize the
risk of severe injury or death in the
event of a crash. Do not sit or lean
unnecessarily close to the airbag
while the vehicle is in motion.
Sitting improperly or out of position
can result in serious or fatal injury
in a crash. All occupants should sit
upright with the seat back in an
upright position, centered on the seat
cushion with their seat belt on, legs
comfortably extended and their feet
on the floor until the vehicle is parked
and the ignition key is removed.
The SRS airbag system must deploy
very rapidly to provide protection
in a crash. If an occupant is out of
position because of not wearing a
seat belt, the airbag may forcefully
contact the occupant causing serious
or fatal injuries.
3-47
03
Why didn’t my airbag go off in a
collision? (Inflation and non-inflation
conditions of the airbag)
There are many types of accidents
in which the airbag would not be
expected to provide additional
protection.
These include rear impacts, the
second or third collisions in multiple
impact accidents, as well as low speed
impacts.
Side airbag
OIB034021
OIB034021
OJK032063
OJK032063
The actual airbags in the vehicle may differ
from the illustration.
Your vehicle is equipped with a side
airbag in each front seat.
The purpose of the airbag is to provide
the vehicle’s driver and/or the front
passenger with additional protection
than that offered by the seat belt alone.
The side airbags are designed to
deploy only during certain side-
impact collisions, depending on the
crash severity, angle, speed and point
of impact. The side airbags are not
designed to deploy in all side impact
situations.
WARNING
Do not allow the passengers to lean
their heads or bodies onto doors,
put their arms on the doors, stretch
their arms out of the window, or
place objects between the doors and
passengers when they are seated
on seats equipped with side and/or
curtain airbags.
WARNING
The side airbag is supplemental to
the driver’s and the passenger’s seat
belt systems and is not a substitute
for them. Therefore, your seat belts
must be worn at all times while the
vehicle is in motion. The airbags
deploy only in certain side impact
conditions severe enough to cause
significant injury to the vehicle
occupants.
For best protection from the side
airbag system and to avoid being
injured by the deploying side airbag,
both front seat occupants should sit
in an upright position with the seat
belt properly fastened. The driver’s
hands should be placed on the
steering wheel at the 9:00 and 3:00
positions. The passenger’s arms and
hands should be placed on their laps.
Do not use any accessory seat covers.
Use of seat covers could reduce or
prevent the effectiveness of the
system.
Do not install any accessories on the
side or near the side airbag.
3-48
Safety System
Do not place any objects over the
airbag or between the airbag and
yourself. Also, do not attach any
objects around the area the airbag
inflates such as the door, side door
glass, front and rear pillar.
Do not place any objects between the
door and the seat. They may become
dangerous projectiles if the side
airbag inflates.
Do not put any objects between the
side airbag label and seat cushion. It
could cause harm if the vehicle is in
a crash severe enough to cause the
airbags to deploy.
To prevent unexpected deployment
of the side airbag that may result in
personal injury, avoid impact to the
side impact sensor when the ignition
switch is on.
If the seat or seat cover is damaged,
we recommend that the system
serviced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Inform the dealer that your vehicle is
equipped with side airbags.
Curtain airbag (if equipped)
OQXI039024
OQXI039024
OTM030030
OTM030030
The actual airbags in the vehicle may differ
from the illustration.
Curtain airbags are located along both
sides of the roof rails above the front
and rear doors.
They are designed to help protect the
heads of the front seat occupants and
the rear outboard seat occupants in
certain side impact collisions.
The curtain airbags are designed to
deploy only during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity, angle, speed and impact.
The curtain airbags are not designed
to deploy in all side impact situations,
collisions from the front or rear of the
vehicle or in most rollover situations.
3-49
03
WARNING
In order for side impact and
curtain airbags to provide the best
protection, both front seat occupants
and both outboard rear occupants
should sit in an upright position with
the seat belts properly fastened.
Importantly, children should sit in a
proper child restraint system in the
rear seat.
When children are seated in the rear
outboard seats, they must be seated
in the proper child restraint system.
Make sure to put the child restraint
system as far away from the door
side as possible, and secure the child
restraint system in a locked position.
Do not place any objects over the
airbag. Also, do not attach any
objects around the area the airbag
inflates such as the door, side door
glass, front and rear pillars, roof side
rail.
Do not hang other objects except
clothes, especially hard or breakable
objects. In an accident, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury.
Do not allow the passengers to lean
their heads or bodies onto doors,
put their arms on the doors, stretch
their arms out of the window, or
place objects between the doors and
passengers when they are seated
on seats equipped with side and/or
curtain airbags.
Do not attempt to open or repair
the side curtain airbags yourself. If
necessary, we recommend that the
airbag be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Never try to open or repair any
components of the side curtain
airbag system. We recommend
that the system be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Failure to follow the above mentioned
instructions can result in injury or death
to the vehicle occupants in an accident.
Why didn’t my airbag go off in a
collision? (Inflation and non-inflation
conditions of the airbag)
There are many types of accidents
in which the airbag would not be
expected to provide additional
protection.
These include rear impacts, the
second or third collisions in multiple
impact accidents, as well as low speed
impacts.
3-50
Safety System
Airbag inflation conditions
OAI3032022/OAI3039024/OAI3033023L/OBI3030014L
OAI3032022/OAI3039024/OAI3033023L/OBI3030014L
5 Door
5 Door
(1) SRS control module
(2) Front impact sensor
(3) Side impact sensor*
* : if equipped
3-51
03
OAI3032042/OAI3039024/OAI3033043L/OBI3030014L
OAI3032042/OAI3039024/OAI3033043L/OBI3030014L
4 Door
4 Door
(1) SRS control module
(2) Front impact sensor
(3) Side impact sensor*
* : if equipped
3-52
Safety System
WARNING
Do not hit or allow any objects to
impact the locations where airbags
or sensors are installed.
This may cause unexpected airbag
deployment, which could result in
serious personal injury or death.
If the installation location or angle of
the sensors is altered in any way, the
airbags may deploy when they should
not or they may not deploy when
they should, causing severe injury or
death.
Therefore, do not try to perform
maintenance on or around the airbag
sensors. We recommend that the
system be serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Problems may arise if the sensor
installation angles are changed
due to the deformation of the front
bumper and body. We recommend
that the system be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Your vehicle has been designed
to absorb impact and deploy the
airbag(s) in certain collisions.
Installing aftermarket bumper guards
or replacing a bumper with non-
genuine parts may adversely affect
your vehicles collision and airbag
deployment performance.
Airbag inflation conditions
OAI3039025
OAI3039025
Front airbags
Front airbags are designed to inflate in
certain frontal collision depending on
the crash severity, speed or angles of
impact of the front collision.
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved roads
or sidewalks, airbags may deploy.
Drive carefully on unimproved roads
or on surfaces not designed for vehicle
traffic to prevent unintended airbag
deployment.
3-53
03
OAI3032028
OAI3032028
OQXI039025
OQXI039025
Side airbags (if equipped)
Side airbags (side impact and/or curtain
airbags) are designed to inflate when
an impact is detected by side collision
sensors depending on the crash severity,
speed or angles of impact resulting from
a side impact collision.
Although the front airbags (driver’s and
front passenger’s airbags) are designed
to inflate only in frontal collisions,
they also may inflate in other types of
collisions if the front impact sensor
detects a sufficient impact. Side airbags
(side impact and/or curtain airbags) are
designed to inflate only in side impact
collisions, but they may inflate in other
collisions if the side impact sensors
detect a sufficient impact.
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved roads
or sidewalks, airbags may deploy.
Drive carefully on unimproved roads
or on surfaces not designed for vehicle
traffic to prevent unintended airbag
deployment.
Airbag non-inflation conditions
OAI3039026
OAI3039026
In certain low-speed collisions, the
airbags may not deploy. The airbags
are designed not to deploy in such
cases because they may not provide
benefits beyond the protection of the
seat belts in such collisions.
OAI3039027
OAI3039027
Front airbags are not designed to
inflate in rear collisions, because
occupants are moved backward by
the force of the impact. In this case,
inflated airbags would not be able to
provide any additional benefit.
3-54
Safety System
OAI3032028
OAI3032028
Front airbags may not inflate in side
impact collisions, because occupants
move to the direction of the collision,
and thus in side impacts, frontal
airbag deployment would not provide
additional occupant protection.
OGB034038
OGB034038
In a slant or angled collision, the force
of impact may direct the occupants in
a direction where the airbags would
not be able to provide any additional
benefit, and thus the sensors may not
deploy any airbags.
OAI3039029
OAI3039029
Just before impact, drivers often brake
heavily. Such heavy braking lowers the
front portion of the vehicle causing
it to “ride” under a vehicle with a
higher ground clearance. Airbags
may not inflate in this “under-ride”
situation because deceleration forces
that are detected by sensor may be
significantly reduced by such “under-
ride” collisions.
OHI038166
OHI038166
Airbags do not inflate in rollover
accidents because the vehicle can not
detect rollover accident.
However, side and/or curtain airbags
may inflate when the vehicle is rolled
over after side impact collision.
3-55
03
OAI3032030
OAI3032030
Airbags may not inflate if the vehicle
collides with objects such as utility
poles or trees, where the point of
impact is concentrated and the
collision energy is absorbed by the
vehicle structure.
SRS Care
The SRS is virtually maintenance free
and so there are no parts you can
safely service by yourself. If the SRS
airbag warning light does not Illuminate
approximately 6sec after ignition switch
turned ON, or continuously remains
on, we recommend that the system be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
We recommend that the any work on the
SRS system, such as removing, installing
or repairing, or any work on the steering
wheel, the front passenger’s panel, front
seats or roof rails be performed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Improper
handling of the SRS system may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING
Modification to SRS components
or wiring, including the addition
of any kind of badges to the pad
covers or modifications to the body
structure, can adversely affect SRS
performance and lead to possible
injury.
For cleaning the airbag pad covers,
use only a soft, dry cloth or one which
has been moistened with plain water.
Solvents or cleaners could adversely
affect the airbag covers and proper
deployment of the system.
3-56
Safety System
No objects should be placed over
or near the airbag modules on the
steering wheel, instrument panel,
and the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box, because any
such object could cause harm if the
vehicle is in a crash severe enough to
cause the airbags to inflate.
If the airbags inflate, we recommend
that the system be replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not tamper with or disconnect
SRS wiring, or other components of
the SRS system. Doing so could result
in injury, due to accidental inflation
of the airbags or by rendering the
SRS inoperative.
If components of the airbag system
must be discarded, or if the vehicle
must be scrapped, certain safety
precautions must be observed. An
authorized HYUNDAI dealer knows
these precautions and can give you
the necessary information. Failure
to follow these precautions and
procedures could increase the risk of
personal injury.
If your car was flooded and has
soaked carpeting or water on the
flooring, you shouldn’t try to start
the engine; we recommend that
you contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Additional safety precautions
Never let passengers ride in the cargo
area or on top of a folded-down back
seat. All occupants should sit upright,
fully back in their seats with their seat
belts on and their feet on the floor.
Passengers should not move out of
or change seats while the vehicle
is moving. A passenger who is not
wearing a seat belt during a crash
or emergency stop can be thrown
against the inside of the vehicle,
against other occupants, or out of the
vehicle.
Each seat belt is designed to restrain
one occupant. If more than one
person uses the same seat belt, they
could be seriously injured or killed in a
collision.
Do not use any accessories on seat
belts. Devices claiming to improve
occupant comfort or reposition the
seat belt can reduce the protection
provided by the seat belt and increase
the chance of serious injury in a crash.
Passengers should not place hard or
sharp objects between themselves
and the airbags. Carrying hard or
sharp objects on your lap or in your
mouth can result in injuries if an airbag
inflates.
Keep occupants away from the
airbag covers. All occupants should sit
upright, fully back in their seats with
their seat belts on and their feet on the
floor. If occupants are too close to the
airbag covers, they could be injured if
the airbags inflate.
3-57
03
Do not attach or place objects on or
near the airbag covers. Any object
attached to or placed on the front
airbag covers could interfere with the
proper operation of the airbags.
Do not modify the front seats.
Modification of the front seats could
interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components in the airbags.
Do not place items under the
front seats. Placing items under
the front seats could interfere with
the operation of the supplemental
restraint system sensing components
and wiring harnesses.
Never hold an infant or child on
your lap. The infant or child could be
seriously injured or killed in the event
of a crash. All infants and children
should be properly restrained in
appropriate child safety seats or seat
belts in the rear seat.
WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position
can cause occupants to be shifted
too close to a deploying airbag, strike
the interior structure or be thrown
from the vehicle resulting in serious
injury or death.
Always sit upright with the seatback
in an upright position, centered on
the seat cushion with your seat belt
on, legs comfortably extended and
your feet on the floor.
Adding equipment to or modifying
your airbag-equipped vehicle
If you modify your vehicle by changing
your vehicle’s frame, bumper system,
front end or side sheet metal or ride
height, this may affect the operation of
your vehicle’s airbag system.
3-58
Safety System
Airbag warning label
OAC3039035R
OAC3039035R
Airbag warning labels are attached
to alert the driver and passengers of
potential risks of the airbag system. Be
sure to read all of the information about
the airbags that are installed on your
vehicle in this Owner’s Manual.
Instrument cluster ..........................................................................................4-2
Gauges ....................................................................................................................... 4-4
Instrument cluster control ........................................................................................4-4
Transmission shift indicator ......................................................................................4-9
Warning and indicator lights ...................................................................................4-10
Cluster display messages ........................................................................................4-19
Cluster display (cluster type B) ....................................................................4-23
Cluster display control ............................................................................................ 4-23
Cluster display modes............................................................................................. 4-24
User settings mode .................................................................................................4-26
Trip computer ................................................................................................4-30
Cluster type A ..........................................................................................................4-30
Cluster type B .......................................................................................................... 4-35
4. Instrument Cluster
4
4-2
Instrument Cluster
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
1. Tachometer
2. Speedometer
3. Fuel gauge
4. Warning and indicator lights
5. Trip mode/reset button
The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more details, refer to the “Gauges” in this chapter.
Type A
Type A
OAI3043001
OAI3043001
4-3
04
Type B
Type B
OAI3043033
OAI3043033
1. Tachometer
2. Speedometer
3. Engine coolant temperature gauge
4. Fuel gauge
5. Warning and indicator lights
6. Cluster display (including Trip computer)
The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more details, refer to the “Gauges” in this chapter.
4-4
Instrument Cluster
Instrument Cluster Control
WARNING
Never adjust the instrument cluster
while driving. This could result in loss
of control and lead to an accident that
may cause death, serious injury, or
property damage.
Gauges
Speedometer
OAI3049003
OAI3049003
Type A
Type A
OAI3042032
OAI3042032
Type B
Type B
The speedometer indicates the speed
of the vehicle and is calibrated in
kilometers per hour (km/h).
4-5
04
Tachometer
OAI3049005
OAI3049005
Type A
Type A
OJS048103
OJS048103
Type B
Type B
The tachometer indicates the
approximate number of engine
revolutions per minute (RPM).
Use the tachometer to select the correct
shift points and to prevent lugging and/
or over-revving the engine.
NOTICE
Do not operate the engine within the
tachometer’s RED ZONE. This may
cause severe engine damage.
Fuel Gauge
OAI3049007
OAI3049007
Type A
Type A
OJS048103
OJS048103
Type B
Type B
This gauge indicates the approximate
amount of fuel remaining in the fuel
tank.
4-6
Instrument Cluster
i Information
The fuel tank capacity is given in
chapter 2.
The fuel gauge is supplemented by
a low fuel warning light, which will
illuminate when the fuel tank is nearly
empty.
On inclines or curves, the fuel gauge
pointer may fluctuate or the low fuel
warning light may come on earlier than
usual due to the movement of fuel in the
tank.
WARNING
Running out of fuel can expose vehicle
occupants to danger.
You must stop and obtain additional
fuel as soon as possible after the
warning light comes on or when the
gauge indicator comes close to the “E
(Empty)” level.
NOTICE
Avoid driving with a very low fuel
level. Running out of fuel could cause
the engine to misfire damaging the
catalytic converter.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
(if equipped)
OJS048104
OJS048104
This gauge shows the temperature of the
engine coolant when the ignition switch
is in the ON position.
NOTICE
If the gauge pointer moves beyond
the normal range area toward the “H”
position, it indicates overheating that
may damage the engine.
Do not continue driving with an
overheated engine. If your vehicle
overheats, refer to the “If the Engine
Overheats” in chapter 8.
WARNING
Never remove the radiator cap or
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
The engine coolant is under pressure
and could cause severe burns. Wait
until the engine is cool before adding
coolant to the reservoir.
4-7
04
Odometer
OAI3049009
OAI3049009
Type A
Type A
OIG046114
OIG046114
Type B
Type B
The odometer indicates the total
distance that the vehicle has been
driven and should be used to determine
when periodic maintenance should be
performed.
- Odometer range : 0 ~ 1599999
kilometers or 999999 miles.
i Information
It is forbidden to alter the odometer of
all vehicles with the intent to change
the mileage registered on the odometer.
The alteration may void your warranty
coverage.
4-8
Instrument Cluster
Outside Temperature Gauge
OAI3049011
OAI3049011
Type A
Type A
OTM048112
OTM048112
Type B
Type B
This gauge indicates the current outside
air temperatures by 1 °C (1 °F).
- Temperature range : -40 °C ~ 85 °C
(-40 °F ~ 211 °F)
The outside temperature on the display
may not change immediately like a
general thermometer to prevent the
driver from being inattentive.
You can change the temperature unit
(from °C to °F or from °F to °C) in the
press the TRIP button for more than 5
seconds on the Cluster. (Type A, B, if
equipped)
The temperature unit (from °C to °F or
from °F to °C) can be changed as below
procedures. (Type C, if equipped)
- User Settings Mode in the Cluster : You
can change the temperature unit in the
“Other Features – Temperature unit”.
4-9
04
Transmission Shift Indicator
Automated manual transmission
Shift Indicator (if equipped)
OAI3049013
OAI3049013
Type A
Type A
OTL045132
OTL045132
Type B
Type B
This indicator displays which Automated
Manual Transmission shift lever is
selected.
• Park : P
• Reverse : R
• Neutral : N
Drive : D1, D2, D3, D4, D5
Manual Mode : 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
Manual transmission Shift Indicator
(if equipped)
OAI3049015
OAI3049015
Type A
Type A
OPDE046142
OPDE046142
Type B
Type B
This indicator informs which gear is
recommended while driving, to save
fuel.
• Shifting up : 2, 3, 4, 5
• Shifting down :1, 2, 3, 4
4-10
Instrument Cluster
For example
: Indicates that shifting up to the 3rd
gear is recommended (currently the
shift lever is in the 2nd or 1st gear).
: Indicates that shifting down to the
3rd gear is recommended (currently
the shift lever is in the 4th or 5th
gear).
When the system is not working
properly, the indicator is not displayed.
Warning and indicator lights
i Information
Make sure that all warning lights are
OFF after starting the engine. If any light
is still ON, this indicates a situation that
needs attention.
Airbag Warning Light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 6
seconds and then goes off.
When there is a malfunction with the
SRS.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-11
04
Seat Belt Warning Light
This warning light informs the driver (or
front passenger) that the seat belt is not
fastened.
For more details, refer to the “Seat
Belts” in chapter 3.
Parking Brake & Brake
Fluid Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds
- It remains on if the parking brake is
applied.
When the parking brake is applied.
When the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
- If the warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates the brake fluid level is low.
If the brake fluid level in the reser-
voir is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. With the engine stopped, check the
brake fluid level immediately and add
fluid as required (For more details,
refer to “Brake Fluid” in chapter 9).
Then check all brake components for
fluid leaks. If any leak on the brake
system is still found, the warning
light remains on, or the brakes do not
operate properly, do not drive the
vehicle.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle towed to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
inspected.
Dual-diagonal braking system
Your vehicle is equipped with dual-
diagonal braking systems. This means
you still have braking on two wheels
even if one of the dual systems should
fail.
With only one of the dual systems
working, more than normal pedal travel
and greater pedal pressure are required
to stop the vehicle.
Also, the vehicle will not stop in as short
a distance with only a portion of the
brake system working.
If the brakes fail while you are driving,
shift to a lower gear for additional
engine braking and stop the vehicle as
soon as it is safe to do so.
4-12
Instrument Cluster
WARNING
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning
Light
Driving the vehicle with a warning light
ON is dangerous. If the Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid Warning Light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid level is
low.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
When there is a malfunction with
the ABS (The normal braking system
will still be operational without the
assistance of the anti-lock brake
system).
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Motor Driven Power
Steering (MDPS) Warning
Light (if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
When there is a malfunction with the
MDPS.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL)
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
When there is a malfunction with the
emission control system.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-13
04
NOTICE
- Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
Driving with the Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) on may
cause damage to the emission
control systems which could effect
drivability and/or fuel economy.
NOTICE
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) illuminates, potential catalytic
converter damage is possible which
could result in loss of engine power.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
Charging System
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It remains on until the engine is
started.
When there is a malfunction with
either the alternator or electrical
charging system.
If there is a malfunction with either
the alternator or electrical charging
system:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and check the
alternator drive belt for looseness or
breakage.
If the belt is adjusted properly, there
may be a problem in the electrical
charging system.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
Engine Oil Pressure
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
Once you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It remains on until the engine is
started.
When the engine oil pressure is low.
If the engine oil pressure is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and check the
engine oil level (For more details, refer
to “Engine Oil” in chapter 9). If the
level is low, add oil as required.
If the warning light remains on after
adding oil or if oil is not available, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
Continued driving with the warning
light on may cause engine failure.
4-14
Instrument Cluster
NOTICE
If the engine does not stop
immediately after the Engine Oil
Pressure Warning Light is illuminated,
severe damage could result.
If the warning light stays on while the
engine is running, it indicates that
there may be serious engine damage
or malfunction. In this case,
1. Stop the vehicle as soon as it is safe
to do so.
2. Turn off the engine and check the
oil level. If the oil level is low, fill the
engine oil to the proper level.
3. Start the engine again. If the
warning light stays on after the
engine is started, turn the engine
off immediately. In this case, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Engine has Overheated
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates with a
warning chime when the engine coolant
temperature is above 120°C (248°F).
It remains on if the engine coolant
temperature is above 120°C (248°F). This
means that the engine is overheated and
may be damaged.
If your vehicle is overheated, refer to “If
the Engine Overheats” in chapter 8.
Low Fuel Level Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates:
When the fuel tank is nearly empty.
If the fuel tank is nearly empty, add fuel
as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Low Fuel Level
Driving with the Low Fuel Level
warning light on or with the fuel level
below “E (Empty)” can cause the
engine to misfire and damage the
catalytic converter (if equipped).
4-15
04
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) Indicator
Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
When you set the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
When there is a malfunction with the
ESC system.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
While the ESC is operating.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” in chapter 6.
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) OFF
Indicator Light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
When you set the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately
3 seconds and then goes off.
When you deactivate the ESC system
by pressing the ESC OFF button.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” in chapter 6.
Door Ajar Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
When a door is not close securely.
Tailgate/Trunk Open
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
When the tailgate/trunk is not close
securely.
Hood Open Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates:
When the hood is not close securely.
Immobilizer Indicator
Light (without smart key)
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
When the vehicle detects the
immobilizer in your key properly while
the ignition switch is ON.
- At this time, you can start the engine.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks:
When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-16
Instrument Cluster
Immobilizer Indicator
Light (with smart key)
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates for up
to 30 seconds:
When the vehicle detects the smart key
in the vehicle properly while the Engine
Start/Stop button is ACC or ON.
- At this time, you can start the engine.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks for a few
seconds:
When the smart key is not in the vehicle.
- At this time, you can not start the
engine.
This indicator light illuminates for 2
seconds and goes off:
When the vehicle can not detect the
smart key which is in the vehicle while
the Engine Start/Stop button is ON.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
When the battery of the smart key is
weak.
- At this time, you can not start the
engine. However, you can start the
engine if you press the Engine Start/
Stop button with the smart key. (For
more details, refer to “Starting the
Engine” in chapter 6).
When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Turn Signal Indicator
Light
This indicator light blinks:
When you turn the turn signal light on.
If any of the following occurs, there
may a malfunction with the turn signal
system. In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
- The indicator light does not blink but
illuminates.
- The indicator light blinks more rapidly.
- The indicator light does not illuminate
at all.
4-17
04
High Beam Indicator
Light
This indicator light illuminates:
When the headlights are on and in the
high beam position
When the turn signal lever is pulled
into the Flash-to-Pass position.
Light ON Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates:
When the Parking (Position) lights or
headlights are on.
Cruise Indicator Light (if
equipped)
Type A
Type A
CRUISE
This indicator light illuminates:
When Cruise Control system is enabled.
For more details, refer to “Cruise
Control” in chapter 7.
Master Warning Light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates :
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
malfunction (if equipped)
To identify the details of the warning,
look at the cluster display.
Cruise SET Indicator
Light (if equipped)
SET
This indicator light illuminates:
When the cruise control speed is set.
For more details, refer to “Cruise
Control” in chapter 7.
KEY OUT Indicator Light
(if equipped)
KEY
OUT
When the Engine Start/Stop button is
in the ACC or ON position, if any door is
open, the system checks for the smart
key.
This indicator light blinks:
When the smart key is not in the vehicle
and any door is open with the ignition
switch or the Engine Start/Stop button in
the ACC or ON position.
- At this time, if you close all doors,
the chime will also sound for
approximately 5 seconds.
- The indicator will go off while the
vehicle is moving.
Type B
Type B
4-18
Instrument Cluster
Press Brake
(for Automated Manual
Transmission)
This indicator light illuminates :
When changing gear position with out
pressing brake pedal
When trying to start the engine
without pressing brake pedal
Parking Brake Engaged
(for Automated Manual
Transmission)
This indicator light illuminates :
When engine is turned off without
engaging parking brake lever it
illuminates for approx. 5 seconds then
goes off
Clutch Over Heated
(for Automated Manual
Transmission) (if
equipped)
This indicator light illuminates :
When clutch estimated temperature rise
up to limited value
Low Tire Pressure
Warning Light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
When one or more of your tires
are significantly underinflated (The
location of the underinflated tire is
displayed on the Cluster display).
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 8.
This warning light remains on after
blinking for approximately 60 seconds
or repeatedly blinks on and off at
approximately 3 second intervals:
When there is a malfunction with the
TPMS.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 8.
WARNING
Safe Stopping
The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors.
If you notice any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off the
accelerator pedal, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
4-19
04
Cluster display messages
(if equipped)
Key not in vehicle
(for smart key system)
This warning message is displayed if the
smart key is not in the vehicle when you
open or close door in the ACC position
or ON position. The warning sound is
heard when you close door without a
smart key in vehicle.
When attempting to start the vehicle
always have the smart key with you.
Key not detected
(for smart key system)
This warning message is displayed if
the smart key is not detected when you
press the Engine Start/Stop button.
Press START button with key (for
smart key system)
This warning message is displayed if
you press the Engine Start/Stop button
while the warning message “Key not
detected” is displayed.
At this time, the immobilizer indicator
light blinks.
Low key battery
(for smart key system)
This warning message is displayed if the
battery of the smart key is discharged
while changing the Engine Start/Stop
button to the OFF position.
Press brake pedal to start engine
(for smart key system and
Automated manual transmission)
This warning message is displayed if the
Engine Start/Stop button changes to
the ACC position twice by pressing the
button repeatedly without depressing
the brake pedal.
You can start the vehicle by depressing
the brake pedal.
Press clutch pedal to start engine
(for smart key system and Manual
transmission)
This warning message is displayed if the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the ACC
position twice by pressing the button
repeatedly without depressing the clutch
pedal.
Depress the clutch pedal to start the
engine.
Press START button again
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if you were
unable to start the vehicle when the
Engine Start/Stop button was pressed.
If this occurs, attempt to start the engine
by pressing the Engine Start/Stop button
again.
If the warning message appears each
time you press the Engine Start/Stop
button, we recommend that you have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
4-20
Instrument Cluster
Shift to N to start engine
(for smart key system and
Automated manual transmission)
This warning message is displayed if
you try to start the engine with the shift
button not in the N (Neutral) position.
i Information
You can start the engine with the shift
lever in the N (Neutral) position.
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse (for
smart key system and Automated
manual transmission)
This warning message is displayed if the
brake switch fuse is disconnected.
You need to replace the fuse with a new
one. If that is not possible, you can start
the engine by pressing the Engine Start/
Stop button for 10 seconds in the ACC
position.
Turn on FUSE SWITCH
This warning message is displayed if
the fuse switch located on the fuse box
under the steering wheel is OFF.
You should turn the fuse switch on.
For more details, refer to “Fuses”
Section in chapter 9.
4-21
04
Low pressure (if equipped)
OBI3040008
OBI3040008
This warning message is displayed if the
tire pressure is low. The corresponding
tire on the vehicle will be illuminated.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 8.
Heated Steering Wheel turned off
(if equipped)
This message illuminates if the heated
steering wheel will turn off automatically
approximately 30 minutes after the
heated steering wheel is turned on.
For more details, refer to “Heated
Steering Wheel” in chapter 5.
Low fuel
This warning message is displayed if the
fuel tank is almost out of fuel.
When this message is displayed, the low
fuel level warning light in the cluster will
come on.
It is recommended to look for the
nearest fueling station and refuel as
soon as possible.
Low engine oil (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed when
the engine oil level should be checked.
If this warning message is displayed,
check the engine oil level as soon as
possible and add engine oil as required.
Slowly pour the recommended oil little
by little into a funnel.
Use only the specified engine oil. (Refer
to “Recommended lubricants and
capacities” section in chapter 2.)
Do not overfill the engine oil. Make sure
the oil level is not above F (Full) mark on
the dipstick.
NOTICE
If the message is displayed
continuously after adding the engine
oil and travelling approximately
50~100 km after the engine warms up,
we recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
4-22
Instrument Cluster
Engine has overheated
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed
when the engine coolant temperature is
above 120 °C (248 °F). This means that
the engine is overheated and may be
damaged.
If your vehicle is overheated, refer to
“Overheating” section in chapter 8.
Check headlight (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if the
headlamps are not operating properly.
In addition, if a specific lamp(turn signal
lamp etc.) is not operating properly, the
warning message according to a specific
lamp (turn signal lamp etc.) is displayed.
A corresponding bulb may need to be
replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same
wattage rating.
Check brake light (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if the
stop lamps are not operating properly. A
lamp may need to be replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same
wattage rating.
4-23
04
&/867(5',63/$<ǣ&/867(57<3(%Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Cluster display control
OAC3059002TU
OAC3059002TU
Type A
Type A
Type B
Type B
1
1
2
2
3
3
1
1
2
2
3
3
The Cluster display modes can be changed by using the control buttons.
(1) : MODE button for changing modes
(2) , : MOVE switch for changing items
(3) OK: SELECT/RESET button for setting or resetting the selected item
4-24
Instrument Cluster
Cluster display modes
Modes Symbol Explanation
Trip
Computer This mode displays driving information such as the tripmeter,
fuel economy, etc.
For more details, refer to "Trip Computer" in this chapter.
Driving
Assist Tire Pressure Monitoring System
User
Settings In this mode, you can change settings of the doors, lamps and etc.
Warning - This mode displays warning messages related to the
lamp malfunction, etc.
- Tire pressure information
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-25
04
Trip computer mode
OAC3069038TU
OAC3069038TU
The trip computer mode displays
information related to vehicle driving
parameters including fuel economy,
tripmeter information and vehicle speed.
For more details, refer to "Trip
Computer" in this chapter.
Driving Assist mode
OSU2I049054
OSU2I049054
Tire Pressure
This mode displays information related
to Tire Pressure.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” in chapter
8.
4-26
Instrument Cluster
Master warning
OBI3040018
OBI3040018
This warning light informs the driver the
following situations.
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
malfunction (if equipped)
The Master Warning Light illuminates
if one or more of the above warning
situations occur.
At this time, a Master Warning icon ( )
will appear beside the User Settings icon
(), on the Cluster display.
If the warning situation is solved, the
master warning light will be turned
off and the Master Warning icon will
disappear.
User settings mode
In this mode, you can change the
settings of the instrument cluster, doors,
lamps, etc.
1. Driver Assistance
2. Door
3. Light
4. Convenience
5. Service Interval
6. Other
7. Language
8. Reset
The information provided may differ
depending on which functions are
applicable to your vehicle.
Shift to P to edit settings/Engage
parking brake to edit settings
This warning message illuminates if
you try to select an item from the User
Settings mode while driving.
• Automated manual transmission
For your safety, change the User
Settings after parking the vehicle,
applying the parking brake and
moving the shift lever to P(Park).
• Manual transmission
For your safety, change the User
Settings after engaging the parking
brake.
Quick guide (Help)
This mode provides quick guides for the
systems in the User Settings mode.
Select an item, press and hold the OK
button.
For more details about each system,
refer to this Owner’s Manual.
4-27
04
User settings mode
In this mode, you can change setting of the instrument cluster, doors, lamps, and so
on.
Driver Assistance (if equipped)
Items Explanation
Driving Assist The function assists the driver to maintain the set speed, keep a safe
distance with a vehicle ahead and keep the vehicle inside of the lane
while driving on the highway.
Warning Volume To adjust the warning volume of the driver assistance system.
• High / Medium / Low
Door
Items Explanation
Auto Lock Disable : The auto door lock operation will be deactivated.
Enable on Speed : All doors will be automatically locked when the
vehicle speed exceeds 15 km/h (9.3 mph).
Auto Unlock
Disable : The auto door unlock operation will be canceled.
Vehicle Off: All doors will be automatically unlocked when the ignition
key is removed from the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop
button is set to the OFF position.
Light
Items Explanation
One Touch Turn
Signal
• Off: The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated.
3 Flashes : The lane change signals will blink 3 times when the turn
signal lever is moved slightly.
For more details, refer to “Lighting” in chapter 5.
Ambient Light To activate or deactivate the Ambient Light (cabin mood light setting)
function.
Head Lamp
Delay
• Off: The headlight delay function will be deactivated.
• On: The headlight delay function will be activated.
For more details, refer to “Lighting” in chapter 5.
4-28
Instrument Cluster
Service interval
Items Explanation
Service Interval
In this mode, you can activate the service interval function with mileage
(km or mi.) and period (months).
• Off: The service interval function will be deactivated.
• On: You can set the service interval (mileage and months).
Other features
Items Explanation
Fuel Economy
Auto Reset
Off: The average fuel economy will not reset automatically whenever
refueling.
After Ignition: The average fuel economy will reset automatically
whenever it has passed 4 hours after turning OFF the engine.
After Refueling: The average fuel economy will reset automatically
when refueling.
For more details, refer to “Trip Computer” in this chapter.
Fuel Economy
Unit Choose the fuel economy unit. (Km/L, L/100km) (US gallon, UK gallon)
Temperature
Unit Choose the temperature unit. (°C,°F)
4-29
04
Language
Items Explanation
Language Choose the language.
Reset
Items Explanation
Reset You can reset the menus in the User Settings Mode. All menus in the
User Settings Mode are reset to factory settings, except language and
service interval.
NOTICE
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-30
Instrument Cluster
Cluster type A (if equipped)
Tripmeter/Trip computer
OAI3049017
OAI3049017
The trip computer is a microcomputer-
controlled driver information system that
displays information related to driving,
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position. All stored driving information
(except odometer & Trip A & B) resets if
the battery is disconnected.
Press the trip mode/reset button for less
than 1 second to select any mode as
follows:
* if equipped
* if equipped
Tripmeter A
Tripmeter B
Distance to empty*
Average fuel consumption*
Instant fuel consumption*
Average speed*
Elapsed time*
Service Reminder*
TRIP COMPUTER
4-31
04
OAH2048107
OAH2048107
Tripmeter (km or mi.)
A : Tripmeter A
B : Tripmeter B
This mode indicates the distance of
individual trips selected since the last
tripmeter reset.
The meter’s working range is from 0.0
to 9999.9 km. (0.0 to 9999.9 miles).
Pressing the trip mode/reset button for
more than 1 second, when the tripmeter
is being displayed, clears the tripmeter
to zero (0.0).
OAH2048108
OAH2048108
Distance to empty
(if equipped) (km or mi.)
This mode indicates the estimated
distance to empty based on the current
fuel in the fuel tank and the amount of
fuel delivered to the engine. When the
remaining distance is below 50 km (30
miles), “---” will be displayed.
The meter’s working range is from 50 to
999 km (30 to 615 miles).
4-32
Instrument Cluster
OAH2048113
OAH2048113
Average fuel consumption
(if equipped) (l/100 km or MPG)
This mode calculates the average fuel
consumption from the total fuel used
and the distance since the last average
consumption reset. The total fuel used
is calculated from the fuel consumption
input. For an accurate calculation, drive
more than 300 m (0.18 miles).
Pressing the RESET button for more
than 1 second, when the average fuel
consumption is being displayed, clears
the average fuel consumption to zero
(--.-).
OAH2048108
OAH2048108
Instant fuel consumption
(if equipped) (l/100 km or MPG)
This mode calculates the instant fuel
consumption of the last few seconds.
4-33
04
NOTICE
If the vehicle is not on level ground
or the battery power has been
interrupted, the “Distance to empty”
function may not operate correctly.
The trip computer may not register
additional fuel if less than 6 liters
(1.6 gallons) of fuel are added to the
vehicle.
The fuel consumption and distance to
empty may vary significantly based
on driving conditions, driving habits,
and condition of the vehicle.
The distance to empty value is an
estimate of the available driving
distance. This may differ from the
actual driving distance available.
OAH2048111
OAH2048111
Average speed (km/h or MPH)
This mode calculates the average speed
of the vehicle since the last average
speed reset.
Even if the vehicle is not in motion, the
average speed keeps going while the
engine is running.
Pressing the RESET button for more than
1 second, when the average speed is
being displayed, clear the average speed
to zero (---).
4-34
Instrument Cluster
OAH2048112
OAH2048112
Elapsed time (if equipped)
This mode indicates the total time
traveled since the last driving time reset.
Even if the vehicle is not in motion,
the driving time keeps going while the
engine is running.
The meter’s working range is from
00:00~99:59.
Pressing the RESET button for more than
1 second, when the driving time is being
displayed, clear the driving time to zero
(00:00).
Service reminder
OAI3049025
OAI3049025
This mode displays the service interval
(mileage).
4-35
04
Cluster type B (if equipped)
The trip computer is a microcomputer-
controlled driver information system that
displays information related to driving.
i Information
Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example, Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
Trip modes
Fuel Economy
• Average Fuel Economy
• Instant Fuel Economy
Accumulated Info
• Tripmeter
• Average Fuel Economy
• Timer
Drive Info
• Tripmeter
• Average Fuel Economy
• Timer
4-36
Instrument Cluster
Type A
Type A
OQX069060L
OQX069060L
Type B
Type B
To change the trip mode, toggle the
, ” switch on the steering wheel.
Fuel economy
OAC3069039TU
OAC3069039TU
Average Fuel Economy (1)
The average fuel economy is
calculated by the total driving distance
and fuel consumption since the last
average fuel economy reset.
The average fuel economy can be
reset both manually and automatically.
Manual reset
To clear the average fuel economy
manually, press the [OK] button on the
steering wheel for more than 1 second
when the average fuel economy is
displayed.
Automatic reset
To automatically reset the average fuel
economy after refueling, select the “Fuel
Econ. Reset” mode in the User Settings
menu on the Cluster display.
- After ignition: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically
whenever it has passed 4 hours after
turning OFF the engine.
- After refueling: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically
when driving speed exceeds 1 km/h,
after adding 6 liters (1.6 gallons) of fuel
or more.
i Information
The average fuel economy may be
inaccurate, when the vehicle drives
shorter than 300 meters (0.19 miles) after
turning ON the Engine Start/Stop button.
Instant Fuel Economy (2)
This mode displays the instant fuel
economy during the last few seconds
when the vehicle speed is more than
10 km/h (6.2 mph).
4-37
04
Accumulated Info
OAC3069041TU
OAC3069041TU
This display shows the accumulated trip
distance (1), the average fuel economy
(2), and the total driving time (3).
The information is accumulated starting
from the last reset.
To manually reset the information, press
and hold the OK button when viewing
the Accumulated driving info. The trip
distance, the average fuel economy,
and total driving time will reset
simultaneously.
The accumulated driving information will
continue to be counted while the engine
is still running (for example, when the
vehicle is in traffic or stopped at a stop
light).
i Information
The vehicle must be driven for a
minimum of 300 meters (0.19 miles) since
the last ignition key cycle before the
average fuel economy will be recalculated.
4-38
Instrument Cluster
Drive Info
OAC3069040TU
OAC3069040TU
This display shows the trip distance (1),
the average fuel economy (2), and the
total driving time (3).
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the
engine has been OFF for 4 hours or
longer the Drive Info screen will reset.
To manually reset the information, press
and hold the OK button when viewing
the Drive Info. The trip distance, the
average fuel economy, and total driving
time will reset simultaneously.
The driving information will continue
to be counted while the engine is still
running (for example, when the vehicle
is in traffic or stopped at a stop light.)
i Information
The vehicle must be driven for a
minimum of 300 meters (0.19 miles) since
the last ignition key cycle before the
average fuel economy will be recalculated.
Accessing your vehicle ................................................................................... 5-4
Remote key ................................................................................................................ 5-4
Remote key precautions ........................................................................................... 5-6
Smart key ....................................................................................................................5-7
Smart key precautions ..............................................................................................5-11
Immobilizer system .................................................................................................. 5-12
Door locks.......................................................................................................5-14
Operating door locks from outside the vehicle......................................................5-14
Operating door locks from inside the vehicle ........................................................5-16
Auto door lock/unlock features...............................................................................5-18
Child-protector rear door locks ...............................................................................5-18
Steering wheel ...............................................................................................5-19
Motor driven power steering (MDPS) ..................................................................... 5-19
Tilt steering .............................................................................................................. 5-20
Horn........................................................................................................................... 5-21
Mirrors ........................................................................................................... 5-22
Inside rearview mirror ..............................................................................................5-22
Outside rearview mirror ...........................................................................................5-23
Windows ........................................................................................................ 5-25
Power windows ........................................................................................................5-25
Manual windows ..................................................................................................... 5-28
Exterior features ............................................................................................ 5-29
Hood ......................................................................................................................... 5-29
Tailgate ..................................................................................................................... 5-30
Trunk ..........................................................................................................................5-32
Fuel filler door.......................................................................................................... 5-33
Lighting .......................................................................................................... 5-36
Exterior lights........................................................................................................... 5-36
Interior lights ...........................................................................................................5-40
Wipers and washers ...................................................................................... 5-43
Windshield wipers ................................................................................................... 5-44
Windshield washers ................................................................................................ 5-44
Rear window wiper and washer switch ................................................................. 5-45
Manual climate control system ....................................................................5-46
Heating and air conditioning .................................................................................. 5-47
System operation .....................................................................................................5-51
System maintenance .............................................................................................. 5-53
5. Convenience Features
5
5
Automatic climate control system ............................................................... 5-55
Automatic heating and air conditioning ................................................................ 5-56
Manual heating and air conditioning ......................................................................5-57
System operation .................................................................................................... 5-62
System maintenance ..............................................................................................5-64
Windshield defrosting and defogging ......................................................... 5-65
Manual climate control system .............................................................................. 5-65
Automatic climate control system ......................................................................... 5-66
Defroster .................................................................................................................. 5-67
Storage compartment ..................................................................................5-69
Center console storage ...........................................................................................5-69
Glove box ................................................................................................................. 5-70
Cool box ................................................................................................................... 5-70
Interior features ............................................................................................. 5-71
Clock ......................................................................................................................... 5-71
Cup holder ................................................................................................................ 5-71
Sunvisor ....................................................................................................................5-72
Power outlet .............................................................................................................5-72
USB charger ..............................................................................................................5-73
Coat hook ..................................................................................................................5-74
Floor mat anchor(s) ..................................................................................................5-74
Cargo area cover (5 Door) ........................................................................................5-75
Exterior features .............................................................................................5-75
Roof rack ...................................................................................................................5-75
Infotainment system ..................................................................................... 5-76
USB port ....................................................................................................................5-76
Antenna .....................................................................................................................5-76
Steering wheel audio control ..................................................................................5-77
Audio/Video ..............................................................................................................5-78
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology hands-free ..........................................................5-79
How vehicle audio works .........................................................................................5-79
5
5. Convenience Features
Audio (without touch screen) ....................................................................... 5-82
System layout – control panel ................................................................................ 5-82
System layout – steering wheel remote control ...................................................5-86
Turning the system on or off ................................................................................... 5-88
Turning the display on or off ................................................................................... 5-89
Getting to know the basic operations .................................................................... 5-89
Radio ..............................................................................................................5-90
Turning on the radio ................................................................................................5-90
Changing the radio mode ....................................................................................... 5-93
Scanning for available radio stations ..................................................................... 5-93
Saving radio stations ............................................................................................... 5-94
Listening to saved radio stations............................................................................5-94
Media player ..................................................................................................5-95
Using the media player ........................................................................................... 5-95
Using the USB mode ............................................................................................... 5-95
Bluetooth .......................................................................................................5-98
Connecting Bluetooth devices ...............................................................................5-98
Using a Bluetooth audio device ............................................................................ 5-101
Using a Bluetooth phone .......................................................................................5-103
The emergency call service ........................................................................ 5-108
System status icons .................................................................................... 5-109
Infotainment system specifications ........................................................... 5-110
USB .......................................................................................................................... 5-110
Bluetooth ................................................................................................................. 5-111
Trademarks .................................................................................................... 5-111
Declaration of conformity ............................................................................5-112
CE .............................................................................................................................5-112
IFETEL ......................................................................................................................5-113
TRA ...........................................................................................................................5-113
5-4
Convenience Features
ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE
Remote key (if equipped)
OIB034040
OIB034040
Your HYUNDAI uses a remote key, which
you can use to lock or unlock a door
(and trunk/tailgate) and even start the
engine.
1. Door Lock
2. Door Unlock
3. Trunk/Tailgate Unlock
Locking
To lock :
1. Close all doors, engine hood and
trunk/tailgate.
2. Press the Door Lock button (1) on the
remote key.
3. The doors will lock. The hazard
warning lights will blink once.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
WARNING
Do not leave the keys in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could place the
key in the ignition switch and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
Unlocking
To unlock:
1. Press the Door Unlock button (2) on
the remote key.
2. The doors will unlock. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times.
i Information
After unlocking the doors, the doors will
lock automatically after 30 seconds unless
a door is opened.
Trunk/Tailgate unlocking
To unlock:
1. Press the Trunk/Tailgate Unlock
button (3) on the remote key for more
than one second.
2. The hazard warning lights will blink
two times. Once the tailgate/trunk is
opened and then closed, the tailgate/
trunk will lock automatically.
i Information
After unlocking the tailgate, the tailgate
will lock automatically.
The word “HOLD” is written on the
button to inform you that you must
press and hold the button for more than
one second.
5-5
05
Start-up
For detailed information, refer to “Key
Ignition Switch” in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the remote key:
Keep the remote key away from
water or any liquid and fire. If the
inside of the remote key gets damp
(due to drinks or moisture), or is
heated, the internal circuit may
malfunction, excluding the car from
the warranty.
Avoid dropping or throwing the
remote key.
Protect the remote key from extreme
temperatures.
Mechanical key
OYDECO2231
OYDECO2231
Type A
Type A
Type B
Type B
OIB044178
OIB044178
If the remote key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
door by using the mechanical key.
Type B
To unfold the key, press the release
button then the key will unfold
automatically.
To fold the key, fold the key manually
while pressing the release button.
NOTICE
Do not fold the key without pressing
the release button. This may damage
the key.
5-6
Convenience Features
Remote key precautions
The remote key will not work if any of
the following occurs:
The key is in the ignition switch.
You exceed the operating distance
limit (about 10 m [30 feet]).
The remote key battery is weak.
Other vehicles or objects may be
blocking the signal.
• The weather is extremely cold.
The remote key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the remote key.
When the remote key does not work
correctly, open and close the door
with the mechanical key. If you have
a problem with the remote key, it is
recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the remote key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is especially
important when the phone is active
such as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails. Avoid placing the remote key
and your mobile phone in the same
pants or jacket pocket and always try to
maintain an adequate distance between
the two devices.
i Information
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment. If the
keyless entry system is inoperative due
to changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance, it will not be covered by your
manufacturer’s vehicle warranty.
NOTICE
Keep the remote key away from
electromagnetic materials that blocks
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
Battery replacement
If the remote key is not working
properly, try replacing the battery with a
new one.
OIB044180
OIB044180
Type A
Battery type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Insert a slim tool into the slot and
gently pry open the cover.
2. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
3. Reinstall the rear cover of the remote
key.
5-7
05
OAEPH059696C
OAEPH059696C
Type B
Battery type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Insert a slim tool into the slot and
gently pry open the cover.
2. Using a screw driver remove the
battery cover (A).
3. Remove the old battery (B) and insert
a new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
4. Reinstall the battery cover and key
cover in the reverse order of removal.
If you suspect your remote key might
have sustained some damage, or you
feel your remote key is not working
correctly, it is recommended that you
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A BUTTON
BATTERY.
If swallowed, a lithium button battery
can cause severe or fatal injuries within
2 hours. Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
If you think batteries may have been
swallowed or placed inside any part
of the body, seek immediate medical
attention.
i Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human
health. Dispose the battery
according to your local law(s)
and regulation.
Smart key (if equipped)
OIB044179
OIB044179
Type A
Type A
Your HYUNDAI uses a Smart Key, which
you can use to lock or unlock a door
(and trunk/tailgate) and even start the
engine.
1. Door Lock
2. Door Unlock
3. Trunk/Tailgate Unlock
5-8
Convenience Features
Locking
OAI3059001
OAI3059001
To lock :
1. Close all doors, engine hood and
tailgate/trunk.
2. Either press the door handle button or
press the Door Lock button (1) on the
smart key.
3. The hazard warning lights will blink
once.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
i Information
The door handle button will only operate
when the smart key is within 0.7~1 m
(28~40 in.) from the outside door handle.
Even though you press the outside
door handle button, the doors will not
lock and the chime will sound for three
seconds if any of the following occurs:
The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
The Engine Start/Stop button is in ACC
or ON position.
Any door except the tailgate/trunk is
open.
WARNING
Do not leave the Smart Key in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could press the
Engine Start/Stop button and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
5-9
05
Unlocking
OAI3059001
OAI3059001
To unlock:
1. Carry the Smart Key.
2. Either press the door handle button or
press the Door Unlock button (2) on
the smart key.
3. The doors will unlock. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times.
i Information
The door handle button will only
operate when the smart key is within 1
m (40 in.) from the outside door handle.
Other people can also open the doors
without the smart key in possession.
After unlocking the doors, the doors
will lock automatically after 30 seconds
unless a door is opened.
Tailgate/Trunk unlocking
To unlock:
1. Carry the smart key.
2. Press the Tailgate/Trunk Unlock
button (3) on the smart key for more
than one second.
3. The hazard warning lights will blink
two times.
Once the tailgate/trunk is opened and
then closed, the tailgate/trunk will lock
automatically.
i Information
After unlocking the tailgate/trunk, the
tailgate/trunk will lock automatically after
30 seconds unless the tailgate/trunk is
opened.
5-10
Convenience Features
Start-up
You can start the engine without
inserting the key. For detailed
information, refer to the Engine Start/
Stop button in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the smart key:
Keep the smart key away from water
or any liquid and fire. If the inside
of the smart key gets damp (due to
drinks or moisture), or is heated, the
internal circuit may malfunction,
excluding the car from the warranty.
Avoid dropping or throwing the
smart key.
Protect the smart key from extreme
temperatures.
NOTICE
Always have the smart key with you
when leaving the vehicle. If the smart
key is placed near the vehicle, the
vehicle battery may be discharged.
Mechanical key
If the Smart Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
door by using the mechanical key.
OIB044175
OIB044175
Press and hold the release button (1) and
remove the mechanical key (2). Insert
the mechanical key into the key hole on
the door.
To reinstall the mechanical key, put the
key into the hole and push it until a click
sound is heard.
Loss of a smart key
A maximum of two smart keys can
be registered to a single vehicle. If
you happen to lose your smart key,
it is recommended that you should
immediately take the vehicle and
remaining key to your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or tow the vehicle if
necessary.
5-11
05
Smart key precautions
The smart key will not work if any of the
following occurs:
The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station,
military area, police station,
government offices, broadcasting
stations, transmission towers, port or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the smart key.
The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a cellular phone.
The smart key is close to a metal
product or coins
Another vehicle’s smart key is being
operated close to your vehicle.
When you connect an external device
to the multi-purpose socket or USB
port and place it near the smart key,
the smart key may not be recognized/
work in some areas of the vehicle. In
this case, try moving the smart key to
another location to start the engine or
press the start button directly with the
smart key to start the engine.
In the following situations, the frequency
band from the smart key may be mixed
with a different frequency, which may
cause smart key malfunction (engine
operation, door lock function, etc.) or
the working distance of smart key may
change.
The smart key is placed near the
electronic systems (woofer, cellular
phone, portable wired/wireless
charger, electric heating device,
electronic power bank, e-cigarettes,
etc.)
When the smart key does not work
correctly, open and close the door
with the mechanical key. If you have
a problem with the smart key, it is
recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the smart key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is especially
important when the phone is active
such as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails. Avoid placing the smart key and
your mobile phone in the same pants or
jacket pocket and always try to maintain
an adequate distance between the two
devices.
i Information
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment. If the
keyless entry system is inoperative due
to changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance, it will not be covered by your
manufacturer’s vehicle warranty.
NOTICE
Keep the smart key away from
electromagnetic materials that blocks
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
5-12
Convenience Features
Battery replacement
OLF044008
OLF044008
If the Smart Key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Pry open the rear cover of the smart
key.
2. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
3. Reinstall the rear cover of the smart
key.
If you suspect your smart key might
have sustained some damage, or you
feel your smart key is not working
correctly, it is recommended that you
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A BUTTON
BATTERY.
If swallowed, a lithium button battery
can cause severe or fatal injuries within
2 hours. Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
If you think batteries may have been
swallowed or placed inside any part
of the body, seek immediate medical
attention.
i Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human
health. Dispose the battery
according to your local law(s)
and regulation.
Immobilizer system
The system is designed in such a way
that it makes vehicle theft difficult if
its circuit and battery connection is
uninterrupted. If an improperly coded
key (or other device) is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
When the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position, the immobilizer system
indicator should come on briefly, then
go off. If the indicator starts to blink, the
system does not recognize the coding of
the key.
Place the ignition switch to the LOCK/
OFF position, then place the ignition
switch to the ON position again.
The system may not recognize your
key’s coding if another immobilizer
key or other metal object (for example,
key chain) is near the key. The engine
may not start because the metal may
interrupt the transponder signal from
transmitting normally.
If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of the key, it is
recommended that you contact your
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system
or add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle inoperable.
Disclaimer:
The system is designed in such a way
that it makes vehicle theft difficult if
its circuit and battery connection is
uninterrupted.
5-13
05
WARNING
In order to prevent theft of your
vehicle, do not leave spare keys
anywhere in your vehicle. Your
immobilizer password is a customer
unique password and should be kept
confidential.
NOTICE
The transponder in your key is an
important part of the immobilizer
system. It is designed to give years
of trouble-free service, however you
should avoid exposure to moisture,
static electricity and rough handling.
Immobilizer system malfunction could
occur.
Disclaimer:
The system is designed in such a way
that it makes vehicle theft difficult if
its circuit and battery connection is
uninterrupted.
5-14
Convenience Features
DOOR LOCKS
Operating door locks from
outside the vehicle
Mechanical key
OAI3059053
OAI3059053
Turn the key toward the rear of the
vehicle to unlock and toward the front of
the vehicle to lock.
If you lock/unlock the driver’s door with
a key, all vehicle doors will lock/unlock
automatically. (If equipped with the
central door lock system)
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
Remote key
OQXI049004
OQXI049004
To lock the doors, press the Door Lock
button (1) on the remote key.
To unlock the doors, press the Door
Unlock button (2) on the remote key.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
i Information
In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
If the door is locked/unlocked multiple
times in rapid succession with either
the vehicle key or door lock switch, the
system may stop operating temporarily
in order to protect the circuit and
prevent damage to system components.
5-15
05
Smart key
OAI3059062
OAI3059062
1. Door lock
2. Door unlock
To lock the doors, press the button on
the outside door handle while carrying
the smart key with you or press the door
lock button on the smart key.
To unlock the doors, press the button on
the outside door handle while carrying
the smart key with you or press the door
unlock button on the smart key.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
i Information
In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
If the door is locked/unlocked multiple
times in rapid succession with either
the vehicle key or door lock switch, the
system may stop operating temporarily
in order to protect the circuit and
prevent damage to system components.
5-16
Convenience Features
Operating door locks from
inside the vehicle
With the door lock button
OAI3059003
OAI3059003
To unlock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Unlock” position.
To lock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Lock” position.
To open a door, pull the door handle
(2) outward.
If the inner door handle of the driver’s
door is pulled when the door lock
button is in the lock position, the
button is unlocked and door opens.
Front doors cannot be locked if the
key is in the ignition switch and any
front door is open.
Doors cannot be locked if the smart
key is in the vehicle and any door is
open.
i Information
If a power door lock ever fails to function
while you are in the vehicle, try one or
more of the following techniques to exit:
Operate the door unlock feature
repeatedly (both electronic and manual)
while simultaneously pulling on the door
handle.
Operate the other door locks and handles,
front and rear.
Lower a front window and use the
mechanical key to unlock the door from
outside.
5-17
05
With the central door lock/unlock
switch
OAI3059004
OAI3059004
When pressing the ( ) portion (1) of the
switch, all vehicle doors will lock.
If the key is in the ignition switch and
any door is opened, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (1) of
the central door lock switch is pressed.
If the smart key is in the vehicle and
any door is opened, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (1) of
the central door lock switch is pressed.
When pressing the ( ) portion (2) of the
switch, all vehicle doors will unlock.
WARNING
The doors should always be fully
closed and locked while the vehicle is
in motion. If the doors are unlocked,
the risk of being thrown from the
vehicle in a crash will increase.
Do not pull the inner door handle of
the driver’s or passenger’s door while
the vehicle is moving.
WARNING
Do not leave the elderly, children or
animals unattended in your vehicle.
An enclosed vehicle can become
extremely hot, causing death or serious
injury to the elderly, unattended
children or animals who cannot
escape from the vehicle. Children
might operate features of the vehicle
that could injure them, or they could
encounter other harm, possibly from
someone gaining entry to the vehicle.
WARNING
Always secure your vehicle.
Leaving your vehicle unlocked
increases the potential risk to you or
others from someone hiding in your
vehicle.
To secure your vehicle, while
depressing the brake, move the shift
lever to the P (Park) position (for
Automated Manual Transmission) or
first gear or R (Reverse, for manual
transmission), engage the parking
brake, and place the ignition switch
in the LOCK/OFF position, close all
windows, lock all doors, and always
take the key with you.
5-18
Convenience Features
WARNING
Opening a door when something is
approaching may cause damage or
injury. Be careful when opening doors
and watch for vehicles, motorcycles,
bicycles or pedestrians approaching
the vehicle in the path of the door.
WARNING
If you stay in the vehicle for a long time
while the weather is very hot or cold,
there are risks of injuries or danger to
life. Do not lock the vehicle from the
outside when someone is in the vehicle.
Auto door lock/unlock features
(if equipped)
Impact sensing door unlock system
All doors will be automatically unlocked
when an impact causes the airbags to
deploy.
Speed sensing door lock system
All doors will be automatically locked
when the vehicle speed exceeds 15 km/h
(9 mph).
Child-protector rear door locks
OAI3059005
OAI3059005
The child safety lock is provided to help
prevent children seated in the rear from
accidentally opening the rear doors. The
rear door safety locks should be used
whenever children are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock is located on the
edge of each rear door. When the child
safety lock is in the lock position ( ),
the rear door will not open if the inner
door handle is pulled.
To lock the child safety lock, insert a key
(or screwdriver) into the hole (1) and turn
it to the lock ( ) position.
To allow a rear door to be opened from
inside the vehicle, unlock the child
safety lock.
WARNING
If children accidently open the rear
doors while the vehicle is in motion,
they could fall out of the vehicle. The
rear door safety locks should always
be used whenever children are in the
vehicle.
5-19
05
Motor driven power steering
(MDPS)
The system assists you with steering
the vehicle. If the engine is off or if
the power steering system becomes
inoperative, the vehicle may still be
steered, but it will require increased
steering effort.
Also, the steering effort becomes
heavier as the vehicle’s speed increases
and becomes lighter as the vehicle’s
speed decreases for better control of the
steering wheel.
Should you notice any change in the
effort required to steer during normal
vehicle operation, we recommend that
the system be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
If the Motor driven power steering
system does not operate normally, the
warning light ( ) will illuminate on
the instrument cluster. The steering
wheel may become difficult to control
or operate. Take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the system checked as soon as
possible.
i Information
The following symptoms may occur
during normal vehicle operation:
The steering effort may be high
immediately after placing the ignition
switch in the ON position.
This happens as the system performs
the MDPS system diagnostics. When
the diagnostics is completed, the
steering wheel will return to its normal
condition.
When the battery voltage is low, you
might have to put more steering effort.
However, it is a temporary condition so
that it will return to normal condition
after charging the battery.
A click noise may be heard from the
MDPS relay after the ignition switch
is placed to the ON or LOCK/OFF
position.
Motor noise may be heard when the
vehicle is at stop or at a low driving
speed.
When you operate the steering wheel
in low temperature, abnormal noise
may occur. If temperature rises, the
noise will disappear. This is a normal
condition.
WARNING
Never adjust the steering wheel while
driving. You may lose the steering
control and cause severe personal
injury, death or accidents.
STEERING WHEEL
5-20
Convenience Features
Tilt steering (if equipped)
WARNING
Never adjust the steering wheel while
driving. You may lose steering control
and cause severe personal injury, death
or accidents.
i Information
After adjustment, sometimes the lock-
release lever may not lock the steering
wheel.
It is not a malfunction. This occurs when
two gears are not engaged correctly. In
this case, adjust the steering wheel again
and then lock the steering wheel.
OAI3059017
OAI3059017
To change the steering wheel angle:
1. Pull down the lock-release lever (1).
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the
desired angle (2). Move the steering
wheel, so it points toward your chest,
not toward your face. Make sure you
can see the instrument panel warning
lights and gauges.
3. Pull up the lock-release lever (3) to
lock the steering wheel in place.
Push the steering wheel both up and
down to be certain it is locked in
position.
CAUTION
While adjusting the steering wheel
height, please do not push or pull it
hard since the fixture can be damaged.
5-21
05
Horn
OQXI049023
OQXI049023
To sound the horn, press the area
indicated by the horn symbol on your
steering wheel (see illustration). The
horn will operate only when this area is
pressed.
NOTICE
Do not strike the horn severely to
operate it, or hit it with your fist. Do not
press on the horn with a sharp-pointed
object.
5-22
Convenience Features
Inside rearview mirror
Before you start driving, adjust the
rearview mirror to the center on the view
through the rear window.
WARNING
Make sure your line of sight is not
obstructed. Do not place objects in the
rear seat, cargo area, or behind the rear
headrests which could interfere with
your vision through the rear window.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury during an
accident or deployment of the airbag,
do not modify the rearview mirror and
do not install a wide mirror.
WARNING
NEVER adjust the mirror while driving.
This may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
Day/night rearview mirror
OBC3050054
OBC3050054
[A] : Day, [B] :Night
Make this adjustment before you start
driving and while the day/night lever is
in the day position.
Pull the day/night lever toward you to
reduce glare from the headlights of the
vehicles behind you during night driving.
Remember that you lose some rearview
clarity in the night position.
MIRRORS
5-23
05
Outside rearview mirror
Your vehicle is equipped with both left-
hand and right-hand outside rearview
mirrors.
WARNING
Rearview mirrors
Both right and left outside rear view
mirror are convex.
Objects seen in the mirror are closer
than they appear.
Use your interior rearview mirror or
turn your head and look to determine
the actual distance of following
vehicles when changing lanes.
WARNING
Do not adjust or fold the outside
rearview mirrors while the vehicle is
moving. This could result in loss of
control, and an accident which could
cause death, serious injury or property
damage.
NOTICE
Do not scrape ice off the mirror face;
this may damage the surface of the
glass.
If the mirror is jammed with ice, do
not adjust the mirror by force. Use
an approved de-icer (not radiator
antifreeze) spray, a sponge or soft
cloth with very warm water, or move
the vehicle to a warm place and allow
the ice to melt.
Adjustion the rearview mirror
OBI3050073L
OBI3050073L
Manual type (if equipped)
To adjust an outside mirror, move the
control lever.
OAI3059019
OAI3059019
Electric type (if equipped)
Move the lever (1) to the L (Left) or R
(Right) to select the rearview mirror you
would like to adjust.
Use the mirror adjustment control to
position the selected mirror up, down,
left or right.
5-24
Convenience Features
NOTICE
The mirrors stop moving when
they reach the maximum adjusting
angles, but the motor continues to
operate while the switch is pressed.
Do not press the switch longer
than necessary, the motor may be
damaged.
Do not attempt to adjust the outside
rearview mirror by hand or the motor
may be damaged.
Folding the outside rearview mirror
OAI3059020
OAI3059020
Manual type (if equipped)
To fold the outside rearview mirror,
grasp the housing of the mirror and then
fold it toward the rear of the vehicle.
OAI3059021
OAI3059021
Electric type (if equipped)
To fold the outside rearview mirror,
press the button.
To unfold outside rearview mirror, press
the button again.
If the button is pressed, the mirror will
fold or unfold automatically.
NOTICE
The electric type outside rearview
mirror operates even though the
ignition switch is in the ACC position.
However, to prevent unnecessary
battery discharge, do not adjust the
mirrors longer than necessary while the
engine is not running.
NOTICE
Do not fold the electric type outside
rearview mirror by hand. It could cause
motor failure.
5-25
05
WINDOWS
Power windows (if equipped)
OAI3059008
OAI3059008
(1) Driver’s door power window switch*
(2) Front passenger’s door window switch
(3) Rear door window switch (Right)
(4) Rear door window switch (Left)
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window*
(7) Power window lock switch*
* : if equipped
5-26
Convenience Features
The ignition switch must be in the ON
position to be able to raise or lower
the windows. Each door has a Power
Window switch to control that door’s
window. The driver has a Power Window
Lock switch which can block the
operation of rear passenger windows.
The power windows will operate for
approximately 30 seconds after the
ignition switch is placed in the ACC or
OFF position. However, if the front doors
are opened, the Power Windows cannot
be operated even within the 30 seconds
period.
WARNING
To avoid serious injury or death, do not
extend your head, arms or body outside
the windows while driving.
i Information
In cold and wet climates, power
windows may not work properly due to
freezing conditions.
While driving with the rear windows
down or with the sunroof (if equipped)
opened (or partially opened), your
vehicle may demonstrate a wind
buffeting or pulsation noise. This
noise is normal and can be reduced
or eliminated by taking the following
actions. If the noise occurs with one
or both of the rear windows down,
partially lower both front windows
approximately 2.5 cm (one inch).
Window opening and closing
OAI3059009
OAI3059009
To open or close a window, press
down or pull up the front portion of the
corresponding switch to the first detent
position (5).
Auto down Window
(if equipped) (Driver’s window)
OAI3053010L
OAI3053010L
Pressing the power window switch
momentarily to the second detent
position (6) completely lowers the
driver’s window even when the switch
is released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is in
operation, pull up and release the switch
to the opposite direction of the window
movement.
5-27
05
To reset the power windows
If the power windows do not operate
normally, the automatic power window
system must be reset as follows:
1. Place the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Close the window and continue pulling
up on the power window switch for at
least one second.
If the power windows do not
operate properly after resetting, it
is recommended that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
The automatic reverse feature doesn’t
activate while resetting power window
system. Make sure body parts or other
objects are safely out of the way before
closing the windows to avoid injuries or
vehicle damage.
Power window lock switch
(if equipped)
OAI3059011
OAI3059011
The driver can disable the power window
switches on the rear passengers’ doors
by pressing the power window lock
switch.
When the power window lock switch is
pressed:
The driver’s master control can
operate all the power windows.
The front passenger’s control can
operate the front passenger’s power
window.
The rear passenger’s control cannot
operate the rear passengers’ power
window.
5-28
Convenience Features
NOTICE
To prevent possible damage to the
power window system, do not open
or close two windows or more at the
same time. This will also ensure the
longevity of the fuse.
Never try to operate the main
switch on the driver’s door and the
individual door window switch in
opposite directions at the same time.
If this is done, the window will stop
and cannot be opened or closed.
WARNING
NEVER leave the keys in your vehicle
with unsupervised children, when the
engine is running.
NEVER leave any child unattended in
the vehicle. Even very young children
may inadvertently cause the vehicle
to move, entangle themselves in
the windows, or otherwise injure
themselves or others.
Always double check to make
sure arms, hands, head and other
obstructions are safely out of the way
before closing a window.
Do not allow children to play with the
power windows. Keep the driver’s
door power window lock switch in
the LOCK position (pressed). Serious
injury can result from unintentional
window operation by the child.
Do not extend your head, arms or
body outside the windows while
driving.
Manual windows (if equipped)
OYC046423
OYC046423
To raise or lower the window, turn the
window regulator handle clockwise or
counterclockwise in the right side. And
the left side is opposite direction.
WARNING
When opening or closing the windows,
make sure your passenger’s arms,
hands and body are safely out of the
way.
5-29
05
Hood
Opening the hood
OAI3059012
OAI3059012
1. Make sure the shift lever is in N
(Neutral, for Automated manual
transmission) or first gear or R
(Reverse, for Manual transmission) and
set the parking brake.
2. Pull the release lever to unlatch the
hood. The hood should pop open
slightly.
OAI3052013
OAI3052013
3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise
the hood slightly, push the secondary
hood release lever up (1) inside of the
hood center and lift the hood (2).
OAI3059014
OAI3059014
4. Pull out the support rod.
5. Hold the hood opened with the
support rod.
WARNING
The support rod must be inserted
completely into the hole provided
whenever you inspect the engine
compartment. This will prevent the
hood from falling and possibly injuring
you.
EXTERIOR FEATURES
5-30
Convenience Features
Closing the hood
1. Before closing the hood, check the
following:
All filler caps in the engine
compartment must be correctly
installed.
Gloves, rags or any other
combustible materials must
be removed from the engine
compartment.
2. Return the support rod to its clip to
prevent it from rattling.
3. Lower the hood halfway (lifted
approximately 30 cm from the closed
position) and push down to securely
lock in place. Then double check to be
sure the hood is secure.
WARNING
Always double check to be sure that the
hood is firmly latched before driving
away. Check there is no hood open
warning light or message displayed on
the instrument cluster. Driving with the
hood opened may cause a total loss
of visibility, which might result in an
accident.
WARNING
Before closing the hood, ensure that
all obstructions are removed from
the hood opening. Closing the hood
with an obstruction present in the
hood opening may result in property
damage or severe personal injury.
Do not leave gloves, rags or any other
combustible materials in the engine
compartment. Doing so may cause a
heat-induced fire.
Do not move the vehicle with
the hood raised. The view will be
blocked and the hood could fall or be
damaged.
Tailgate
Opening the tailgate
OAI3053006L
OAI3053006L
The tailgate is locked or unlocked
when all doors are locked or unlocked
with the key, remote key, smart key or
central door lock/unlock switch.
If unlocked, the tailgate can be
opened by pressing the handle and
pulling it up.
i Information
In cold and wet climates, door lock and
door mechanisms may not work properly
due to freezing conditions.
5-31
05
WARNING
The tailgate swings upward. Make
sure no objects or people are near the
rear of the vehicle when opening the
tailgate.
NOTICE
Make certain that you close the tailgate
before driving your vehicle. Possible
damage may occur to the tailgate lift
cylinders and attaching hardware if the
tailgate is not closed prior to driving.
Closing the tailgate
To close the tailgate, lower and push
down the tailgate firmly. Make sure that
the tailgate is securely latched.
WARNING
Always keep the tailgate lid completely
closed while the vehicle is in motion. If
it is left open or ajar, poisonous exhaust
gases containing carbon monoxide
(CO) may enter the vehicle and serious
illness or death may result.
WARNING
Rear cargo area
Occupants should never ride in the
rear cargo area where no restraints are
available. To avoid injury in the event of
an accident or sudden stops, occupants
should always be properly restrained.
WARNING
OAI3053007L
OAI3053007L
Do not hold the part (gas lifter) that
supports the tailgate. Be aware that
the deformation of the part may cause
vehicle damage and a risk of safety
accident.
5-32
Convenience Features
Trunk
Opening the trunk
OAI3059055
OAI3059055
Make sure the shift lever is in first gear
or R (Reverse) and set the parking brake.
Then do one of the following:
1. Unlock all doors with the Door Unlock
button on your remote key or smart
key. Pull the trunk release switch and
open the trunk.
2. Press and hold the trunk Unlock
button on the remote key or smart
key.
Closing the trunk
Lower the trunk lid and press down
until it locks. To be sure the trunk lid
is securely fastened, always check by
trying to pull it up again.
WARNING
Always keep the trunk lid completely
closed while the vehicle is in motion. If
it is left open or ajar, poisonous exhaust
gases containing carbon monoxide
(CO) may enter the vehicle and serious
illness or death may result.
i Information
To prevent damage to the trunk lift
cylinders and the attached hardware,
always close the trunk before driving.
NOTICE
In cold and wet climates, trunk lock
and trunk mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
WARNING
NEVER allow anyone to occupy the
trunk of the vehicle at any time. If the
trunk is partially or totally latched
and the person is unable to get out,
serious injury or death could occur
due to lack of ventilation, exhaust
fumes and rapid heat build-up, or
because of exposure to cold weather
conditions. The trunk is also a highly
dangerous location in the event of a
crash because it is not a protected
occupant space but is a part of the
vehicle’s crush zone.
Your vehicle should be kept locked
and keys should be kept out of the
reach of children. Parents should
teach their children about the
dangers of playing in trunks.
5-33
05
Fuel filler door
Opening the fuel filler door
OAI3059015
OAI3059015
The fuel filler door must be opened from
inside the vehicle by pulling up the fuel
filler door opener.
1. Stop the engine.
2. Pull the fuel filler door opener up.
OAI3059016
OAI3059016
3. Pull the fuel filler door out (1) to fully
open.
4. To remove the fuel tank cap (2), turn
it counterclockwise. You may hear a
hissing noise as the pressure inside
the tank equalizes.
5. Place the cap on the fuel filler door (3).
i Information
If the fuel filler door does not open
because ice has formed around it, tap
lightly or push on the door to break the
ice and release the door. Do not pry on the
door. If necessary, spray around the door
with an approved de-icer fluid (do not use
radiator anti-freeze) or move the vehicle
to a warm place and allow the ice to melt.
Closing the fuel filler door
1. To install the fuel tank cap (2), turn it
clockwise until it “clicks” once. This
indicates that the cap is securely
tightened.
2. Close the fuel filler door (1) and push it
lightly and make sure that it is securely
closed.
WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and
explosive. Failure to follow these
guidelines may result in SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH:
Read and follow all warnings posted
at the gas station.
Before refueling, note the location of
the Emergency Gasoline Shut-Off,if
available, at the gas station.
Before touching the fuel nozzle, you
should eliminate the potential build-
up of static electricity by touching
a metal part of the vehicle, a safe
distance away from the fuel filler
neck, nozzle, or other gas source,
with your bare hand.
Do not use cellular phones while
refueling. Electric current and/or
electronic interference from cellular
phones can potentially ignite fuel
vapors and cause a fire.
5-34
Convenience Features
Do not get back into a vehicle
once you have begun refueling.
You can generate a buildup of
static electricity by touching,
rubbing or sliding against any item
or fabric capable of producing
static electricity. Static electricity
discharge can ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire. If you must re-enter
the vehicle, you should once again
eliminate potentially dangerous
static electricity discharge by
touching a metal part of the vehicle,
away from the fuel filler neck, nozzle
or other gasoline source, with your
bare hand.
When using an approved portable
fuel container, be sure to place the
container on the ground prior to
refueling. Static electricity discharge
from the container can ignite fuel
vapors causing a fire. Once refueling
has begun, contact between your
bare hand and the vehicle should
be maintained until the filling is
complete.
Use only approved portable plastic
fuel containers designed to carry and
store gasoline.
When refueling, always move the
shift lever to the N (Neutral) position
(for Automated manual transmission)
or first gear or R (Reverse, for manual
transmission), set the parking brake,
and place the ignition switch to the
LOCK/OFF position. Sparks produced
by electrical components related
to the engine can ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire.
Do not use matches or a lighter and
do not smoke or leave a lit cigarette
in your vehicle while at a gas station,
especially during refueling.
Do not over-fill or top-off your
vehicle tank, which can cause
gasoline spillage.
If a fire breaks out during refueling,
leave the vicinity of the vehicle, and
immediately contact the manager
of the gas station and then contact
the local fire department. Follow any
safety instructions they provide.
If pressurized fuel sprays out, it can
cover your clothes or skin and thus
subject you to the risk of fire and
burns. Always remove the fuel cap
carefully and slowly. If the cap is
venting fuel or if you hear a hissing
sound, wait until the condition stops
before completely removing the cap.
Always check that the fuel cap is
installed securely to prevent fuel
spillage in the event of an accident.
5-35
05
i Information
Make sure to refuel your vehicle
according to the “Fuel Requirements”
suggested in the chapter 1.
Do not spill fuel on the exterior surfaces
of the vehicle. Any type of fuel spilled
on painted surfaces may damage the
paint.
NOTICE
If the fuel filler cap requires
replacement, use only a genuine
HYUNDAI cap or the equivalent
specified for your vehicle. An incorrect
fuel filler cap can result in a serious
malfunction of the fuel system or
emission control system.
5-36
Convenience Features
Exterior lights
Lighting control
OAI3052071
OAI3052071
To operate the lights, turn the knob at
the end of the control lever to one of the
following positions:
(1) OFF
(2) Parking Light
(3) Headlight
(4) AUTO Light (if equipped)
OAI3052072
OAI3052072
Headlight ( )
When the light switch is in the head light
position, the headlights, license plate
light and instrument panel lights are
turned ON.
i Information
The ignition switch must be in the ON
position to turn on the headlights.
OAI3052073
OAI3052073
Parking light ( )
When the light switch is in the Parking
(Position) light position, the Parking
(Position) light, license plate light and
instrument panel lights are turned ON.
LIGHTING
5-37
05
OAI3052074
OAI3052074
AUTO light (if equipped)
When the light switch is in the AUTO
position, the parking (position) light and
headlights will be turned ON or OFF
automatically depending on the amount
of light outside the vehicle.
Even with the AUTO light feature
in operation, it is recommended to
manually turn ON the lights when driving
at night or in a fog, or when you enter
dark areas, such as tunnels and parking
facilities.
NOTICE
Do not cover or spill anything on the
sensor located on the instrument
panel.
Do not clean the sensor using
a window cleaner, the cleanser
may leave a light film which could
interfere with sensor operation.
If your vehicle window tint or other
types of metallic coating on the front
windshield, the AUTO light system
may not work properly.
High beam operation
OAI3052075
OAI3052075
To turn on the high beam headlight,
push the lever away from you. The lever
will return to its original position.
The high beam indicator will light when
the headlight high beams are switched
on.
To turn off the high beam headlight, pull
the lever towards you. The low beams
will turn on.
WARNING
Do not use high beam when there are
other vehicles approaching you. Using
high beam could obstruct the other
driver’s vision.
5-38
Convenience Features
OAI3052076
OAI3052076
To flash the high beam headlights, pull
the lever towards you, then release the
lever. The high beams will remain ON as
long as you hold the lever towards you.
Turn signals and lane change
signals
OAI3052077
OAI3052077
To signal a turn, push down on the lever
for a right turn or up for a left turn in
position (A). To signal a lane change,
move the turn signal lever slightly and
hold it in position (B). The lever will
return to the OFF position when released
or when the turn is completed.
If an indicator stays on and does not
flash or if it flashes abnormally, one of
the turn signal bulbs may be burned out
and will require replacement.
NOTICE
If the turn signal indicator stays on
and does not flash, or if it flashes
abnormally, a bulb may be burned out
or have a poor electrical connection
in the circuit. The bulb may require
replacement.
5-39
05
One-touch turn signal function
(if equipped)
To activate a one-touch turn signal
function, move the turn signal lever
slightly and then release it. The lane
change signals will blink 3 times.
NOTICE
If an indicator flash is abnormally quick
or slow, a bulb may be burned out or
have a poor electrical connection in the
circuit.
Battery saver function (if equipped)
The purpose of this feature is to prevent
the battery from being discharged.
The system automatically turns off the
position lamp when the driver turns the
engine off and opens the driver-side
door.
With this feature, the position lamps will
turn off automatically if the driver parks
on the side of road at night.
However, the position lamps stay
ON even when the driver-side door
is opened if the headlamp switch is
turned to the position lamp or AUTO (if
equipped) position after the engine is
turned off.
If necessary, to keep the lamps on
turn the position lamps OFF and ON
again using the headlamp switch on
the steering column after the engine is
turned off.
NOTICE
If the driver exits the vehicle through
another door besides the driver
door, the battery saver function
does not operate and the headlight
delay function does not turn OFF
automatically.
This may cause the battery to
discharge. To avoid battery discharge,
turn OFF the headlights manually from
the headlight switch before exiting the
vehicle.
Headlight escort function
(if equipped)
If you turn the ignition switch to the ACC
or LOCK position with the headlights
(Low) ON, the headlights remain on
for about 5 minutes. However, if the
driver’s door is opened and closed,
the headlights are turned off after 15
seconds.
The headlights can be turned off
by pressing the lock button on the
transmitter twice or turning the light
switch to the OFF position.
For deactivation or activation of this
feature, we recommend that you contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Headlight leveling device
(if equipped)
OAI3059028
OAI3059028
To adjust the headlight beam level
according to the number of the
passengers and loading weight in the
luggage area, turn the beam leveling
switch.
The higher the number of the switch
position, the lower the headlight beam
level. Always keep the headlight beam
at the proper leveling position, or
headlights may dazzle other road users.
5-40
Convenience Features
Listed below are the examples of proper
switch settings. For loading conditions
other than those listed below, adjust the
switch position so that the beam level
may be the nearest as the condition
obtained according to the list.
Loading condition Switch position
Driver only 0
Driver +
Front passenger 0
Full passengers
(including driver) 1
Full passengers
(including driver) +
Maximum permissible
loading
2
Driver + Maximum
permissible loading 3
Daytime running light (DRL)
(if equipped)
The Daytime Running Lights (DRL) can
make it easier for others to see the front
of your vehicle during the day, especially
after dawn and before sunset.
The DRL system will turn the dedicated
lamp OFF when:
1. The headlights or front fog lights are
in the ON position.
2. The engine is turned off.
Interior lights
WARNING
Do not use the interior lights when
driving in the dark. The interior lights
may obscure your view and cause an
accident.
NOTICE
Do not use the interior lights for
extended periods when the engine is
turned off or the battery will discharge.
5-41
05
Room lamp
OAH2048032
OAH2048032
(1) : In the OFF position, the light stays
off at all times even when a door is
opened.
(2): In the DOOR position, the light
comes on when any door is opened
regardless of the ignition switch
position.
When doors are unlocked by the
transmitter, the light comes on for
approximately 30 seconds as long
as any door is not opened. The light
goes out gradually after approximately
30 seconds if the door is closed.
However, if the ignition switch is ON
or all doors are locked, the light will go
out immediately.
If a door is opened with the ignition
switch in the ACC or LOCK position,
the light stays on for about 20
minutes.
However, if a door is opened with the
ignition switch in the ON position, the
light stays on continuously.
(3) : In the ON position, the light stays
on at all times.
NOTICE
Do not leave the lamp switches on for
an extended period of time when the
engine is turned off.
Luggage compartment lamp (if
equipped)
OAI3053029L
OAI3053029L
5 Door
5 Door
4 Door
4 Door
OAI3059063
OAI3059063
The luggage compartment lamp comes
on when the tailgate is opened.
NOTICE
The luggage compartment lamp comes
on as long as the tailgate/trunk lid is
open. To prevent unnecessary charging
system drain, close the tailgate/trunk
lid securely after using the tailgate/
trunk.
5-42
Convenience Features
Mood lamp (if equipped)
OAI3053070
OAI3053070
The lamp turns on when ‘Ambient Light’
is selected from the cluster User settings
menu.
5-43
05
WIPERS AND WASHERS
A : Wiper speed control
MIST Single wipe
OFF Off
• INT – Intermittent wipe*
• LO – Low wiper speed
• HI – High wiper speed
B : Wash with brief wipes (front)
* : if equipped
Front
Front
OAI3059064/OAI3059065
OAI3059064/OAI3059065
Type A
Type A
Type B
Type B
C : Rear wiper/washer control
(if equipped)
Wash with brief wipes
• ON – Continuous wipe
• OFF – Off
Rear
Rear
OAI3059066
OAI3059066
5-44
Convenience Features
Windshield wipers
Operates as follows when the ignition
switch is turned ON.
MIST : For a single wiping cycle, move
the lever upward (or downward)
and release it. The wipers will
operate continuously if the lever
is held in this position.
OFF : The wiper is not in operation
INT : The wiper operates intermittently
at the same wiping intervals. Use
this mode in light rain or mist. To
vary the speed setting, turn the
speed control knob. (if equipped)
LO : The wiper runs at a lower speed.
HI : The wiper runs at a higher speed.
i Information
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
or ice on the windshield, defrost the
windshield for about 10 minutes, or until
the snow and/or ice is removed before
using the windshield wipers, to ensure
proper operation.
If you do not remove the snow and/or ice
before using the wiper and washer, it may
damage the wiper and washer system.
Windshield washers
OAI3059067
OAI3059067
In the OFF position, pull the lever gently
toward you to spray washer fluid on the
windshield and to run the wipers 1-3
cycles. The spray and wiper operation
will continue until you release the lever.
If the washer does not work, you may
need to add washer fluid to the washer
fluid reservoir.
WARNING
When the outside temperature is below
freezing, ALWAYS warm the windshield
using the defroster to prevent the
washer fluid from freezing on the
windshield and obscuring your vision
which could result in an accident and
serious injury or death.
5-45
05
CAUTION
To prevent possible damage to the
washer pump, do not operate the
washer when the fluid reservoir is
empty.
To prevent possible damage to the
wipers or windshield, do not operate
the wipers when the windshield is
dry.
To prevent damage to the wiper
arms and other components, do
not attempt to move the wipers
manually.
To prevent possible damage to the
wipers and washer system, use anti-
freezing washer fluids in the winter
season or cold weather.
Rear window wiper and washer
switch (if equipped)
OAI3059068
OAI3059068
The rear window wiper and washer
switches are located at the end of the
wiper and washer switch lever.
Turn the switch to the desired position
to operate the rear wiper and washer.
– Wash with brief wipes
ON – Continuous wipe
OFF – Off
5-46
Convenience Features
OAI3059100
OAI3059100
(1) Temperature control knob
(2) Fan speed control knob
(3) Mode selection knob
(4) Air intake control button
(recirculated air position or outside (fresh) air position)
(5) A/C (Air conditioning) button
(6) Rear window defroster button (if equipped)
0$18$/&/,0$7(&21752/6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
5-47
05
Heating and air conditioning
1. Start the engine.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
To improve the effectiveness of heating and cooling :
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the desired position.
4. Set the air intake control to the outside (fresh) air or recirculated air position.
5. Set the fan speed control to the desired speed.
6. If the air conditioning is desired, turn the system (if equipped) on.
Mode selection
(if equipped)
(if equipped)
(if equipped)
(if equipped)
OAI3053103
OAI3053103
5-48
Convenience Features
OAI3059118
OAI3059118
The mode selection knob controls the
direction of the air flow through the
ventilation system.
Air can be directed to the floor,
dashboard outlets, or windshield. Five
symbols are used to represent Face,
Bi-Level, Floor, Floor-Defrost and
Defrost air position.
Face-Level (B, D, E)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E)
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
Floor-Level (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield, side
window defrosters and side vents.
Floor/Defrost-Level (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters and side vents.
Defrost-Level (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side vents.
5-49
05
Front
Front
OAI3059104
OAI3059104
Rear (if equipped)
Rear (if equipped)
OAI3059105
OAI3059105
Instrument panel vents
You can adjust the direction of air
delivered from these vents using the
vent control lever as shown.
The outlet vents located in the rear can
be opened or closed separately using
the thumbwheel.
Temperature control
OAI3059119
OAI3059119
The temperature will increase by turning
the knob to the right.
The temperature will decrease by
turning the knob to the left.
Air intake control
OAI3059106
OAI3059106
This button is used to select the outside
(fresh) air position or recirculated air
position.
5-50
Convenience Features
Recirculation mode
The indicator light on the
button illuminates when
the recirculated air
position is selected.
With the recirculated air
position selected, air from
the passenger
compartment will be
drawn through the climate
control system and heated
or cooled according to the
function selected.
Fresh mode
The indicator light on the
button will turn off when
the outside (fresh) air
position is selected.
With the outside (fresh) air
position selected, air
enters the vehicle from
outside and is heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
i Information
Prolonged use of the air conditioning with
the recirculated air position selected will
result in excessive dry air in the passenger
compartment.
WARNING
Continued use of the climate control
system operation in the recirculated
air position can cause drowsiness
or sleepiness, that may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident. Set the air intake control
to the outside (fresh) air position as
much as possible while driving.
Continued use of the climate
control system operation in the
recirculated air position (without
the air conditioning selected) may
allow humidity to increase inside the
vehicle which may fog the glass and
obscure visibility.
Do not sleep in a vehicle with the air
conditioning or heating system on. It
may cause serious harm or death due
to a drop in the oxygen level and/or
body temperature.
5-51
05
Fan speed control
OAI3059117
OAI3059117
Turn the knob to the right to increase
the fan speed and airflow. Turn the knob
to the left to decrease fan speed and
airflow.
Air conditioning (A/C)
(if equipped)
OAI3059107
OAI3059107
Press the A/C button to turn the air
conditioning system on (indicator light
will illuminate). Press the button again to
turn the air conditioning system off.
System operation
Ventilation
1. Select the Face Level mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
1. Select the Floor Level mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If desired, turn the air conditioning ON
with the temperature control knob set
to heat in order to dehumidify the air
before it enters into the cabin.
If the windshield fogs up, select the
Floor & Defrost mode or press the
Front Defrost mode.
Operation Tips
To keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through the
ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculation
mode. Be sure to return the control
to fresh mode position when the
irritation has passed to keep fresh air
in the vehicle. This will help keep the
driver alert and comfortable.
To prevent interior fog on the
windshield, set the air intake control
to fresh mode and fan speed to
the desired position, turn on the
air conditioning system, and adjust
the temperature control to desired
temperature.
5-52
Convenience Features
Air conditioning (if equipped)
HYUNDAI Air Conditioning Systems are
filled with R-134a refrigerant.
1. Start the engine.
2. Push the air conditioning button.
3. Select the Face Level mode.
4. Set the air intake control to the
Recirculation mode temporarily to
allow the cabin to cool quickly. When
the desired temperature in the cabin
is reached, change the air intake
control back to Fresh mode.
5. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
NOTICE
The refrigerant system should only
be serviced by trained and certified
technicians to insure proper and safe
operation.
The refrigerant system should be
serviced in a well-ventilated place.
i Information
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the temperature gauge closely
while driving up hills or in heavy traffic
when outside temperatures are high.
Air conditioning system operation may
cause engine overheating. Continue
to use the blower fan but turn the
air conditioning system off if the
temperature gauge indicates engine
overheating.
When opening the windows in humid
weather, air conditioning may create
water droplets inside the vehicle. Since
excessive water droplets may cause
damage to electrical equipment, air
conditioning should only be used with
the windows closed.
5-53
05
Air conditioning system operation tips
If the vehicle has been parked in direct
sunlight during hot weather, open the
windows for a short time to let the hot
air inside the vehicle escape.
After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from
recirculation mode to fresh mode.
To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
During the air conditioning system
operation, you may occasionally
notice a slight change in engine speed
as the air conditioning compressor
cycles. This is a normal system
operation characteristic.
Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system
performance.
When using the air conditioning
system, you may notice clear water
dripping (or even puddling) on the
ground under the passenger side of
the vehicle. This is a normal system
operation characteristic.
If you operate the air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause the
outer surface of the windshield to fog
up, causing loss of visibility. In this
case, set the mode selection button to
the position and set the fan speed
control knob to the lowest speed
setting.
System maintenance
Climate control air filter
OIK047401L
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Climate control air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
This filter is installed behind the glove
box. It filters the dust or other pollutants
that enter the vehicle through the
heating and air conditioning system.
We recommend that the climate control
air filter be replaced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer according to the
maintenance schedule. If the vehicle is
being driven in severe conditions such
as dusty or rough roads, more frequent
climate control filter inspections and
changes are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
we recommend the system be checked
at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
Replace the filter according to the
Maintenance Schedule.
If the car is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty, rough roads,
more frequent climate control air filter
inspections and changes are required.
When the air flow rate suddenly
decreases, we recommend that the
system be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-54
Convenience Features
Checking the amount of air
conditioner refrigerant and
compressor lubricant
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also has a bad
influence on the air conditioning system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, we recommend that the system
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
It is important that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, damage to the compressor
and abnormal system operation may
occur. To prevent damage, the air
conditioning system in your vehicle
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-134a
Since the refrigerant is
operated at very high
pressure, the air
conditioning system should
only be serviced by trained
and certified technicians.
All refrigerants should be reclaimed
with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to the
atmosphere is harmful to individuals
and environment. Failure to heed these
warnings can lead to serious injuries.
5-55
05
OAI3059101I
OAI3059101I
1. Fan speed control knob
2. A/C (Air conditioning) button
3. Recirculation mode/Fresh mode
4. Mode selection button
5. Rear window defroster button
(if equipped)
6. Front windshield defroster button
7. OFF button
8. Temperature control knob
9. AUTO (automatic control) button
10. Climate control screen
$8720$7,&&/,0$7(&21752/6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
5-56
Convenience Features
Automatic heating and air
conditioning
The Automatic Climate Control System
is controlled by setting the desired
temperature.
OAI3059110I
OAI3059110I
1. Press the AUTO button.
The modes, fan speeds, air intake and
air-conditioning will be controlled
automatically by the temperature setting
you select.
OAI3059111I
OAI3059111I
2. Turn the temperature control knob
to set the desired temperature. If
the temperature is set to the lowest
setting (Lo), the air conditioning
system will operate continuously.
To turn the automatic operation off,
select any button of the following:
- Mode selection button
- Front windshield defrost button (Press
the button one more time to deselect
the front windshield defroster function.
- Fan speed control button
The selected function will be controlled
manually while other functions operate
automatically.
For your convenience and to improve
the effectiveness of the climate control,
use the AUTO button and set the
temperature to 23°C (73°F).
i Information
OAI3059112I
OAI3059112I
Never place anything near the sensor
located to ensure better control of the
heating and cooling system.
5-57
05
Manual heating and air conditioning
The heating and cooling system can be controlled manually by pressing buttons other
than the AUTO button. In this case, the system works sequentially according to the
order of buttons selected.
When pressing any button (or turning any knob) except the AUTO button while using
automatic operation, the functions not selected will be controlled automatically.
1. Start the engine.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
To improve the effectiveness of heating and cooling:
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the desired position.
4. Press the fresh button.
5. Set the fan speed control to the desired speed.
6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the air conditioning system on.
7. Press the AUTO button in order to convert to full automatic control of the system.
Mode selection
OAI3053103
OAI3053103
5-58
Convenience Features
OAI3059113I
OAI3059113I
The mode selection button controls the
direction of the air flow through the
ventilation system.
Face-Level (B, D, E)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E)
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
Floor-Level (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield, side
window defrosters and side vents.
Floor/Defrost-Level
(A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters and side vents.
OAI3059114I
OAI3059114I
Defrost-Level (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
5-59
05
Front
Front
OAI3059104
OAI3059104
Rear
Rear
OAI3059105
OAI3059105
Instrument panel vents
You can adjust the direction of air
delivered from these vents using the
vent control lever as shown.
The outlet vents located in the rear can
be opened or closed separately using
the thumbwheel.
Temperature control
OAI3059111I
OAI3059111I
The temperature will increase by turning
the knob to the right.
The temperature will decrease by
turning the knob to the left.
The temperature will increase or
decrease by 0.5 °C (1 °F) for each time
you turn the knob. When set to the
lowest temperature setting, the air
conditioning will operate continuously.
5-60
Convenience Features
Air intake control
OAI3059106I
OAI3059106I
The air intake control button is used to
select either Fresh mode (outside air) or
Recirculation mode (cabin air).
Recirculated air position
The indicator light on the
button illuminates when
the recirculated air
position is selected.
With the recirculated air
position selected, air from
the passenger
compartment will be
drawn through the climate
control system and heated
or cooled according to the
function selected.
Outside (fresh) air position
The indicator light on the
button will turn off when
the outside (fresh) air
position is selected.
With the outside (fresh) air
position selected, air
enters the vehicle from
outside and is heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
i Information
Operating the system primarily in Fresh
mode is recommended. Use Recirculation
mode temporarily only when needed.
Prolonged operation of the heater in
Recirculation mode and without the A/C
ON can cause fogging of the windshield.
In addition, prolonged use of the A/C
ON in Recirculation mode may result in
excessively dry, dehumidified air in the
cabin and may promote formation of
musty vent odor due to stagnant air.
WARNING
Continued use of the climate control
system operation in the recirculated
air position can cause drowsiness
or sleepiness, that may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident. Set the air intake control to
the outside (fresh) mode as much as
possible while driving.
Continued use of the climate
control system operation in the
recirculated air position (without
the air conditioning selected) may
allow humidity to increase inside the
vehicle which may fog the glass and
obscure visibility.
Do not sleep in a vehicle with the air
conditioning or heating system on. It
may cause serious harm or death due
to a drop in the oxygen level and/or
body temperature.
5-61
05
Fan speed control
OAI3059115I
OAI3059115I
Turn the knob to the right to increase
the fan speed and air flow. Turn the
knob to the left to decrease fan speed
and air flow.
NOTICE
Operating the fan speed when the
ignition switch is in the ON position
could cause the battery to discharge.
Operate the fan speed when the engine
is running.
Air conditioning
OAI3059107I
OAI3059107I
Push the A/C button to manually turn
the system on (indicator light will
illuminate) and off.
OFF mode
OAI3059116I
OAI3059116I
Push the OFF button to turn off the
climate control system. You can still
operate the mode and air intake buttons
with the ignition switch in the ON
position.
5-62
Convenience Features
System operation
Ventilation
1. Select the Face Level mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
1. Select the Floor Level mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If desired, turn the air conditioning ON
with the temperature control knob set
to heat in order to dehumidify the air
before it enters into the cabin.
If the windshield fogs up, select the
Front Defrost mode.
Operation Tips
To keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through the
ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculation
mode. Be sure to return the control
to fresh mode position when the
irritation has passed to keep fresh air
in the vehicle. This will help keep the
driver alert and comfortable.
To prevent interior fog on the
windshield, set the air intake control
to fresh mode and fan speed to
the desired position, turn on the
air conditioning system, and adjust
the temperature control to desired
temperature.
Air conditioning
HYUNDAI Air Conditioning Systems are
filled with R-134a refrigerant.
1. Start the engine.
2. Push the air conditioning button.
3. Select the Face Level mode.
4. Set the air intake control to the
Recirculation mode temporarily to
allow the cabin to cool quickly. When
the desired temperature in the cabin
is reached, change the air intake
control back to Fresh mode.
5. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
5-63
05
NOTICE
The refrigerant system should only
be serviced by trained and certified
technicians to insure proper and safe
operation.
The refrigerant system should be
serviced in a well-ventilated place.
i Information
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the temperature gauge closely
while driving up hills or in heavy traffic
when outside temperatures are high.
Air conditioning system operation may
cause engine overheating. Continue
to use the blower fan but turn the
air conditioning system off if the
temperature gauge indicates engine
overheating.
When opening the windows in humid
weather, air conditioning may create
water droplets inside the vehicle. Since
excessive water droplets may cause
damage to electrical equipment, air
conditioning should only be used with
the windows closed.
Air conditioning system operation tips
If the vehicle has been parked in direct
sunlight during hot weather, open the
windows for a short time to let the hot
air inside the vehicle escape.
After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from the
recirculation mode to the fresh mode.
To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
During the air conditioning system
operation, you may occasionally
notice a slight change in engine speed
as the air conditioning compressor
cycles. This is a normal system
operation characteristic.
Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system
performance.
When using the air conditioning
system, you may notice clear water
dripping (or even puddling) on the
ground under the passenger side of
the vehicle. This is a normal system
operation characteristic.
If you operate the air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause the
outer surface of the windshield to fog
up, causing loss of visibility. In this
case, set the mode selection button to
the position and set the fan speed
control knob to the lowest speed
setting.
5-64
Convenience Features
System maintenance
Climate control air filter
OIK047401L
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Climate control air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
This filter is installed behind the glove
box. It filters the dust or other pollutants
that enter the vehicle through the
heating and air conditioning system.
We recommend that the climate control
air filter be replaced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer according to the
maintenance schedule. If the vehicle is
being driven in severe conditions such
as dusty or rough roads, more frequent
climate control filter inspections and
changes are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
we recommend the system be checked
at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
Replace the filter according to the
Maintenance Schedule.
If the car is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty, rough roads,
more frequent climate control air filter
inspections and changes are required.
When the air flow rate suddenly
decreases, we recommend that the
system be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Checking the amount of air
conditioner refrigerant and
compressor lubricant
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also has a bad
influence on the air conditioning system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, we recommend that the system
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
It is important that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, damage to the compressor
and abnormal system operation may
occur. To prevent damage, the air
conditioning system in your vehicle
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-134a
Since the refrigerant is
operated at very high
pressure, the air
conditioning system should
only be serviced by trained
and certified technicians.
All refrigerants should be reclaimed
with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to the
atmosphere is harmful to individuals
and environment. Failure to heed these
warnings can lead to serious injuries.
5-65
05
WARNING
Do not use the or position
during cooling operation in extremely
humid weather. The difference
between the temperature of the
outside air and that of the windshield
could cause the outer surface of the
windshield to fog up, causing loss of
visibility. Set the mode selection to the
position and fan speed control to a
lower speed.
For maximum defrosting, set the
temperature control to the extreme
right/hot position and the fan speed
control to the highest speed.
If warm air to the floor is desired while
defrosting or defogging, set the mode
to the floor-defrost position.
Before driving, clear all snow and ice
from the windshield, rear window,
outside rear view mirrors, and all side
windows.
Clear all snow and ice from the hood
and air inlet at the buttom of the
windshield.
i Information
If the engine temperature is still cold after
starting, then a brief engine warm up
period may be required for the vented air
flow to become warm or hot.
Manual climate control system
To defog inside windshield
OAI3059108
OAI3059108
1. Select desired fan speed.
2. Select desired temperature.
3. Select the or position.
4. The outside (fresh) air will be selected
automatically. Additionally, the
air conditioning will automatically
operate if the mode is selected to the
or position.
If the air conditioning and outside (fresh)
mode are not selected automatically,
press the corresponding button
manually.
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING
5-66
Convenience Features
To defrost outside windshield
OAI3059109
OAI3059109
1. Set the fan speed to the highest
(extreme right) position.
2. Set the temperature to the extreme
hot position.
3. Select the position.
4. The outside (fresh) mode and
air conditioning will be selected
automatically.
Automatic climate control
system
To defog inside windshield
OAI3059108I
OAI3059108I
1. Select desired blower speed.
2. Select desired temperature.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The air-conditioning will turn on
according to the detected ambient
temperature, fresh mode and higher
blower speed will be selected
automatically.
If the air-conditioning, the fresh
mode and higher blower speed are
not selected automatically, adjust the
corresponding button or knob manually.
If the position is selected, lower
blower speed is controlled to higher
blower speed.
5-67
05
To defrost outside windshield
OAI3059109I
OAI3059109I
1. Set blower speed to the highest
position.
2. Set temperature to the extreme hot
(HI) position.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The air-conditioning will turn on
according to the detected ambient
temperature and fresh mode will be
selected automatically.
If the position is selected, lower
blower speed is controlled to higher
blower speed.
Defroster
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the conductors
bonded to the inside surface of the rear
window, never use sharp instruments
or window cleaners containing
abrasives to clean the window.
i Information
If you want to defrost and defog the
front windshield, refer to “Windshield
Defrosting and Defogging” in this chapter.
5-68
Convenience Features
Rear window defroster (if equipped)
Manual climate control system
Manual climate control system
OAI3059102
OAI3059102
Automatic climate control system
Automatic climate control system
OAI3059102I
OAI3059102I
The defroster heats the window to
remove frost, fog and thin ice from the
interior and exterior of the rear window,
while engine is running.
To activate the rear window defroster,
press the rear window defroster
button located in the center facia
switch panel. The indicator on the rear
window defroster button illuminates
when the defroster is ON.
To turn off the defroster, press the rear
window defroster button again.
i Information
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
on the rear window, brush it off before
operating the rear defroster.
The rear window defroster
automatically turns off after
approximately 20 minutes or when the
ignition switch is in the LOCK/OFF
position.
5-69
05
WARNING
Flammable materials
Do not store cigarette lighters,
propane cylinders, or other flammable/
explosive materials in the vehicle.
These items may catch fire and/or
explode if the vehicle is exposed to hot
temperatures for extended periods.
WARNING
ALWAYS keep the storage
compartment covers closed securely
while driving. Items inside your vehicle
are moving as fast as the vehicle. If you
have to stop or turn quickly, or if there
is a crash, the items may fly out of the
compartment and may cause an injury
if they strike the driver or a passenger.
NOTICE
To avoid possible theft, do not leave
valuables in the storage compartment.
Center console storage
(if equipped)
Type A
Type A
OAI3059032
OAI3059032
Type B
Type B
OAI3053078
OAI3053078
Type C
Type C
OAI3059034
OAI3059034
These compartments can be used to
store small item.
STORAGE COMPARTMENT
5-70
Convenience Features
Glove box
OAI3059035
OAI3059035
To open the glove box, pull the lever and
the glove box will automatically open.
Close the glove box after use.
WARNING
ALWAYS close the glove box door after
use.
An open glove box door can cause
serious injury to the passenger in an
accident, even if the passenger is
wearing a seat belt.
Cool box (if equipped)
OAI3059036
OAI3059036
You can keep beverage cans or other
items cool in the glove box.
1. Turn on the air conditioning.
2. Turn the open/close switch of the vent
installed in the glove box to the open
position.
3. When the cool box is not used, turn
the switch to the closed position.
WARNING
Do not put perishable food in the cool
box because it may not maintain the
necessary consistent temperature to
keep the food fresh.
i Information
If the vent is blocked by items in the
coolbox, cooling will be reduced.
If the climate control system’s
temperature control is in the warm
or hot position, Cold air only will flow
into the glove box.
5-71
05
Clock (if equipped)
WARNING
Do not adjust the clock while driving.
You may lose your steering control
and cause severe personal injury or
accidents.
Cup holder
Front
OAI3059038
OAI3059038
Cups or small beverage cans may be
placed in the cup holders.
Rear (if equipped)
OAI3059057
OAI3059057
To use the center cup holder, pull down
the armrest
WARNING
Avoid abrupt starting and braking
when the cup holder is in use to
prevent spilling your drink. If hot
liquid spills, you could be burned.
Such a burn to the driver could cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Do not place uncovered or unsecured
cups, bottles, cans, etc., in the cup
holder containing hot liquid while
the vehicle is in motion. Injuries may
result in the event of sudden stop or
collision.
Only use soft cups in the cup holders.
Hard objects can injure you in an
accident.
WARNING
Keep cans or bottles out of direct sun
light and do not put them in a hot
vehicle. It may explode.
NOTICE
Keep your drinks sealed while driving
to prevent spilling your drink. If liquid
spills, it may get into the vehicle’s
electrical/electronic system and
damage electrical/electronic parts.
When cleaning spilled liquids,
do not dry the cup holder at high
temperature. This may damage the
cup holder.
INTERIOR FEATURES
5-72
Convenience Features
Sunvisor
OAI3059051I
OAI3059051I
Driver's side
Driver's side
Passenger's side
Passenger's side
OAI3059052I
OAI3059052I
Use the sunvisor to shield direct light
through the front or side windows.
To use a sunvisor for a side window, pull
it downward, unsnap it from the bracket
(1) and swing it to the side (2).
A mirror (4, if equipped) and ticket
holder (3, if equipped) are provided on
the sunvisor.
WARNING
For your safety, do not block your view
when using the sunvisor.
NOTICE
Do not put several tickets in the ticket
holder at one time. This could cause
damage to the ticket holder.
Power outlet (if equipped)
OAI3053079
OAI3053079
Front
Front
Rear
Rear
OAI3059040
OAI3059040
The power outlet is designed to provide
power for mobile telephones or other
devices designed to operate with vehicle
electrical systems. The devices should
draw less than 120 W (Watt) with the
engine running.
WARNING
Avoid electrical shocks. Do not place
your fingers or foreign objects (pin,
etc.) into a power outlet or touch the
power outlet with a wet hand.
5-73
05
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the Power outlet:
Use the power outlet only when the
engine is running and remove the
accessory plug after use. Using the
accessory plug for prolonged periods
of time with the engine off could
cause the battery to discharge.
Only use 12 V electric accessories
which are less than 120 W (Watt) in
electric capacity.
Adjust the air-conditioner or heater
to the lowest operating level when
using the power outlet.
Close the cover when not in use.
Some electronic devices can cause
electronic interference when plugged
into a vehicle’s power outlet. These
devices may cause excessive audio
static and malfunctions in other
electronic systems or devices used in
your vehicle.
Push the plug in as far as it will go.
If good contact is not made, the
plug may overheat or the internal
temperature fuse may open.
Plug in battery equipped electrical/
electronic devices with the reverse
current protection. The current
from the battery may flow into the
vehicle’s electrical/electronic system
and cause system malfunction.
USB charger (if equipped)
OAI3053080
OAI3053080
Front
Front
Rear
Rear
OAI3050070
OAI3050070
The USB charger is designed to recharge
batteries of small size electrical devices
using a USB cable.
The electrical devices can be recharged
when the ignition switch is in the ACC,
ON or START position.
The battery charging state may be
monitored on the electrical device.
Disconnect the USB cable from the USB
port after use.
A smart phone or a tablet PC may
get warmer during the re-charging
process. It does not indicate any
malfunction with the charging system.
A smart phone or a tablet PC, which
adopts a different re-charging
method, may not be properly
re-charged. In this case, use an
exclusive charger of your device.
The charging terminal is only to
recharge a device. Do not use the
charging terminal either to turn ON
an audio or to play media on the
infotainment system.
5-74
Convenience Features
Coat hook (if equipped)
OIB044031
OIB044031
These hooks are not designed to hold
large or heavy items.
WARNING
OIB047192
OIB047192
Do not hang other objects such
as hangers or hard objects except
clothes. Also, do not put heavy, sharp
or breakable objects in the clothes
pockets. In an accident or when the
curtain airbag is inflated, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury.
Floor mat anchor(s)
(if equipped)
OAI3059042
OAI3059042
ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors to
attach the front floor mats to the vehicle.
The anchors on the front floor carpet
keep the floor mats from sliding forward.
WARNING
The following must be observed when
installing ANY floor mat to the vehicle.
Ensure that the floor mats are
securely attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchor(s) before driving the
vehicle.
Do not use ANY floor mat that cannot
be firmly attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchors.
Do not stack floor mats on top of one
another (for example, all-weather
rubber mat on top of a carpeted floor
mat). Only a single floor mat should
be installed in each position.
IMPORTANT - Your vehicle was
manufactured with driver’s side floor
mat anchors that are designed to
securely hold the floor mat in place.
To avoid any interference with pedal
operation, HYUNDAI recommends that
the HYUNDAI floor mat designed for
use in your vehicle be installed.
5-75
05
Cargo area cover
(5 Door, if equipped)
OAI3053044L
OAI3053044L
Use the cargo area cover to hide items
stored in the cargo area.
The cargo area cover can be uprighted
or removed.
WARNING
Do not place objects on the cargo
area cover. Such objects may be
thrown about inside the vehicle and
possibly injure vehicle occupants
during an accident or braking.
Never allow anyone to ride in the
luggage compartment. It is designed
for luggage only.
NOTICE
Do not put luggage on the cover since
it may be damaged or malformed.
Roof rack (if equipped)
OAI3059049I
OAI3059049I
Do not load cargo on the roof. The roof
lack is not for loading cargo but for
aesthetic purpose.
EXTERIOR FEATURES
5-76
Convenience Features
INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM
NOTICE
If you install an aftermarket HID
head lamp, your vehicle’s audio and
electronic device may malfunction.
Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand
cleaner, and air freshener from
contacting the interior parts because
they may cause damage, button
struck issues or discoloration.
USB port (if equipped)
OAI3053045
OAI3053045
You can use a USB port to plug in USB to
play music.
NOTE : Please go through USB
compatibility list in HYUNDAI India
website.
i Information
When using a portable audio device
connected to the power outlet, noise may
occur during playback. If this happens,
use the power source of the portable audio
device.
Depending on the car model above
layout may be vary.
Antenna
Type A
Type A
OAI3059048
OAI3059048
Type A
The roof antenna receives both AM and
FM broadcast signals. Rotate the roof
antenna in a counterclockwise direction
to remove it. Rotate it in a clockwise
direction to reinstall it.
Type B
Type B
OAI3059046
OAI3059046
Type B
The shark fin antenna receives
transmitted data. (for example: AM/FM)
5-77
05
Type C
Type C
OAI3059047
OAI3059047
Type C
This antenna is dummy for aesthetic
purpose.
NOTICE
Before entering a place with a low
height clearance, be sure that the
antenna is removed.
Be sure to remove the antenna before
washing the vehicle in an automatic
car wash or it may be damaged.
When reinstalling your antenna, it is
important that it is fully tightened
and adjusted to the upright position
to ensure proper reception. But it
could be removed when parking the
vehicle.
NOTICE
Installation of aftermarket antenna may
result in water leakage, wind noise,
rattling & improper radio operation.
We recommend to use the antenna
available with an authorized Hyundai
dealer.
i Information
Some models do not have audio (plastic
blanking cover) system, and will not
supply radio main cable. Thus if you want
to insert an aftermarket audio or OEM
audio to listen radio broadcasting service,
we recommend to use the feeder cable
available with an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Steering wheel audio control
(if equipped)
Type A
Type A
OQXI049068L
OQXI049068L
Type B
Type B
OQXI049069L
OQXI049069L
Type C
Type C
OQX059012L
OQX059012L
The steering wheel audio control
switches are installed for your
convenience.
NOTICE
Do not operate audio remote control
buttons simultaneously.
5-78
Convenience Features
VOLUME (VOL + / VOL -) (1)
Move the VOLUME toggle switch up to
increase volume.
Move the VOLUME toggle switch
down to decrease volume.
SEEK/PRESET ( / ) (2)
If the SEEK/PRESET toggle switch is
moved up or down and held for 0.8
seconds or more, it will function in the
following modes.
RADIO mode
It will function as the AUTO SEEK select
switch. It will SEEK until you release the
switch.
MEDIA mode
It will function as the FF/REW switch
(except in Bluetooth audio mode).
If the SEEK/PRESET toggle switch is
moved up or down, it will function in the
following modes.
RADIO mode
It will function as the PRESET STATION
UP/DOWN switch.
MEDIA mode
It will function as the TRACK UP/ DOWN
switch.
MODE ( ) (3)
Press the MODE button to select RADIO/
MEDIA/Bluetooth Audio, etc.
MUTE ( ) (4, if equipped)
Press the button to mute the sound.
Press the button again to activate the
sound.
During a call, press to turn off the
microphone.
i Information
Detailed information for audio control
buttons are described in the following
pages in this chapter.
Audio/Video (if equipped)
Detailed information for the system
is described in a separately supplied
manual.
5-79
05
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
hands-free (if equipped)
OQXI049071
OQXI049071
OAH2048050
OAH2048050
You can use the phone wirelessly
by using the Bluetooth® Wireless
Technology.
(1) Call / Answer button
(2) Call end button
(3) Microphone
Audio : For detailed information, refer
to “AUDIO” in this chapter.
Navigation : Detailed information for
the Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
hands-free is described in the manual
supplied separately.
Depending on the car model above
layout may be vary.
How vehicle audio works
FM reception
FM reception
JBM001
JBM001
AM and FM radio signals are broadcast
from transmitter towers located around
your city. They are intercepted by the
radio antenna on your vehicle. This
signal is then processed by the radio and
sent to your vehicle speakers.
When a strong radio signal has reached
your vehicle, the precise engineering
of your audio system ensures the best
possible quality reproduction. However,
in some cases the signal coming to your
vehicle may not be strong and clear.
This can be due to factors, such as
the distance from the radio station,
closeness of other strong radio stations
or the presence of buildings, bridges or
other large obstructions in the area.
5-80
Convenience Features
FM reception
FM reception
JBM002
JBM002
AM broadcasts can be received at
greater distances than FM broadcasts.
This is because AM radio waves are
transmitted at low frequencies. These
long distance, low frequency radio
waves can follow the curvature of the
earth rather than travelling straight. In
addition, they curve around obstructions
resulting in better signal coverage.
FM reception
FM reception
JBM003
JBM003
FM broadcasts are transmitted at high
frequencies and do not bend to follow
the earth’s surface. Because of this,
FM broadcasts generally begin to fade
within short distances from the station.
Also, FM signals are easily affected by
buildings, mountains, and obstructions.
This can lead to undesirable or
unpleasant listening conditions which
might lead you to believe a problem
exists with your radio.
The following conditions are normal and
do not indicate radio trouble:
FM reception
FM reception
JBM004
JBM004
Fading - As your vehicle moves away
from the radio station, the signal will
weaken and sound will begin to fade.
When this occurs, we suggest that you
select another stronger station.
Flutter/Static - Weak FM signals
or large obstructions between the
transmitter and your radio can disturb
the signal causing static or fluttering
noises to occur. Reducing the treble
level may lessen this effect until the
disturbance clears.
5-81
05
FM reception
FM reception
OJF045311L
OJF045311L
Multi-Path Cancellation - Radio signals
being received from several directions
can cause distortion or fluttering.
This can be caused by a direct and
reflected signal from the same station,
or by signals from two stations with
close frequencies. If this occurs, select
another station until the condition has
passed.
Using a cellular phone or a two-way
radio
When a cellular phone is used inside
the vehicle, noise may be produced
from the audio system. This does not
mean that something is wrong with the
audio equipment. In such a case, use
the cellular phone at a place as far as
possible from the audio equipment.
NOTICE
When using a communication system
such as a cellular phone or a radio set
inside the vehicle, a separate external
antenna must be fitted. When a cellular
phone or a radio set is used with an
internal antenna alone, it may interfere
with the vehicle’s electrical system and
adversely affect safe operation of the
vehicle.
While listening to the radio, if devices
such as laptop charger are connected
to the socket, it may generate noise.
WARNING
Do not use a cellular phone while
driving. Stop at a safe location to use a
cellular phone.
iPod®
iPod® is a registered trademark of Apple
Inc.
Bluetooth® Wireless
Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos
are registered trademarks owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such
marks by HYUNDAI is under license.
Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
A
Bluetooth
® Wireless Technology
enabled cell phone is required to use
Bluetooth
® Wireless Technology.
5-82
Convenience Features
System layout – control panel
Type A
Type A
$8',2ǣ:,7+287728&+6&5((1Ǥ
(1) RADIO button
Press to display the radio mode
selection window.
When the mode selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired mode and then
press the knob.
When the Mode Popup is not selected
in [MENU/CLOCK] X Mode Popup,
press the [RADIO] button on the
control panel to change the mode.
Each time you press the [RADIO]
button on the control panel, the mode
switches to radio FM X AM in order.
(2) MEDIA button
Play content from a media storage de-
vice.
(3) FAV button
While listening to the radio, press to
move to next page of the preset list.
(4) POWER button/VOL knob
Press to turn the system on or off.
Turn to the left or right to adjust the
system sound volume.
The system’s actual appearance and layout may differ depending on the vehicle
model and specification.
5-83
05
Type A
Type A
(5) SEEK/TRACK button
• Change the station/track/file.
While listening to the radio, press and
hold to search for a station.
While playing media, press and hold to
rewind or fast forward.
(6) MENU button/CLOCK button
Press to access the menu screen for
the current mode.
Press and hold to access the time
setup screen.
(7) TUNE knob/FILE knob/ENTER button
While listening to the radio, turn to
adjust the frequency.
While playing media, turn to search for
a track/file.
While searching by turning the knob,
press to select the current track/file.
(8) Number buttons
(1 RPT~ 4 BACK)
While listening to the radio, press to
listen to a saved radio station.
While listening to the radio, press and
hold to save the current radio station
to the preset.
In the USB/Bluetooth audio modes,
press the [1 RPT] button to change the
repeat play mode. Press the
[2 SHFL] button to change the shuffle
play mode.
Press the [4 BACK] button to return
to the previous screen (except for the
radio preset list).
The system’s actual appearance and layout may differ depending on the vehicle
model and specification.
5-84
Convenience Features
(With Bluetooth® Wireless Technology)
Type B
Type B
(1) AUDIO button
Press to display the radio/media mode
selection window.
When the mode selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired mode and then
press the knob.
When the Mode Popup is not selected
in [MENU/CLOCK] X Mode Popup,
press the [AUDIO] button on the
control panel to change the mode.
Each time you press the [AUDIO]
button on the control panel, the mode
switches to radio X media in order.
(2) PHONE button
Press to start connecting a mobile
phone via Bluetooth.
After a Bluetooth phone connection is
made, press to access the Bluetooth
phone menu.
(3) FAV button
While listening to the radio, press to
move to next page of the preset list.
(4) POWER button/VOL knob
Press to turn the system on or off.
Turn to the left or right to adjust the
system sound volume.
The system’s actual appearance and layout may differ depending on the vehicle
model and specification.
5-85
05
(With Bluetooth® Wireless Technology)
Type B
Type B
The system’s actual appearance and layout may differ depending on the vehicle
model and specification.
(5) SEEK/TRACK button
• Change the station/track/file.
While listening to the radio, press and
hold to search for a station.
While playing media, press and hold to
rewind or fast forward (except for the
Bluetooth audio mode).
(6) MENU button/CLOCK button
Press to access the menu screen for
the current mode.
Press and hold to access the time
setup screen.
(7) TUNE knob/FILE knob/ENTER button
While listening to the radio, turn to
adjust the frequency.
While playing media, turn to search for
a track/file (except for the Bluetooth
audio mode).
While searching by turning the knob,
press to select the current track/file
(except for the Bluetooth audio mode).
(8) Number buttons
(1 RPT~ 4 BACK)
While listening to the radio, press to
listen to a saved radio station.
While listening to the radio, press and
hold to save the current radio station
to the preset.
In the USB/Bluetooth audio modes,
press the [1 RPT] button to change the
repeat play mode. Press the [2 SHFL]
button to change the shuffle play
mode.
• Press the [4 BACK] button to return
to the previous screen (except for the
radio preset list).
5-86
Convenience Features
System layout – steering wheel
remote control
1 2
34
56
(Bluetooth® equipped model)
ÃThe system’s actual appearance and
layout may differ depending on the
vehicle model and specification.
(1) MUTE button
Press to mute or unmute the system.
During a call, press to mute or unmute
the microphone.
While playing media, press to pause or
resume playback. (if equipped)
(2) MODE button
Press to switch between radio and
media modes.
Press and hold to turn the system on
or off.
(3) Volume lever
Push up or down to adjust the
volume.
(4) Up/Down lever
• Change the station/track/file.
While listening to the radio, push to
listen to the previous/next saved radio
station.
While listening to the radio, push and
hold to search for a station.
While playing media, push and hold to
rewind or fast forward (except for the
Bluetooth audio mode).
(5) Call/Answer button
Press to start connecting a mobile
phone via Bluetooth.
After a Bluetooth phone connection
is made, press to access your call
history. Press and hold to dial the most
recent phone number. When a call
comes in, press to answer the call.
During a call, press to switch between
the active call and the held call. Press
and hold to switch the call between
the system and the mobile phone.
(6) Call end button
When a call comes in, reject the call.
During a call, end the call.
5-87
05
WARNING - About driving
Do not operate the system while
driving. Driving while distracted may
result in a loss of vehicle control,
potentially leading to an accident,
severe personal injury, or death.
The driver’s primary responsibility
is the safe and legal operation of a
vehicle, and any handheld devices,
equipment, or vehicle systems which
divert the driver’s attention from this
responsibility should never be used
during operation of the vehicle.
Avoid watching the screen while
driving. Driving while distracted
may lead to a traffic accident. Stop
your vehicle in a safe location before
using functions that require multiple
operations.
Stop your vehicle first before using
your mobile phone. Using a mobile
phone while driving may lead to a
traffic accident. If necessary, use the
Bluetooth Handsfree feature to make
calls and keep the call as short as
possible.
Keep the volume low enough to hear
external sounds. Driving without the
ability to hear external sounds may
lead to a traffic accident. Listening
to a loud volume for a long time may
cause hearing damage.
WARNING
- About handling the system
Do not disassemble or modify the
system. Doing so may result in an
accident, fire, or electric shock.
Do not allow liquids or foreign
substances to enter the system.
Liquids or foreign substances may
cause noxious fumes, a fire, or a
system malfunction.
Stop using the system if it
malfunctions, such as no audio
output or display. If you continue
using the system when it is
malfunctioning, it may lead to a fire,
electric shock, or system failure.
Do not touch the antenna during
thunder or lightning because such an
act may cause electric shock.
NOTICE
Manufacturer: HYUNDAI MOBIS Co.,
Ltd.
203, Teheran-ro, Gangnam-gu, Seoul,
06141 , Korea
Tel: +82-31-260-2707
i Information
- About operating the
system
Use the system with the engine running.
Using the system for a long time when
the engine is stopped may discharge the
battery.
Do not install unapproved products.
Using unapproved products may cause
an error while using the system. System
errors caused by installing unapproved
products are not covered under the
warranty.
5-88
Convenience Features
i Information
- About handling the system
Do not apply excessive force to the
system. Excessive pressure on the
screen may damage the LCD panel or
the touch panel.
When cleaning the screen or button
panel, make sure to stop the engine
and use a soft, dry cloth. Wiping the
screen or buttons with a rough cloth or
using solvents (alcohol, benzene, paint
thinner, etc.) may scratch or chemically
damage the surface.
If you attach a liquid-type air freshener
to the fan louver, the surface of the
louver may become deformed due to the
flowing air.
If you want to change the position of
the installed device, please inquire
with your place of purchase or service
maintenance center. Technical expertise
is required to install or disassemble the
device.
NOTICE
If you experience any problems with
the system, contact your place of
purchase or dealer.
Placing the infotainment system
within an electromagnetic
environment may result in noise
interference.
Turning the system on or off
To turn on the system, start the engine.
If you do not want to use the system
while driving, you can turn off the
system by pressing the [PWR] button
on the control panel. To use the
system again, press the [PWR] button
again.
After you have turned off the engine, the
system will automatically turn off after a
while or as soon as you open the driver’s
door.
Depending on the vehicle model or
specifications, the system may turn off as
soon as you turn off the engine.
When you turn back on the system,
the previous mode and settings will
remain intact.
WARNING
Some functions may be disabled for
safety reasons while the vehicle is
moving. They work only when the
vehicle stops. Park your vehicle in
a safe location before using any of
them.
Stop using the system if it
malfunctions, such as no audio
output or display. If you continue
using the system when it is
malfunctioning, it may lead to a fire,
electric shock, or system failure.
i Information
You can turn on the system when the key
ignition switch is placed in the “ACC”
or “ON” position. Using the system for
an extended period without the engine
running drains the battery. If you plan on
using the system for a long time, start the
engine.
5-89
05
Turning the display on or off
To prevent glare, you can turn off the
screen. The screen can be turned off
only while the system is on.
1. On the control panel, press the
[MENU/CLOCK] button.
2. When the option selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select Display Off, and then press the
knob.
To turn the screen back on, press
any of the control panel buttons.
Getting to know the basic
operations
You can select an item or adjust the
settings by using the number buttons
and the [TUNE] knob on the control
panel.
Selecting an item
Numbered items
Press the corresponding number
button.
Numberless items
Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired item, and then press the knob.
Adjusting the settings
Turn the [TUNE] knob to adjust the
value, and then press the knob to save
changes.
Turn the [TUNE] knob to the right to
increase the value and turn the [TUNE]
knob to the left to decrease the value.
5-90
Convenience Features
Turning on the radio
1. On the control panel, press the
[RADIO] / [AUDIO] button.
2. When the mode selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired radio mode and
then press the knob.
FM/AM Mode
(1) Current radio mode
(2) Radio station information
(3) Preset list
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following
menu options:
• Autostore: Save radio stations to the
preset list.
• Scan: The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals and
plays each radio station for about five
seconds.
• Sound Settings: You can change
the settings related to sounds, such
as location where sound will be
concentrated and the output level for
each range.
- Position: Select a location where
sound will be concentrated in the
vehicle. Select Fade (Fader) or
Balance, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired position, and
then press the knob. To set sound
to be centered in the vehicle, select
Centre (Center).
- Equaliser (Tone): Adjust the output
level for each sound tone mode.
- Speed Dependent Vol.: Set the
volume to be adjusted automatically
according to your driving speed.
NOTICE
Depending on vehicle models or
specifications, available options may
vary.
Depending on the system or amplifier
specifications applied to your vehicle,
available options may vary.
• Mode Popup: Set to display mode
selection window when the
[RADIO] / [AUDIO] button is pressed
on the control panel.
• Date/Time: You can change the
date and time that are shown on the
system display.
- Set Date: Set date to display on the
system display.
- Set Time: Set time to display on the
system display.
- Time Format: Select to display time
in the 12 hour format or the 24 hour
format.
- Display (Power Off): Set to display
the clock when the system power is
off.
• Language: You can change the display
language.
• Display Off: Turn off the screen. Press
any of the control panel buttons to
turn back on.
RADIO
5-91
05
FM/AM Mode (With RDS)
(1) Current radio mode
(2) Radio station information
(3) Preset list
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following
menu options:
• Traffic Announcement: Activate or
deactivate traffic announcements.
Announcements and programs will be
received automatically if available.
• Autostore: Save radio stations to the
preset list.
• Scan: The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals
and plays each option for about five
seconds.
• Sound Settings: You can change
the settings related to sounds, such
as location where sound will be
concentrated and the output level for
each range.
- Position: Select a location where
sound will be concentrated in the
vehicle. Select Fade (Fader) or
Balance, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired position, and
then press the knob. To set sound
to be centered in the vehicle, select
Centre (Center).
- Equaliser (Tone): Adjust the output
level for each sound tone mode.
- Speed Dependent Vol.: Set the
volume to be adjusted automatically
according to your driving speed.
NOTICE
Depending on vehicle models or
specifications, available options may
vary.
Depending on the system or amplifier
specifications applied to your vehicle,
available options may vary.
• Mode Popup: Set to display mode
selection window when the
[RADIO] / [AUDIO] button is pressed
on the control panel.
• Date/Time: You can change the
date and time that are shown on the
system display.
- Set Date: Set date to display on the
system display.
- Set Time: Set time to display on the
system display.
- Time Format: Select to display time
in the 12 hour format or the 24 hour
format.
- Display (Power Off): Set to display
the clock when the system power is
off.
• Language: You can change the display
language.
• Display Off: Turn off the screen. Press
any of the control panel buttons to
turn back on.
5-92
Convenience Features
DAB Mode
(1) Current radio mode
(2) Radio station information
(3) Preset list
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following
menu options:
• Traffic Announcement: Activate or
deactivate traffic announcements.
Announcements and programs will be
received automatically if available.
• List: Display all available radio
stations.
• Scan: The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals
and plays each option for about five
seconds.
• Sound Settings: You can change
the settings related to sounds, such
as location where sound will be
concentrated and the output level for
each range.
- Position: Select a location where
sound will be concentrated in the
vehicle. Select Fade (Fader) or
Balance, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired position, and
then press the knob. To set sound
to be centered in the vehicle, select
Centre (Center).
- Equaliser (Tone): Adjust the output
level for each sound tone mode.
- Speed Dependent Vol.: Set the
volume to be adjusted automatically
according to your driving speed. (if
equipped)
NOTICE
Depending on vehicle models or
specifications, available options may
vary.
Depending on the system or amplifier
specifications applied to your vehicle,
available options may vary.
• Mode Popup: Set to display mode
selection window when the
[RADIO] / [AUDIO] button is pressed
on the control panel.
• Date/Time: You can change the
date and time that are shown on the
system display.
- Set Date: Set date to display on the
system display.
- Set Time: Set time to display on the
system display.
- Time Format: Select to display time
in the 12 hour format or the 24 hour
format.
- Display (Power Off): Set to display
the clock when the system power is
off.
• Language: You can change the display
language.
• Display Off: Turn off the screen. Press
any of the control panel buttons to
turn back on.
5-93
05
Changing the radio mode
1. On the control panel, press the
[RADIO] / [AUDIO] button.
2. When the mode selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired radio mode and
then press the knob.
Each time you press the [MODE]
button on the steering wheel, the
radio mode switches to FM X AM in
order.
NOTICE
When the Mode Popup is not selected
in [MENU/CLOCK] X Mode Popup, press
the [RADIO] / [AUDIO] button on the
control panel to change the radio mode.
Each time you press the [RADIO] /
[AUDIO] button on the control panel, the
radio mode switches to FM X DAB (if
equipped) X AM in order.
Scanning for available radio
stations
You can listen to each radio station for
a few seconds to test the reception and
select the one you want.
1. From the radio screen, press the
[MENU/CLOCK] button on the control
panel.
2. When the option selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select Scan, and then press the knob.
The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals
and plays each radio station for
about five seconds.
3. When you find the radio station you
want to listen to, press the [TUNE]
knob.
You can continue listening to the
selected station.
Searching for radio stations
To search for the previous or next
available radio station, press the
[< SEEK] button / [TRACK >] button on
the control panel.
You can also press and hold the
[< SEEK] button / [TRACK >] button
to search for frequencies quickly.
When you release the button, a radio
station with a strong signal is selected
automatically.
If you know the exact frequency of the
radio station you want to listen to, turn
the [TUNE] knob on the control panel to
change the frequency.
5-94
Convenience Features
Saving radio stations
You can save your favorite radio stations
and listen to them by selecting them
from the preset list.
Saving the current radio station
While listening to the radio, press and
hold the desired number button on the
control panel.
The radio station you are listening to
will be added to the selected number.
To save the next page of the preset
list, press the [FAV] button.
NOTICE
You can save up to 12 radio stations in
each mode.
If a station is already saved to the
selected preset number, the station
will be replaced by the station you
are listening to.
Using the auto save function
You can search for radio stations in your
area where there is a strong signal. The
results of your search can be saved to
the preset list automatically.
1. From the radio screen, press the
[MENU/CLOCK] button on the control
panel.
2. When the option selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select Autostore, and then press the
knob.
Listening to saved radio
stations
FM/AM Mode
1. Confirm the preset number for the
radio station you want to listen to.
To view the next page of the preset
list, press the [FAV] button.
2. On the control panel, press the desired
number button.
Alternatively, push the Up/Down
lever on the steering wheel to
change the station.
5-95
05
Using the media player
You can play music stored in various
media storage devices, such as USB
storage devices, and smartphones.
1. Connect a device to the USB port in
your vehicle.
• Playback may start immediately
depending on the device that you
connect to the system.
2. On the control panel, press the
[MEDIA] / [AUDIO] button.
3. When the mode selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired mode and then
press the knob.
NOTICE
To start the media player, press the
[MEDIA] / [AUDIO] button on the
control panel.
You can also change the mode
by pressing the [MODE] button
repeatedly on the steering wheel.
Make sure to connect or disconnect
external USB devices with the system
power turned off.
When the Mode Popup is not selected
in [MENU/CLOCK] X Mode Popup,
press the [MEDIA] / [AUDIO] button on
the control panel to change the media
player.
Each time you press the [MEDIA] /
[AUDIO] button on the control panel,
the media mode switches to USB X BT
Audio in order.
Depending on vehicle models and
specifications, available buttons or
the appearance and layout of the USB
port in your vehicle may vary.
Do not connect a smartphone or an
MP3 device to the system via multiple
methods such as USB and Bluetooth
simultaneously. Doing so may
cause a distorted noise or a system
malfunction.
When the equaliser function of the
connected device and Tone settings
of the system are both activated, the
effects may interfere with each other
and may lead to sound degradation
or distortion. Deactivate the device’s
equaliser function if possible.
Using the USB mode
You can play media files stored in
portable devices, such as USB storage
devices and MP3 players. Check
compatible USB storage devices and
file specifications before using the USB
mode.
Connect your USB device to the USB
port in the vehicle.
Playback starts immediately.
Press the [MEDIA] / [AUDIO] button on
the control panel to display the mode
selection window, turn the [TUNE]
knob to select USB and then press the
knob.
MEDIA PLAYER
5-96
Convenience Features
(1) Current file number and total number
of files
(2) Playback time
(3) Information about the song currently
playing
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following
menu options:
• List: Access the file list.
• Folder List: Access the folder list.
• Information: Display information
about the song currently playing.
• Sound Settings: You can change
the settings related to sounds, such
as location where sound will be
concentrated and the output level for
each range.
- Position: Select a location where
sound will be concentrated in the
vehicle. Select Fade (Fader) or
Balance, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired position, and
then press the knob. To set sound
to be centered in the vehicle, select
Centre (Center).
- Equaliser (Tone): Adjust the output
level for each sound tone mode.
- Speed Dependent Vol.: Set the
volume to be adjusted automatically
according to your driving speed.
NOTICE
Depending on vehicle models or
specifications, available options may
vary.
Depending on the system or amplifier
specifications applied to your vehicle,
available options may vary.
• Song information (Media Display):
Select information such as Folder/File
or Artist/Title/Album to display when
playing MP3 files.
• Mode Popup: Set to display mode
selection window when the
[MEDIA] / [AUDIO] button is pressed
on the control panel.
• Date/Time: You can change the
date and time that are shown on the
system display.
- Set Date: Set date to display on the
system display.
- Set Time: Set time to display on the
system display.
- Time Format: Select to display time
in the 12 hour format or the 24 hour
format.
- Display (Power Off): Set to display
the clock when the system power is
off.
• Language: You can change the display
language.
• Display Off: Turn off the screen. Press
any of the control panel buttons to
turn back on.
Rewinding/Fast forwarding
On the control panel, press and hold the
[< SEEK] button / [TRACK >] button.
You can also push and hold the Up/
Down lever on the steering wheel.
5-97
05
Restarting the current playback
On the control panel after the song has
played for 2 seconds, press the [< SEEK]
button.
You can also push the Up lever on the
steering wheel.
Playing the previous or next song
To play the previous song on the control
panel within the first 2 seconds of the
current song, press the [< SEEK] button.
To play the next song, press the [TRACK
>] button on the control panel.
If more than 2 seconds of playback
have elapsed, press the [< SEEK]
button on the control panel twice to
play the previous song.
You can also push the Up/Down lever
on the steering wheel.
NOTICE
Select [MENU/CLOCK] > List to access
the file list, turn the [TUNE] knob to find
the desired song and press the knob to
play the file.
Playing repeatedly
On the control panel, press the [1 RPT]
button. The repeat play mode changes
each time you press it. The corresponding
mode icon will be displayed on the screen.
Playing in random order
On the control panel, press the
[2 SHFL] button. The shuffle play mode is
activated or deactivated each time you
press it. When you activate the shuffle
mode, the corresponding mode icon will
be displayed on the screen.
NOTICE
Depending on the connected Bluetooth
device or mobile phone, RPT & SHFL
features may not be supported.
Searching folders
1. On the control panel, press the
[MENU/CLOCK] button.
2. When the option selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the Folder List and then press
the knob.
3. Navigate to the desired folder in the
Folder List and then press the [TUNE]
knob.
The first song in the selected folder
will be played.
i Information
Start the engine of your vehicle before
connecting a USB device to your system.
Starting the engine with a USB device
connected to the system may damage
the USB device.
Be careful of static electricity when
connecting or disconnecting a USB
device. A static discharge may cause a
system malfunction.
Be careful not to let your body or
external objects contact the USB port.
Doing so may cause an accident or a
system malfunction.
Do not connect and disconnect a USB
connector repeatedly in a short time.
Doing so may cause an error in the
device or a system malfunction.
Do not use a USB device for purposes
other than playing files. Using USB
accessories for charging or heating may
cause poor performance or a system
malfunction.
5-98
Convenience Features
NOTICE
When connecting a USB storage
device, do not use an extension
cable. Connect it directly to the
USB port. If you use a USB hub or an
extension cable, the device may not
be recognized.
Fully insert a USB connector into the
USB port. Failure to do so may cause
a communication error.
When you disconnect a USB storage
device, a distorted noise may occur.
The system can play only files
encoded in a standard format.
The following types of USB devices
may not be recognized or work
correctly:
- Encrypted MP3 players
- USB devices not recognized as
removable disks
A USB device may not be recognized
depending on its condition.
Some USB devices may be
incompatible with your system.
Depending on the USB device’s type,
capacity, or the format of files, USB
recognition time may be longer.
Image and video playback are not
supported.
BLUETOOTH
Connecting Bluetooth devices
Bluetooth is a short-range wireless
networking technology. Via Bluetooth,
you can connect nearby mobile
devices wirelessly to send and receive
data between connected devices.
This enables you to use your devices
effectively.
To use Bluetooth, you must first connect
a Bluetooth-enabled device to your
system, such as a mobile phone or an
MP3 player. Ensure that the device you
want to connect supports Bluetooth.
WARNING
Park your vehicle in a safe location
before connecting Bluetooth devices.
Distracted driving can cause a traffic
accident and lead to personal injury or
death.
NOTICE
On your system, you can use only
Bluetooth Handsfree and Audio
features. Connect a mobile device
that supports both features.
Some Bluetooth devices may cause
malfunctions to the infotainment
system or make interference noises.
In this case, storing the device in a
different location may resolve the
problem.
Depending on the connected
Bluetooth device or mobile
phone, some functions may not be
supported.
If the system is not stable due
to a vehicle-Bluetooth device
communication error, delete the
paired devices and connect the
Bluetooth devices again.
5-99
05
If Bluetooth connection is not stable,
follow these steps to try again.
1. Deactivate Bluetooth and
reactivate it on the device. Then,
reconnect the device.
2. Turn the device off and on. Then,
reconnect it.
3. Remove the battery from the
device and reinstall it. Then, turn
the device on and reconnect it.
4. Unregister the Bluetooth pairing on
both the system and the device and
then re-register and connect them.
The Bluetooth connection is
unavailable when the device’s
Bluetooth function is turned off. Be
sure to turn on the device’s Bluetooth
function.
Pairing devices with your system
For Bluetooth connections, first pair your
device with your system to add it to the
system’s list of Bluetooth devices. You
can register up to five devices.
1. From the control panel, press the
[PHONE] button, and then select
Phone Settings X Add New Device.
If you are pairing a device with your
system for the first time, you can
also press the Call/Answer button
on the steering wheel.
2. On the Bluetooth device you want to
connect, activate Bluetooth, search for
your vehicle’s system, and then select
it.
• Check the system’s Bluetooth
name, which is displayed in the new
registration pop-up window on the
system screen.
3. Enter or confirm the passkey to
confirm the connection.
If the passkey input screen is
displayed on the Bluetooth device
screen, enter the passkey ‘0000’
which is displayed on the system
screen.
If the 6-digit passkey is displayed
on the Bluetooth device screen,
ensure that the Bluetooth passkey
displayed on the Bluetooth device
is the same as the passkey on the
system screen and confirm the
connection from the device.
NOTICE
The screen image in this manual is an
example. Check your system screen for
the exact vehicle name and Bluetooth
device name.
The default passkey is ‘0000’.
It may take a while for the system
to connect with the device after
you permit the system to access the
device. When a connection is made,
the Bluetooth status icon appears at
the top of the screen.
You can change the permission
settings via the mobile phone’s
Bluetooth settings menu. For more
information, refer to your mobile
phone’s user guide.
To register a new device, repeat
steps 1 to 3.
5-100
Convenience Features
If you use the automatic Bluetooth
connection function, a call may be
switched to the vehicle’s Handsfree
when you are taking on the phone
near the vehicle while the vehicle’s
engine is on. If you do not want the
system to connect with the device
automatically, deactivate Bluetooth
on your device.
When a device is connected to the
system via Bluetooth, the device’s
battery may discharge faster.
Connecting a paired device
To use a Bluetooth device on your
system, connect the paired device to the
system. Your system can connect with
only one device at a time.
1. From the control panel, press the
[PHONE] button, and then select Phone
Settings X Paired Devices.
If there is no connected device,
press the Call/Answer button on the
steering wheel.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
device to connect, and then press the
knob.
If another device is already
connected to your system,
disconnect it. Select the connected
device to disconnect.
NOTICE
If a connection ends because a
device is out of the connection
range or a device error occurs,
the connection will be restored
automatically when the device enters
the connection range or when the
error is cleared.
Depending on auto connection
priority, connection to a device may
take time.
Disconnecting a device
If you want to stop using a Bluetooth
device or connect another device,
disconnect your currently connected
device.
1. From the control panel, press the
[PHONE] button, and then select Phone
Settings X Paired Devices.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select your
currently connected device and then
press the knob.
3. Press the [1 RPT] button to select Yes.
Deleting paired devices
If you no longer want a Bluetooth device
paired or if you want to connect a new
device when the Bluetooth device list is
full, delete paired devices.
1. From the control panel, press the
[PHONE] button, and then select Phone
Settings X Delete Devices.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
device to delete, and then press the
knob.
3. Press the [1 RPT] button to select Yes.
5-101
05
NOTICE
When you delete a paired device, the
Call history and Contacts stored in
the system are also deleted.
To re-use a deleted device, you must
pair the device again.
Using a Bluetooth audio device
You can listen to music stored in the
connected Bluetooth audio device via
your vehicle’s speakers.
1. On the control panel, press the
[AUDIO] button.
2. When the mode selection window
displays, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select BT Audio and then press the
knob.
(1) Information about the song currently
playing
1. Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button
on the control panel to access the
following a menu option.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select option
and then press the knob.
• Sound Settings: You can change
the settings related to sounds, such
as location where sound will be
concentrated and the output level
for each range.
- Position: Select a location where
sound will be concentrated in the
vehicle. Select Fade (Fader) or
Balance, turn the [TUNE] knob to
select the desired position, and
then press the knob. To set sound
to be centered in the vehicle,
select Centre (Center).
- Equaliser (Tone): Adjust the
output level for each sound tone
mode.
- Speed Dependent Vol.: Set
the volume to be adjusted
automatically according to your
driving speed.
NOTICE
Depending on vehicle models or
specifications, available options may
vary.
Depending on the system or amplifier
specifications applied to your vehicle,
available options may vary.
• Mode Popup: Set to display mode
selection window when the [AUDIO]
button is pressed on the control
panel.
• Date/Time: You can change the
date and time that are shown on the
system display.
- Set Date: Set date to display on
the system display.
- Set Time: Set time to display on
the system display.
5-102
Convenience Features
- Time Format: Select to display
time in the 12 hour format or the
24 hour format.
- Display (Power Off): Set to display
the clock when the system power
is off.
• Language: You can change the
display language.
• Display Off: Turn off the screen.
Press any of the control panel
buttons to turn back on.
Pausing/Resuming playback
To pause playback, press the [TUNE]
knob on the control panel. To resume
playback, press the [TUNE] knob again.
You can also press the Mute button on
the steering wheel remote control.
Playing repeatedly
On the control panel, press the
[1 RPT] button. The repeat play mode
changes each time you press it. The
corresponding mode icon will be
displayed on the screen.
Playing in random order
On the control panel, press the
[2 SHFL] button. The shuffle play mode is
activated or deactivated each time you
press it. When you activate the shuffle
mode, the corresponding mode icon will
be displayed on the screen.
NOTICE
Depending on the connected Bluetooth
device or mobile phone, RPT & SHFL
features may not be supported.
NOTICE
Depending on the connected
Bluetooth device, mobile phone,
or the music player you are using,
playback controls may differ.
Depending on the music player you
are using, streaming may not be
supported.
Depending on the connected
Bluetooth device or mobile
phone, some functions may not be
supported.
If a Bluetooth enabled phone is being
used to play music and it receives or
makes a phone call, the music will
stop.
Receiving an incoming call or making
an outgoing call while playing
Bluetooth audio may result in audio
interference.
If you use the Bluetooth phone
mode while using Bluetooth audio,
playback may not automatically
resume after you end the call
depending on the connected mobile
phone.
Moving the track up/down while
playing Bluetooth audio mode may
result in pop noises with some mobile
phones.
The Rewinding/Fast forwarding
function is not supported in the
Bluetooth audio mode.
The playlist feature is not supported
in the Bluetooth audio mode.
If the Bluetooth device is
disconnected, Bluetooth audio mode
will end.
5-103
05
Using a Bluetooth phone
You can use Bluetooth to talk on the
phone hands free. View call information
on the system screen, and make or re-
ceive calls safely and conveniently via the
vehicle’s built-in microphone and speak-
ers.
WARNING
Park your vehicle in a safe location
before connecting Bluetooth devices.
Distracted driving can cause a traffic
accident and lead to personal injury
or death.
Never dial a phone number or pick
up your mobile phone while driving.
Use of a mobile phone may distract
your attention, making it difficult to
recognize external conditions and
reducing the ability to cope with
unexpected situations, which may
lead to an accident. If necessary, use
the Bluetooth Handsfree feature to
make calls and keep the call as short
as possible.
NOTICE
You cannot access the Phone screen
if there is no connected mobile
phone. To use the Bluetooth phone
function, connect a mobile phone to
the system.
The Bluetooth Handsfree function
may not work when you are
passing out of the cellular service
coverage area, such as when you
are in a tunnel, underground, or in a
mountainous area.
Call quality may be degraded in the
following environments:
- The reception of the mobile phone
is poor
- The inside of the vehicle is noisy
- The mobile phone is placed
near metallic objects, such as a
beverage can.
Depending on the connected mobile
phone, the volume and sound quality
of the Bluetooth Handsfree may vary.
5-104
Convenience Features
Making a call
If your mobile phone is connected to the
system, you can make a call by selecting
a name from your call history or contacts
list.
1. On the control panel, press the
[PHONE] button.
Alternatively, press the Call/
Answer button on the steering wheel.
2. Select a phone number.
To select a phone number from your
favorites list, select
Favorites.
To select a phone number from your
call history, select Call
History.
To select a phone number from the
contacts list downloaded from the
connected mobile phone, select
Contacts.
3. To end the call, press the [2 SHFL]
button on the control panel.
Alternatively, press the Call end
button on the steering wheel.
Registering the favorites list
You can more easily use Bluetooth
to talk on the phone hands-free by
registering phone numbers as your
favorites.
1. On the Phone screen, turn the [TUNE]
knob on the control panel to select
Favorites and press the knob.
2. Select Add New.
3. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired group of alphanumeric
characters, and then press the knob.
4. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired contact.
Using the favorites list
1. From the Phone screen, turn the
[TUNE] knob on the control panel to
select Favorites, and then press the
knob.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired contact, and then press the
knob to make a phone call.
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following
menu options:
Add new favorites: Add a frequently
used phone number to favorites.
• Delete Items: Delete a selected
favorites item.
• Delete All: Delete all favorites items.
NOTICE
You can register up to 20 favorites for
each device.
You must first download the contacts
to the system to register favorites.
The favorites list saved on the mobile
phone is not downloaded to the
system.
Even if the contact information
on the mobile phone is edited, the
favorites on the system are not
automatically edited. Delete and add
the item to favorites again.
When you connect a new mobile
phone, your favorites set for the
previous mobile phone will not be
displayed, but they will remain in
your system until you delete the
previous phone from the device list.
5-105
05
Using your call history
1. From the Phone screen, turn the
[TUNE] knob on the control panel to
select Call History, and then press the
knob.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired entry, and then press the knob
to make a phone call.
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following
menu options:
• Download: Download your call history.
• All Calls: View all call records.
• Dialed Calls: View only dialed calls.
• Received Calls: View only received
calls.
• Missed Calls: View only missed calls.
NOTICE
Some mobile phones may not
support the download function.
The call history is accessed only after
downloading the call history when
the mobile phone is connected to the
system.
Calls from restricted IDs are not
saved on the call history list.
Up to 50 call records will be
downloaded per individual list.
Call duration and time information
will not be displayed on the system
screen.
Permission is required to download
your call history from the mobile
phone. When you attempt to
download data, you may need to
permit the download on the mobile
phone. If the download fails, check
the mobile phone screen for any
notification or the mobile phone’s
permission setting.
When you download your call history,
any old data will be deleted.
Using the contacts list
1. From the Phone screen, turn the
[TUNE] knob on the control panel to
select Contacts, and then press the
knob.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired group of alphanumeric
characters, and then press the knob.
3. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired contact, and then press the
knob to make a phone call.
5-106
Convenience Features
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following a
menu option:
Download: Download your mobile
phone contacts.
NOTICE
Contacts can be viewed only when
the Bluetooth device is connected.
Only contacts in the supported
format can be downloaded and
displayed from the Bluetooth device.
Contacts from some applications will
not be included.
Up to 2,000 contacts can be
downloaded from your device.
Some mobile phones may not
support the download function.
Depending on the system’s
specifications, some of the
downloaded contacts may be lost.
Contacts stored both in the phone
and in the SIM card are downloaded.
With some mobile phones, contacts
in the SIM card may not be
downloaded.
Special characters and figures used
in the contact name may not be
displayed properly.
Permission is required to download
contacts from the mobile phone.
When you attempt to download
data, you may need to permit the
download on the mobile phone. If
the download fails, check the mobile
phone screen for any notification
or the mobile phone’s permission
setting.
Depending on the mobile phone type
or status, downloading may take
longer.
When you download your contacts,
any old data will be deleted.
You cannot edit or delete your
contacts on the system.
When you connect a new mobile
phone, your contacts downloaded
from the previous mobile phone will
not be displayed, but they will remain
in your system until you delete the
previous phone from the device list.
Answering calls
When a call comes in, a notification pop-
up window of the incoming call appears
on the system screen.
To answer the call, press the [1 RPT]
button on the control panel.
Alternatively, press the Call/
Answer button on the steering wheel.
5-107
05
To reject the call, press the [2 SHFL]
button on the control panel.
Alternatively, press the Call end button
on the steering wheel.
NOTICE
Depending on the mobile phone type,
call rejection may not be supported.
Once your mobile phone is connected
to the system, the call sound may be
output through the vehicle’s speakers
even after you exit the vehicle if the
phone is within the connection range.
To end the connection, disconnect
the device from the system or
deactivate Bluetooth on the device.
Using options during a call
During a call, you will see the call screen
shown below. Press a button to perform
the function you want.
To switch the call to your mobile phone,
press the [1 RPT] button on the control
panel.
Alternatively, press and hold the Call/
Answer button on the steering wheel.
To end the call, press the [2 SHFL]
button on the control panel.
Alternatively, press the Call end button
on the steering wheel.
Press the [MENU/CLOCK] button on the
control panel to access the following a
menu option:
• Microphone Volume (Outgoing
Volume): Adjust the microphone
volume or turn off the microphone so
the other party cannot hear you.
NOTICE
If the caller information is saved in
your contacts list, the caller’s name
and phone number will be displayed.
If the caller information is not saved
in your contacts list, only the caller’s
phone number will be displayed.
You cannot switch to any other
screen, such as the audio screen
or the settings screen, during a
Bluetooth call.
Depending on the mobile phone
type, call quality may vary. On some
phones, your voice may be less
audible to the other party.
Depending on the mobile phone
type, the phone number may not be
displayed.
Depending on the mobile phone type,
the call switching function may not
be supported.
5-108
Convenience Features
7+((0(5*(1&<&$//6(59,&(ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
You can make an emergency call quickly
in the event of a traffic accident via the
emergency call system.
Public Safety Answering Point (PSAP)
emergency call service
SOS
Driver or passenger manually can
make an emergency call in the single
duty dispatch service, by pressing SOS
button to call the necessary emergency
services.
Stops sound and SOS is displayed on
screen.
NOTICE
For more information, refer to the
“Emergency situations” in manual.
Depending on your region, the
service may not be supported.
Depending on your region or vehicle
model, the name of the button may
vary.
5-109
05
SYSTEM STATUS ICONS
Status icons appear at the top of the
screen to display the current system
status.
Familiarise yourself with the status icons
that appear when you perform certain
actions or functions and their meanings.
Bluetooth
Icon Description
Battery level of connected
Bluetooth device
Mobile phone or audio device
connected via Bluetooth
Bluetooth call in progress
Microphone turned off during
Bluetooth call
Downloading call history from
a mobile phone connected via
Bluetooth to the system
Downloading contacts from a
mobile phone connected via
Bluetooth to the system
Signal strength
Icon Description
Signal strength of the mobile
phone connected via Bluetooth
NOTICE
The battery level displayed on the
screen may differ from the battery
level displayed on the connected
device.
The signal strength displayed on the
screen may differ from the signal
strength displayed on the connected
mobile phone.
Depending on vehicle models and
specifications, some status icons may
not be displayed.
5-110
Convenience Features
USB
Supported audio formats
Audio file specification
- WAVeform audio format
- MPEG1/2/2.5 Audio Layer3
- Windows Media Audio Ver 7.X/8.X
Bit rates
- MPEG1 (Layer3):
32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/
160/192/224/256/320 kbps
- MPEG2 (Layer3):
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/
112/128/144/160 kbps
- MPEG2.5 (Layer3):
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/
112/128/144/160 kbps
- WMA (High Range):
48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps
• Bits Per Sample
- WAV (PCM(Stereo)): 24 bit
- WAV (IMA ADPCM): 4 bit
- WAV (MS ADPCM): 4 bit
• Sampling frequency
- MPEG1: 44100/48000/32000 Hz
- MPEG2: 22050/24000/16000 Hz
- MPEG2.5: 11025/12000/8000 Hz
- WMA: 32000/44100/48000 Hz
- WAV: 44100/48000 Hz
Maximum length of folder/file names
(Based on Unicode): 40 English or
Korean characters
Supported characters for folder/
file names (Unicode support): 2,604
Korean characters, 94 alphanumeric
characters, 4,888 Chinese characters
in common use, 986 special
characters
Maximum number of folders: 1,000
• Maximum number of files: 5,000
NOTICE
Files that are not in a supported
format may not be recognized or
played, or information about them,
such as the file name, may not be
displayed properly.
Only files with .mp3/.wma/.wav
extensions can be recognized by the
system. If the file is not in supported
format, change the file format by
using the latest encoding software.
The device will not support files
locked by DRM (Digital Rights
Management).
For MP3/WMA compression files and
WAV file, differences in sound quality
will occur depending on the bitrate.
(Music files with a higher bitrate have
a better sound quality.)
Japanese or Simplified Chinese
characters in folder or file names may
not be displayed properly.
Supported USB storage devices
Byte/Sector: 64 kbyte or less
• Format system: FAT12/16/32
(recommended), exFAT/NTFS
INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM SPECIFICATIONS
5-111
05
NOTICE
Operation is guaranteed only for a
metal cover type USB storage device
with a plug type connector.
- USB storage devices with a plastic
plug may not be recognized.
- USB storage devices in memory
card types, such as CF card or SD
cards, may not be recognized.
USB hard disk drives may not be
recognized.
When you use a large capacity USB
storage device with multiple logical
drives, only files stored on the first
drive will be recognized.
If an application program is loaded
on a USB storage device, the
corresponding media files may not
play.
Use USB 2.0 devices for better
compatibility.
Bluetooth
Bluetooth Power Class 2: -6 to 4 dBm
• Aerial power: Max 2.5 mW
Frequency range: 2400 to 2483.5 MHz
• Bluetooth patch RAM software
version: 1
TRADEMARKS
Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos
are registered trademarks owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of
such marks by HYUNDAI is under
licence.
5-112
Convenience Features
CE
Product details
[2]
Applied Standards
[6]
Signed By
[14]
Seunghoon Choe
Representave
Hyundai MOBIS Co., Ltd.
25/07/2022
This declaraon of conformity is issued under the sole
responsibility of the manufacturer.
[15]
203, Teheran-ro, Gangnam-gu, Wilhelm-Fay-Strabe 51,
Seoul, 06141 , Korea Frankfurt Main, 65936, Germany
Tel: +82-31-260-2707 Tel: +49-69-85096-5011
Hyundai MOBIS Co., Ltd. MOBIS Parts Europe N.V.
Arcle
[7]
3.2
EN 300 328 V2.2.2, EN 303 345-1 V1.1.1, EN 303 345-2 V1.2.1,
EN 303 345-3 V1.1.1 EN 303 345-4 V1.1.1
Radio
[8]
Arcle
[7]
3.1b EN 301 489-1 V2.2.3, EN 301 489-17 V3.2.4
EN 55032:2015+A11:2020, EN 55035:2017+A11:2020
EMC
[9]
Arcle
[7]
3.1a EN IEC 623681:2020+A11:2020
EN 62311:2008
Safety
[10]
, Health
[11]
Manufacturer
[12]
Representave in the EU
[13]
We hereby declare, that the product above is in compliance with the essenal requirements of the Direcve
2014/53/EU by applicaon of
[5]
EU Declaraon of Conformity
[1]
Product
[3]
Car Auido System
Model
[4]
ACB10HQIG, ACB11HQIG, ACB12HQIG, ACB13HQIG, ACB10HQGG, ACB10HQGN, ACB10HQGL,
ACB10HQGP, ACB11HQGG, ACB10HQMG, ACB00GQTP, ACB11GQTP, ACB00GQEG,
ACB01GQEG, ACB90GQEG, ACB10GQEG, ACB11GQEG, ACBC0GQEG, ACB00GQEP,
ACB90GQEP, ACB10GQEP, ACBC0GQEP, ACB11GQEP, ACBC1GQEP, ACB91GQEP, ACB02GQEP,
AU210HQEP, AU211HQEP
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
5-113
05
IFETEL
“La operación de este equipo está sujeta a las siguientes dos condiciones: (1) es
posible que este equipo o dispositivo no cause interferencia perjudicial y (2) este
equipo o dispositivo debe aceptar cualquier interferencia, incluyendo la que pueda
causar su operación no deseada.”
TRA
OMAN-TRA
D192564
TRA/TA-R/7402/19
5-114
Convenience Features
Before driving ..................................................................................................6-3
Before entering the vehicle ......................................................................................6-3
Before starting ........................................................................................................... 6-3
Ignition switch .................................................................................................6-4
Key ignition switch ....................................................................................................6-4
Engine Start/Stop button ...........................................................................................6-7
Manual transmission .....................................................................................6-12
Manual transmission operation ...............................................................................6-12
Good driving practices .............................................................................................6-14
Automated Manual Transmission (AMT) ......................................................6-15
Automated Manual Transmission (AMT) operation ...............................................6-16
Features of the Automated Manual Transmission (AMT) ......................................6-16
Parking ..................................................................................................................... 6-24
Good driving practices ............................................................................................6-24
Braking system ..............................................................................................6-26
Power brakes ...........................................................................................................6-26
Disc brakes wear indicator .....................................................................................6-26
Rear drum brakes .....................................................................................................6-27
Parking brake ............................................................................................................6-27
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................................................................................6-29
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) ..........................................................................6-30
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) ....................................................................6-33
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) ................................................................................6-34
Emergency Stop Signal (ESS) ................................................................................. 6-35
Brake Assist System (BAS) ...................................................................................... 6-35
Good braking practices ...........................................................................................6-36
Special driving conditions ............................................................................6-37
Hazardous driving conditions .................................................................................6-37
Rocking the vehicle ..................................................................................................6-37
Smooth cornering ...................................................................................................6-38
Driving at night ........................................................................................................6-38
Driving in the rain ....................................................................................................6-38
Driving in flooded areas ..........................................................................................6-39
Winter driving ............................................................................................... 6-40
Snow or icy conditions ............................................................................................6-40
Winter precautions ..................................................................................................6-42
Vehicle weight ...............................................................................................6-44
Overloading .............................................................................................................6-44
6. Driving Your Vehicle
6
6-2
Driving Your Vehicle
WARNING
Carbon monoxide (CO) gas is toxic. Breathing CO can cause unconsciousness and
death.
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide which cannot be seen or smelled.
Do not inhale engine exhaust.
If at any time you smell engine exhaust inside the vehicle, open the windows
immediately. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and death by asphyxiation.
Be sure the exhaust system does not leak.
The exhaust system should be checked whenever the vehicle is raised to change the
oil or for any other purpose. If you hear a change in the sound of the exhaust or if you
drive over something that strikes the underneath side of the vehicle, we recommend
that the exhaust system be checked as soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Do not run the engine in an enclosed area.
Letting the engine idle in your garage, even with the garage door open, is a hazardous
practice. Run the engine only long enough to start the engine and to move the vehicle
out of the garage.
Avoid idling the engine for prolonged periods with people inside the vehicle.
If it is necessary to idle the engine for a prolonged period with people inside the
vehicle, be sure to do so only in an open area with the air intake set at “Fresh” and fan
control set to high so fresh air is drawn into the interior.
Keep the air intakes clear.
To assure proper operation of the ventilation system, keep the ventilation air intakes
located in front of the windshield clear of snow, ice, leaves, or other obstructions.
If you must drive with the tailgate/trunk open:
Close all windows.
Open instrument panel air vents.
Set the air intake control at “Fresh”, the air flow control at “Floor” or “Face”, and the
fan control set to high.
6-3
06
Before entering the vehicle
Be sure all windows, outside mirror(s)
and outside lights are clean and
unobstructed.
• Remove frost, snow or ice.
Visually check the tires for uneven
wear and damage.
Check under the vehicle for any sign
of leaks.
Be sure there are no obstacles behind
you if you intend to back up.
Before starting
Make sure the hood, the tailgate/trunk
and the doors are securely closed and
locked.
Adjust the position of the seat and
steering wheel.
Adjust the inside and outside rearview
mirrors.
Verify all of the lights work.
• Fasten your seatbelt. Check that
all passengers have fastened their
seatbelts.
Check the gauges and indicators in the
instrument panel and the messages
on the instrument display when the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
Check that any items you are carrying
are stored properly or fastened down
securely.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the following
precautions:
ALWAYS wear your seat belt. All
passengers must be properly belted
whenever the vehicle is moving.
For more information, refer to “Seat
Belts” in chapter 3.
Always drive defensively. Assume
other drivers or pedestrians may be
careless and make mistakes.
Stay focused on the task of driving.
Driver distraction can cause
accidents.
Leave plenty of space between you
and the vehicle in front of you.
WARNING
NEVER drink or take drugs and drive.
Drinking or taking drugs and driving
is dangerous and may result in an
accident and SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH.
Drunk driving is the number one
contributor to the highway death
toll each year. Even a small amount
of alcohol will affect your reflexes,
perceptions and judgment. Just
one drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions and
emergencies and your reaction time
gets worse with each additional drink.
Driving while under the influence
of drugs is as dangerous as or more
dangerous than driving under the
influence of alcohol.
You are much more likely to have a
serious accident if you drink or take
drugs and drive. If you are drinking or
taking drugs, don’t drive. Do not ride
with a driver who has been drinking
or taking drugs. Choose a designated
driver or call a taxi.
BEFORE DRIVING
6-4
Driving Your Vehicle
IGNITION SWITCH
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the following
precautions:
NEVER allow children or any person
who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the ignition switch or related
parts. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur.
NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the ignition switch, or any
other controls, while the vehicle is in
motion. The presence of your hand
or arm in this area may cause a loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Key ignition switch
(if equipped)
OIB054010
OIB054010
WARNING
NEVER turn the ignition switch to
the LOCK or ACC position while the
vehicle is in motion except in an
emergency. This will result in the
engine turning off and loss of power
assist for the steering and brake
systems.
This may lead to loss of directional
control and braking function, which
could cause an accident.
Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift lever is in
the 1st gear (for manual transmission
vehicle) or N (Neutral) position (for
Automated Manual Transmission
vehicle), apply the parking brake, and
turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position.
Unexpected vehicle movement may
occur if these precautions are not
followed.
6-5
06
Key ignition switch positions
Switch
Position Action Notice
LOCK The ignition key can be removed in
the LOCK position. The steering wheel locks to protect
the vehicle from theft.
(if equipped)
ACC Electrical accessories are usable.
The steering wheel unlocks.
If difficulty is experienced turning
the ignition switch to the ACC
position, turn the key while turning
the steering wheel right and left to
release tension.
ON
This is the normal key position
when the engine has started.
All features and accessories are
usable.
The warning lights can be checked
when you turn the ignition switch
from ACC to ON.
Do not leave the ignition switch in
the ON position when the engine is
not running to prevent the battery
from discharging.
START
To start the engine, turn the
ignition switch to the START
position. The switch returns to the
ON position when you let go of the
key.
The engine will crank until you
release the key.
6-6
Driving Your Vehicle
Starting the engine
WARNING
Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle. Unsuitable
shoes, such as high heels, ski boots,
sandals, flip-flops, etc., may interfere
with your ability to use the brake,
accelerator and clutch pedals.
Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed. The
vehicle can move and lead to an
accident.
Wait until the engine RPM is normal.
The vehicle may suddenly move if
the brake pedal is released when the
RPM is high.
Starting the gasoline engine
Vehicle with Manual Transmission:
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift lever is in N
(Neutral).
3. Depress the clutch and brake pedals.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of
10 seconds) until the engine starts and
release it.
Vehicle with Automated Manual
Transmission :
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift lever is in N
(Neutral).
3. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of
10 seconds) until the engine starts
and release it. The engine can not
be started unless the shift lever is ‘N’
position.
6-7
06
i Information
Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine speeds.
(Steep accelerating and decelerating
should be avoided.)
Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not race the engine while warming it
up.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
Do not hold the ignition key in the
START position for more than 10
seconds. Wait 5 to 10 seconds before
trying again.
Do not turn the ignition switch to
the START position with the engine
running. It may damage the starter.
If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the shift lever in the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle
is still moving and turn the ignition
switch to the START position in an
attempt to restart the engine.
Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
Engine Start/Stop button
(if equipped)
OAI3069001
OAI3069001
Whenever the front door is opened, the
Engine Start/Stop button will illuminate
and will go off 30 seconds after the door
is closed.
WARNING
To reduce risk of serious injury or
death, NEVER allow children or any
person who is unfamiliar with the
vehicle to touch the Engine Start/Stop
button or related parts. Unexpected
and sudden vehicle movement can
occur.
6-8
Driving Your Vehicle
WARNING
To turn the engine off in an emergency:
Press and hold the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than two seconds OR
Rapidly press and release the Engine
Start/Stop button three times (within
three seconds).
If the vehicle is still moving, you can
restart the engine without depressing
the brake pedal by pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button with the shift lever in
the N (Neutral) position.
WARNING
NEVER press the Engine Start/Stop
button while the vehicle is in motion
except in an emergency. This will
result in the engine turning off and
loss of power assist for the steering
and brake systems.
This may lead to loss of directional
control and braking function, which
could cause an accident.
Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always set the parking brake, press
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
OFF position, and take the Smart
Key with you. Unexpected vehicle
movement may occur if these
precautions are not followed.
NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the Engine Start/Stop
button or any other control while the
vehicle is in motion. The presence
of your hand or arm in this area
may cause a loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
6-9
06
Engine Stop/Start button positions
Button Position Action Notice
OFF
To turn off the engine, stop
the vehicle and then press the
Engine Start/Stop button.
The steering wheel locks to
protect the vehicle from theft.
(if equipped)
If the steering wheel is not locked
properly when you open the
driver’s door, the warning chime
will sound.
ACC
Press the Engine Start/Stop
button when the button is
in the OFF position without
depressing the brake pedal.
Electrical accessories are
usable.
The steering wheel unlocks.
If you leave the Engine Start/
Stop button in the ACC
position for more than one
hour, the battery power
will turn off automatically
to prevent the battery from
discharging.
If the steering wheel doesn’t
unlock properly, the Engine
Start/Stop button will not
work. Press the Engine Start/
Stop button while turning the
steering wheel right and left to
release tension.
ON
Press the Engine Start/Stop
button while it is in the ACC
position without depressing
the clutch pedal.
The warning lights can be
checked before the engine is
started.
Do not leave the Engine Start/
Stop button in the ON position
when the engine is not running
to prevent the battery from
discharging.
START
To start the engine, depress the
clutch and brake pedals and
press the Engine Start/ Stop
button with the shift lever in
neutral.
If you press the Engine Start/Stop
button without depressing the
clutch pedal, the engine does not
start and the Engine Start/Stop
button changes as follows:
OFF o ACC o ON o OFF
6-10
Driving Your Vehicle
Starting the engine
WARNING
Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle. Unsuitable
shoes, such as high heels, ski boots,
sandals, flip-flops, etc., may interfere
with your ability to use the brake,
accelerator and clutch pedals.
Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed. The
vehicle can move and lead to an
accident.
Wait until the engine RPM is normal.
The vehicle may suddenly move if
the brake pedal is released when the
RPM is high.
i Information
The engine will start by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button, only when the
smart key is in the vehicle.
Even if the smart key is in the vehicle,
if it is far away from the driver, the
engine may not start.
When the Engine Start/Stop button is in
the ACC or ON position, if any door is
open, the system checks for the smart
key. If the smart key is not in the
vehicle, the “ ” indicator will blink
and the warning “Key not in vehicle”
will come on, and if all doors are closed,
the chime will also sound for about 5
seconds. The indicator will turn off
while the vehicle is moving. Keep the
smart key in the vehicle when using the
ACC position or if the vehicle engine is
ON.
Vehicle with Manual Transmission:
1. Always carry the smart key with you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the shift lever is in N
(Neutral).
4. Depress the clutch and brake pedals.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button.
Vehicle with Automated Manual
Transmission:
1. Always carry the smart key with you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the shift lever is in N
(Neutral).
4. Depress the brake pedals.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button.
The engine can not be started unless
the shift lever is ‘N’ position.
6-11
06
i Information
Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine speeds.
(Steep accelerating and decelerating
should be avoided.)
Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not race the engine while warming it
up.
When you start to drive, move
the shift lever after checking the
RPM(revolutions per minute) is in the
proper range (under 1,000 RPM) by
depressing the clutch pedal and brake
pedal.
After releasing the parking brake, take
your foot off the clutch and depress the
accelerator slowly while starting your
vehicle.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the shift lever in the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle
is still moving and press the Engine
Start/Stop button in an attempt to
restart the engine.
Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
When the stop lamp fuse is blown, you
can’t start the engine normally. Replace
the fuse with a new one. If you are not
able to replace the fuse, you can start
the engine by pressing and holding
the Engine Start/Stop button for 10
seconds with the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ACC position.
Do not press the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than 10 seconds except
when the stop lamp fuse is blown.
For your safety, always depress the
brake and/or clutch pedal before
starting the engine.
Emergency starting
OAI3069002
OAI3069002
If the smart key battery is weak or the
smart key does not work correctly, you
can start the engine by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button with the smart
key in the direction of the picture above.
6-12
Driving Your Vehicle
OAI3069025
OAI3069025
Type A
Type A
Type B
Type B
OAI3069026
OAI3069026
The shift lever can be moved
without pressing the button (1).
The button (1) must be pressed
while moving the shift lever to
R (Reverse).
Manual transmission operation
The manual transmission has 5
forward gears. The transmission is fully
synchronized in all forward gears so
shifting to either a higher or a lower gear
is easily accomplished.
WARNING
Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift lever is
in the 1st gear when the vehicle is
parked on an uphill and in R (Reverse)
on a downhill, set the parking brake,
and place the ignition switch in the
LOCK/OFF position. Unexpected
vehicle movement may occur if these
precautions are not followed.
To shift to R (Reverse), make sure the
vehicle has completely stopped, and
then move the shift lever to neutral
before moving into R (Reverse).
When you’ve come to a complete stop
and it’s hard to shift into the 1st gear or
R (Reverse):
1. Put the shift lever in neutral and
release the clutch pedal.
2. Depress the clutch pedal, and then
shift into the first or R (Reverse) gear.
i Information
During cold weather, shifting may be
difficult until the transmission lubricant
has warmed up.
0$18$/75$160,66,21ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
6-13
06
Using the clutch (if equipped)
The clutch pedal should be depressed all
the way to the floor before:
- Starting the engine
The engine will not start without
depressing the clutch pedal.
- Shifting
To start your vehicle, slowly release
the clutch pedal and depress the
accelerator.
When releasing the clutch pedal, release
it slowly. The clutch pedal should always
be released while driving.
NOTICE
To prevent unnecessary wear or
damage to the clutch:
Do not rest your foot on the clutch
pedal while driving.
Do not hold the vehicle with the
clutch on an incline, while waiting for
the traffic light, etc.
Always depress the clutch pedal
down fully to prevent noise or
damage.
Do not start with the 2nd (second)
gear engaged except when you start
on a slippery road.
Depress the clutch pedal all the way
and be careful not to depress the
pedal again before returning to the
upright position after you release
the pedal. If you depress the pedal
before returning to the original
position repeatedly, it may cause the
clutch system failure.
Downshifting
Downshift when you must slow down in
heavy traffic or drive up a steep hill to
prevent engine load.
Also, downshifting reduces the chance
of stalling and can accelerate when you
need to increase your speed again.
When the vehicle is going downhill,
downshifting helps maintain safe speed
by providing brake power from the
engine and enables less wear on the
brakes.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the engine,
clutch and transmission:
When downshifting from the 5th
gear to the 4th gear, be careful not
to inadvertently push the shift lever
sideways engaging the 2nd gear.
A drastic downshift may cause the
engine speed to increase to the point
the tachometer will enter the red-
zone.
Do not downshift more than two
gears at a time or downshift the gear
when the engine is running at high
speed (5,000 RPM or higher). Such
a downshifting may damage the
engine, clutch and the transmission.
6-14
Driving Your Vehicle
Good driving practices
Never take the vehicle out of gear and
coast down a hill. This is extremely
dangerous.
Don’t “ride” the brakes. This can
cause the brakes and related parts to
overheat and malfunction.
When you are driving down a long hill,
slow down and shift to a lower gear.
Engine braking will help slow down
the vehicle.
Slow down before shifting to a lower
gear. This will help avoid over-revving
the engine, which can cause damage.
Slow down when you encounter cross
winds. This gives you much better
control of your vehicle.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you shift into R
(Reverse) to prevent damage to the
transmission.
Exercise extreme caution when driving
on a slippery surface. Be especially
careful when braking, accelerating or
shifting gears. On a slippery surface,
an abrupt change in vehicle speed can
cause the drive wheels to lose traction
and may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
WARNING
Do not use the engine brake (shifting
from a higher gear to lower gear)
rapidly on slippery roads. The vehicle
may slip causing an accident.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ALWAYS wear your seatbelt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast and sharp turns.
The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
6-15
06
$8720$7('0$18$/75$160,66,21ǣ$07Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OAI3069004I
OAI3069004I
Press the shift button, then move shift lever.
Move shift lever.
The Automated Manual Transmission (AMT) is a transmission equipped with a gear
actuator and a clutch actuator in addition to the conventional manual transmission.
To improve the driving convenience, gear shift is automatically performed by the
transmission control unit and clutch/gear actuator.
6-16
Driving Your Vehicle
Automated Manual
Transmission (AMT) operation
The Automated Manual Transmission
(AMT) has five forward speeds and one
reverse speed.
The individual speeds are selected
automatically in the D (Drive) position.
Features of the Automated
Manual Transmission (AMT)
The Automated Manual Transmission
(AMT) can be thought of as an
automatically shifting manual
transmission. It gives the driving feel
of a manual transmission.
When D (Drive) is selected, the
transmission will automatically
shift through the gears similar to a
conventional automatic transmission.
Unlike a traditional automatic
transmission, the gear shifting can
sometimes be felt and heard as the
actuators engage the clutches and
the gears are selected. When the gear
is shifting, you may sometimes hear
operating noise. This is normal and
does not indicate a problem with your
transmission.
The Automated Manual Transmission
(AMT) adopts a dry-type single
clutch, which is different from the
torque converter of the automatic
transmission. It shows better
acceleration performance and
increased fuel efficiency while
driving but initial launch might be
little bit slower than the automatic
transmission.
As a result, gear shifts are sometimes
more noticeable than a conventional
automatic transmission and a light
vibration during launching can be felt
as the transmission speed is matched
with the engine speed. This is a normal
condition of the Automated Manual
Transmission (AMT).
The dry-type clutch transfers torque
more directly and provides a direct
drive feeling which may feel different
from a conventional automatic
transmission with a torque converter.
This may be more noticeable when
launching the vehicle from a stop or
when traveling at low, stop-and-go
vehicle speeds.
When rapidly accelerating at a low
vehicle speed, the engine RPM may
increase highly depending on the
vehicle’s driving condition.
For a smooth launch uphill, depress
the accelerator pedal smoothly
depending on the current conditions.
If you release your foot from the
accelerator pedal at low vehicle speed,
you may feel engine braking, which is
similar to manual transmission.
6-17
06
When you turn the engine on and off,
you may hear clicking sounds as the
system goes through a self-test. This
is a normal sound for the Automated
Manual Transmission (AMT).
During the first 1,500 km (1,000 miles),
you may feel that the vehicle may not
be smooth when accelerating at low
speed. During this break-in period, the
shift quality and performance of your
new vehicle is continuously optimized.
i Information
- Creeping function
The Creeping function helps the vehicle
to start smoothly. If you take your foot
off the brake pedal when the shift lever
is either in R (Reverse), D (Drive) or M
(Manual) position, the vehicle will start
slowly without depressing the accelerator
pedal. To disable the function, depress the
brake pedal or pull up the parking brake
lever.
The creeping function will not operate
when:
The parking brake lever is engaged
with the shift lever in R (Reverse), D
(Drive) or M (Manual) position
Automated Manual Transmission
(AMT) instruction label
OAH2038024
OAH2038024
Read and follow the instruction label
attached on the driver side’s sunvisor
before driving the vehicle.
6-18
Driving Your Vehicle
Lever shifting Shifting condition When shifting condition is dissatisfied
From
(Current position) To
(Desired position) Vehicle speed Brake
Cluster
Transmission
position
Shift indicator Sound
Brake press
indicator
RN N/A - - - -
DReversing below
7 km/h (4 mile/h) Applied R or N blinking On On N
NRMoving forward
below
2 km/h (1 mile/h) Applied N blinking On On N
DReversing below
7 km/h (4 mile/h) Applied N blinking On On N
DRMoving forward
below
2 km/h (1 mile/h) Applied D or N blinking On On N
N N/A - - - -
Lever shifting condition
6-19
06
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death:
ALWAYS check the surrounding
areas near your vehicle for people,
especially children, before shifting a
vehicle into D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift lever is
in the N (Neutral) position, then set
the parking brake, and place the
ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur if these
precautions are not followed.
Do not use engine braking (shifting
from a high gear to lower gear)
rapidly on slippery roads. The vehicle
may slip causing an accident.
The indicator in the instrument cluster
displays the shift lever position when the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
WARNING
After the vehicle has stopped, always
make sure the shift lever is in N
(Neutral), apply the parking brake,
and turn the engine off.
Do not use the N (Neutral) position in
place of the parking brake.
Automated Manual
Transmission (AMT)
warning indicator
Press Brake
The engine can not be started unless
the shift lever is ‘N’ position and brake
pedal is depressed.
Automated Manual
Transmission (AMT)
warning lamp
Clutch Over Heated
This warning light indicates that the
clutch is overheat. It appears for a while
when the ignition switch is turned ON.
The indicator light illuminates when the
Clutch’s estimated temperature rises up
to limited value.
6-20
Driving Your Vehicle
i Information
The AMT waring lamp may come on
when clutch slip occurs excessively due
to repeated stop-and-go driving on steep
grades and when Hill Hold is maintained
for a long time. In order to prevent
waring lamp ON, use the brake during
low speed driving on hill or when
stopping the vehicle on an Uphill slope.
If the vehicle is held on a hill by
using only the accelerator pedal or
by creeping with brake pedal dis-
engaged, the clutch may overheat
which can result in damage. At this
time, a warning lamp will appear on
the cluster.
If the warning lamp is active, the foot
brake must be applied.
• Ignoring the warnings can lead
to damage to the clutch and
transmission.
Clutch High temperature
First warning
Under certain conditions, such as
repeated stop-and-go launches on
steep grades, sudden take off or
acceleration, or other harsh driving
conditions, the clutch temperature will
increase excessively.
When the clutch temperature is high,
the safe protection mode and warning
lamp engages and the gear position
indicator on the cluster blinks three
times with a chime.
Second warning
After first warning, clutch temperature
is increased continuously, then
warning sound and shift indicator
blinks continuously.
If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes and
allow the clutch to cool for a few
minutes with engine on.
If you ignore this warning, the driving
condition may become worse.
You may experience abrupt shifts,
jerkiness.
To return to the normal driving
condition, stop the vehicle and
apply the foot brake. Then allow the
transmission to cool for a few minutes
with engine on.
WARNING
On an uphill road, never hold the
vehicle at a stop using only the
accelerator pedal or the creeping
mode.
This may cause clutch overheating
and excessive damage, resulting in the
reduction of the clutch’s life cycle.
6-21
06
Clutch overheated
Final warning
If the vehicle continues to be driven
and the clutch temperatures reach
the maximum temperature limit,
the warning lamp will be blinked
continuously.
If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes
and allow the clutch to cool for a
few minutes with engine on until
the warning lamp disappear on the
cluster.
• When possible, drive the vehicle
smoothly.
If any of the warnings continue to
blink, for your safety, we recommend
you contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
NOTICE
Always come to a complete stop
before shifting into R (Reverse)
position.
When moving to R (Reverse) position
the gear is not shifted if the vehicle
speed is over 3 km/h.
Depress the brake pedal fully. If
not, the brake press indicator will
illuminate and the gear is not shifted.
N (Neutral)
The wheels and transmission are not
engaged.
Use N (Neutral) if you need to restart
a stalled engine, or if it is necessary to
stop with the engine ON.
Always depress the brake pedal when
you are shifting from N (Neutral) to
another gear.
WARNING
Do not shift into gear unless your foot is
firmly on the brake pedal. Shifting into
gear when the engine is running at high
speed can cause the vehicle to move
very rapidly. You could lose control of
the vehicle and hit people or objects.
D (Drive)
This is the normal forward driving
position. The transmission will
automatically shift to the appropriate
gear position upon operation of the
accelerator pedal and variation of
vehicle speed.
For extra power when passing another
vehicle or driving uphill, depress the
accelerator further until you feel the
transmission downshift to a lower gear.
6-22
Driving Your Vehicle
When starting off on an uphill
Engage the parking brake firmly
to prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards.
Move the shift lever to D (Drive)
position while depressing the brake
pedal. Make sure that the shift
indicator in the cluster displays 1st
gear.
Take your foot of the brake pedal
and depress the accelerator pedal
gradually. Then, when the vehicle
starts moving, release the parking
brake and depress the accelerator
pedal.
When starting off on a downhill
Depress the brake pedal and move the
shift lever to D (Drive) position. Make
sure that the shift indicator in the
cluster displays 1st gear.
Take your foot off the brake pedal and
slowly depress the accelerator pedal.
When the vehicle speed increases, the
clutch will be engaged.
NOTICE
If the gear is not shifted after
changing the shift lever from N
(Neutral) to D (Drive)/M (Manual)/R
(Reverse), try to shift the gear
again. In this case, time delay and
intermittent noise may occur which
are normal.
Always come to a complete stop
and depress the brake pedal before
shifting into D (Drive) position .
When moving from R (Reverse) to
D (Drive) position, the gear is not
shifted if the vehicle speed is over 8
km/h (5 mph).
Depress the brake pedal fully. If
not, the brake press indicator will
illuminate and the gear is not shifted.
6-23
06
Manual shift mode
OAI3069005I
OAI3069005I
Whether the vehicle is stationary or in
motion, Manual shift mode is selected
by pushing the shift lever from the
D (Drive) position into the manual
gate (M). To return to D (Drive) range
operation, push the shift lever back into
the main gate.
In Manual shift mode, moving the shift
lever backwards and forwards will allow
you to select the desired range of gears
for the current driving conditions.
+ (Up) : Push the lever forward once to
shift up one gear.
- (Down) : Pull the lever backwards once
to shift down one gear.
NOTICE
If you cannot move the shift lever
into any position or if the gear is
automatically moved to N (Neutral)
position when the vehicle speed
becomes below 10 km/h, this may
indicate malfunction of the system. In
this case, we recommend the system
be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
i Information
Only the five forward gears can be
selected. To reverse or park the vehicle,
move the shift lever to the R (Reverse)
or N (Neutral) position as required.
Downshifts are made automatically
when the vehicle slows down. When the
vehicle stops, 1st gear is automatically
selected.
When the engine rpm approaches the
red zone the transmission will upshift
automatically.
If the driver presses the lever to + (Up)
or - (Down) position, the transmission
may not make the requested gear
change if the next gear is outside of
the allowable engine RPM range.
The driver must execute upshifts in
accordance with road conditions, taking
care to keep the engine RPMs below the
red zone.
When accelerating from a stop on
a slippery road, push the shift lever
forward into the + (Up) position. This
allows the transmission to shift into the
2nd gear which is better for smooth
driving on a slippery road. Push the
shift lever to the - (Down) side to shift
back to the 1st gear.
6-24
Driving Your Vehicle
Parking
To park your vehicle, always come to a
complete stop and continue to depress
the brake pedal.
When parking on the flat road, move
the shift lever from D (Drive)/R
(Reverse) to N (Neutral) position.
Then, engage the parking brake firmly
before turning off the engine.
When parking on a slope, it is
recommended to place the shift lever
in D (Drive) for uphill and R (Reverse)
for downhill and to engage the parking
brake before turning off the engine.
If the engine was turned off with the
shift lever in D (Drive) or R (Reverse)
position, it is necessary to depress the
brake pedal and move the shift lever
to N (Neutral) position to turn on the
engine. Take the Key with you when
exiting the vehicle.
WARNING
When you stay in the vehicle with
the engine running, be careful not to
depress the accelerator pedal for a long
period of time. The engine or exhaust
system may overheat and start a fire.
The exhaust gas and the exhaust
system are very hot. Keep away from
the exhaust system components.
Do not stop or park over flammable
materials, such as dry grass, paper or
leaves. They may ignite and cause a
fire.
Good driving practices
Never move the shift lever from N
(Neutral) to any other position with the
accelerator pedal depressed.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
Do not move the shift lever to N
(Neutral) when driving. Doing so may
result in an accident because of a loss
of engine braking and the transmission
could be damaged.
Driving uphill or downhill, always shift
to D (Drive) when driving forward or to
R (Reverse) when driving backwards,
and check the gear position indicated
on the cluster before driving. If you
drive in the opposite direction of the
selected gear, the engine will turn
off and a serious accident might be
occurred due to the degraded brake
performance.
Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can result
in the brakes overheating, brake wear
and possibly even brake failure.
Depressing both accelerator and brake
pedals at the same time can trigger
logic for engine power reduction to
assure vehicle deceleration. Vehicle
acceleration will resume after the
brake pedal is released.
When driving in Manual shift mode,
slow down before shifting to a lower
gear. Otherwise, the lower gear may
not be engaged if the engine RPMs are
outside of the allowable range.
6-25
06
Always apply the parking brake when
leaving the vehicle. Do not depend on
placing the transmission in N (Neutral)
to keep the vehicle from moving.
Exercise extreme caution when driving
on a slippery surface. Be especially
careful when braking, accelerating or
shifting gears. On a slippery surface,
an abrupt change in vehicle speed can
cause the drive wheels to lose traction
and may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident
• Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ALWAYS wear your seatbelt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
6-26
Driving Your Vehicle
Power brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes
that adjust automatically through normal
usage.
If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the brakes will not work. You can still
stop your vehicle by applying greater
force to the brake pedal than typical.
The stopping distance, however, will be
longer than with power brakes.
Pump the brake pedal only when
necessary to maintain steering control
on slippery surfaces.
i Information
When the brake pedal is depressed
under certain driving conditions
or weather conditions, you may
temporarily hear a noise. This is normal
and does not indicate a problem with
your brakes.
While driving on a road with deicing
chemicals, brake noise or abnormal
tire wear may occur due to deicing
chemicals. In a safe traffic condition,
additionally apply the brakes to remove
deicing chemicals on the brake discs
and pads.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. This will create
abnormal high brake temperatures,
excessive brake lining and pad wear,
and increased stopping distances.
When descending a long or steep
hill, shift to a lower gear and avoid
continuous application of the brakes.
Applying the brakes continuously
will cause the brakes to overheat and
could result in a temporary loss of
braking performance.
Wet brakes may impair the vehicle’s
ability to safely slow down; the
vehicle may also pull to one side
when the brakes are applied.
Applying the brakes lightly will
indicate whether they have been
affected in this way. Always test your
brakes in this fashion after driving
through deep water. To dry the
brakes, lightly tap the brake pedal to
heat up the brakes while maintaining
a safe forward speed until brake
performance returns to normal.
Avoid driving at high speeds until the
brakes function correctly.
Disc brakes wear indicator
When your brake pads are worn and new
pads are required, you will hear a high
pitched warning sound from your front
or rear brakes. You may hear this sound
come and go or it may occur whenever
you depress the brake pedal.
NOTICE
To avoid costly brake repairs, do not
continue to drive with worn brake pads.
i Information
Always replace brake pads as complete
front or rear axle sets.
BRAKING SYSTEM
6-27
06
Rear drum brakes
Your rear drum brakes do not have
wear indicators.Therefore, have the rear
brake linings inspected if you hear a rear
brake rubbing noise. Also have your rear
brakes inspected each time you change
or rotate your tires and when you have
the front brakes replaced.
Parking brake
OAI3069006
OAI3069006
Always set the parking brake before
leaving the vehicle, to apply:
Firmly depress the brake pedal.
Pull up the parking brake lever as far as
possible.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH, do not operate the parking
brake while the vehicle is moving
except in an emergency situation. It
could damage the brake system and
lead to an accident.
OAI3069007
OAI3069007
To release:
Firmly depress the brake pedal.
Slightly pull up the parking brake lever.
While pressing the release button (1),
lower the parking brake (2).
If the parking brake does not release
or does not release all the way, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the
brake pedal. Move the shift lever into
the 1st gear (for manual transmission
vehicle) or N (Neutral) position (for
Automated Manual Transmission
vehicle), then apply the parking
brake, and place the ignition switch
in the LOCK/OFF position.
Vehicles with the parking brake not
fully engaged are at risk for moving
inadvertently and causing injury to
yourself or others.
6-28
Driving Your Vehicle
NEVER allow anyone who is
unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch
the parking brake. If the parking
brake is released unintentionally,
serious injury may occur.
Only release the parking brake when
you are seated inside the vehicle with
your foot firmly on the brake pedal.
NOTICE
Do not apply the accelerator pedal
while the parking brake is engaged.
If you depress the accelerator pedal
with the parking brake engaged, it
will make warning sounds. Damage
to the parking brake may occur.
Driving with the parking brake on
can overheat the braking system and
cause premature wear or damage to
brake parts. Make sure the parking
brake is released and the Brake
Warning Light is off before driving.
Parking brake warning light
Check the Parking Brake
Warning Light by placing the
ignition switch to the ON
position (do not start the
engine).
This light will be illuminated when the
parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch in the START or ON position.
Before driving, be sure the parking brake
is released and the Brake Warning Light
is OFF.
If the Parking Brake Warning Light
remains on after the parking brake is
released while the engine is running,
there may be a malfunction in the
brake system. Immediate attention is
necessary.
If at all possible, cease driving the
vehicle immediately. If that is not
possible, use extreme caution while
operating the vehicle and only continue
to drive the vehicle until you can reach a
safe location.
6-29
06
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
An Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) or
an Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system will not prevent accidents
due to improper or dangerous driving
maneuvers. Even though vehicle
control is improved during emergency
braking, always maintain a safe
distance between you and objects
ahead of you. Vehicle speeds should
always be reduced during extreme
road conditions. The braking distance
for vehicles equipped with ABS or ESC
may be longer than for those without
these systems in the following road
conditions.
Drive your vehicle at reduced speeds
during the following conditions:
Rough, gravel or snow-covered
roads.
On roads where the road surface is
pitted or has different surface height.
Tire chains are installed on your
vehicle.
The safety features of an ABS or ESC
equipped vehicle should not be tested
by high speed driving or cornering. This
could endanger the safety of yourself
or others.
ABS is an electronic braking system that
helps prevent a braking skid. ABS allows
the driver to steer and brake at the same
time.
Using ABS
To obtain the maximum benefit from
your ABS in an emergency situation,
do not attempt to modulate your brake
pressure and do not try to pump your
brakes. Depress your brake pedal as
hard as possible.
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your ABS is active.
ABS does not reduce the time or
distance it takes to stop the vehicle.
Always maintain a safe distance from the
vehicle in front of you.
ABS will not prevent a skid that results
from sudden changes in direction, such
as trying to take a corner too fast or
making a sudden lane change. Always
drive at a safe speed for the road and
weather conditions.
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability.
Always steer moderately when braking
hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel
movement can still cause your vehicle
to veer into oncoming traffic or off the
road.
On loose or uneven road surfaces,
operation of the anti-lock brake system
may result in a longer stopping distance
than for vehicles equipped with a
conventional brake system.
The ABS warning light ( ) will stay
on for several seconds after the ignition
switch is in the ON position. During
that time, the ABS will go through self-
diagnosis and the light will go off if
everything is normal. If the light stays
on, you may have a problem with your
ABS. We recommend that you contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
6-30
Driving Your Vehicle
WARNING
If the ABS warning light ( ) is on and
stays on, you may have a problem with
the ABS. Your power brakes will work
normally. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, we recommend that
you contact your HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
NOTICE
When you drive on a road having poor
traction, such as an icy road, and apply
your brakes continuously, the ABS will
be active continuously and the ABS
warning light ( ) may illuminate. Pull
your vehicle over to a safe place and
turn the engine off.
Restart the engine. If the ABS warning
light is off, then your ABS system is
normal.
Otherwise, you may have a problem
with your ABS system. We recommend
that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
i Information
When you jump start your vehicle
because of a drained battery, the ABS
warning light ( ) may turn on at the
same time. This happens because of the
low battery voltage. It does not mean your
ABS is malfunctioning. Have the battery
recharged before driving the vehicle.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) (if equipped)
OAI3063008L
OAI3063008L
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system helps to stabilize the vehicle
during cornering maneuvers.
ESC checks where you are steering and
where the vehicle is actually going.
ESC applies braking pressure to any one
of the vehicle’s brakes and intervenes in
the engine management system to assist
the driver with keeping the vehicle on
the intended path. It is not a substitute
for safe driving practices. Always adjust
your speed and driving to the road
conditions.
WARNING
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions or too quickly when
cornering. The ESC system will not
prevent accidents.
Excessive speed in turns, abrupt
maneuvers, and hydroplaning on wet
surfaces can result in severe accidents.
6-31
06
ESC operation
ESC ON condition
When the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the ESC and the ESC
OFF indicator lights illuminate for
approximately three seconds and goes
off, then the ESC is turned on.
When operating
When the ESC is in
operation, the ESC indicator
light blinks:
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in
the brake pedal. This is normal and it
means your ESC is active.
When the ESC activates, the engine
may not respond to the accelerator as
it does under routine conditions.
If the Cruise Control was in use when
the ESC activates, it automatically
disengages. The Cruise Control can be
reengaged when the road conditions
allow. See “Cruise Control” in this
chapter 7 (if equipped).
When moving out of the mud or
driving on a slippery road, the engine
RPM (revolutions per minute) may
not increase even if you press the
accelerator pedal deeply. This is to
maintain the stability and traction of
the vehicle and does not indicate a
problem.
ESC OFF condition
To cancel ESC operation :
• State 1
Press the ESC OFF button briefly.
The ESC OFF indicator light and/or
message “Traction control disabled”
will illuminate and a warning chime will
sound. In this state, the traction control
function of ESC (engine management) is
disabled, but the brake control function
of ESC (braking management) still
operates.
6-32
Driving Your Vehicle
• State 2
Press and hold the ESC OFF button
continuously for more than 3 seconds.
The ESC OFF indicator light and/or
message “Traction control and ESC
disabled” illuminates and a warning
chime sounds. In this state, both the
traction control function of ESC (engine
management) and the brake control
function of ESC (braking management)
are disabled.
If the ignition switch is placed in the
LOCK/OFF position when the ESC is off,
the ESC remains off. Upon restarting the
vehicle, the ESC will automatically turn
on again.
Indicator lights
ESC indicator light (blinks)
ESC indicator light (blinks)
ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
OTD059013
OTD059013
OTD059012
OTD059012
When the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the ESC indicator light
illuminates, then goes off if the ESC
system is operating normally.
The ESC indicator light blinks whenever
the ESC is operating.
If the ESC indicator light stays on, your
vehicle may have a malfunction with
the ESC system. When this warning light
illuminates, we recommend that the
vehicle be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
The ESC OFF indicator light comes on
when the ESC is turned off with the
button.
WARNING
When the ESC is blinking, this indicates
the ESC is active:
Drive slowly and NEVER attempt to
accelerate. NEVER turn the ESC off
while the ESC indicator light is blinking
or you may lose control of the vehicle
resulting in an accident.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before
replacing tires, make sure all four tires
and wheels are the same size. Never
drive the vehicle with different sized
wheels and tires installed.
6-33
06
ESC OFF usage
When Driving
The ESC OFF mode should only be used
briefly to help free the vehicle if stuck in
snow or mud, by temporarily stopping
operation of the ESC, to maintain wheel
torque.
To turn the ESC off while driving, press
the ESC OFF button while driving on a
flat road surface.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the transmission:
Do not allow wheel(s) of one axle to
spin excessively while the ESC, ABS,
and parking brake warning lights
are displayed. The repairs would not
be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Reduce engine power and do not spin
the wheel(s) excessively while these
lights are displayed.
When operating the vehicle on
a dynamometer, make sure the
ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light
illuminated).
i Information
Turning the ESC off does not affect ABS
or standard brake system operation.
Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM) (if equipped)
The Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)
is a function of the Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) system. It helps ensure the
vehicle stays stable when accelerating
or braking suddenly on wet, slippery and
rough roads where traction over the four
tires can suddenly become uneven.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM):
ALWAYS check the speed and the
distance to the vehicle ahead. The
VSM is not a substitute for safe
driving practices.
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions. The VSM system will not
prevent accidents. Excessive speed
in bad weather, slippery and uneven
roads can result in severe accidents.
6-34
Driving Your Vehicle
VSM operation
VSM ON condition
The VSM operates when:
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
is on.
Vehicle speed is approximately above
15 km/h (9 mph) on curve roads.
Vehicle speed is approximately above
20 km/h (12 mph) when the vehicle is
braking on rough roads.
When operating
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may activate the ESC,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your VSM is active.
i Information
The VSM does not operate when:
Driving on a banked road such as
gradient or incline
Driving in reverse.
The ESC OFF indicator light is on.
The MDPS (Motor Driven Power
Steering) ( ) is on or blinks.
WARNING
If the ESC indicator light ( ) or the
MDPS warning light ( ) stays on
or blinks, your vehicle may have a
malfunction with the VSM system.
When the warning light illuminates
we recommend that the vehicle be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before
replacing tires, make sure all four tires
and wheels are the same size. Never
drive the vehicle with different sized
tires and wheels installed.
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
(if equipped)
Hill-Start Assist Control helps prevent
the vehicle from rolling backwards
when starting a vehicle from a stop
on a hill. The system operates the
brakes automatically for approximately
2 seconds (maximum of 5 seconds
when the accelerator pedal is slightly
depressed during HAC operation) and
releases the brake after 2 seconds or
when the accelerator pedal is depressed.
WARNING
Always be ready to depress the
accelerator pedal when starting off
an incline. Hill-Start Assist Control
activates only for approximately 2
seconds (maximum of 5 seconds
when the accelerator pedal is slightly
depressed during HAC operation).
i Information
Hill-Start Assist Control does not
operate when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) or N (Neutral).
Hill-Start Assist Control activates even
when the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) is off. However, it does not
activate, when ESC does not operate
normally.
6-35
06
Emergency Stop Signal (ESS)
The Emergency Stop Signal system
alerts the driver behind by blinking the
stop light when the vehicle is braked
rapidly and severely.
The system is activated when:
• The vehicle suddenly stops (vehicle
speed is over 55 km/h and the vehicle
deceleration at greater than 7 m/s2)
The ABS is activating
When the vehicle speed is under 40
km/h and the ABS deactivates or the
sudden stop situation is over, the stop
light blinking will stop. Instead, the
hazard warning flasher will turn on
automatically.
The hazard warning flasher will turn off
when the vehicle speed is over 10 km/h
(6.2 mph) after the vehicle has stopped.
Also, it will turn off when the vehicle is
driven at low speed for some time. You
can turn it off manually by pushing the
hazard warning flasher switch.
CAUTION
The Emergency Stop Signal (ESS)
system will not work if the hazard
warning flasher is already on.
Brake Assist System (BAS)
(if equipped)
The Brake Assistant System provides
additional pressure when the brake
pedal is momentarily and strongly
depressed in a situation sudden braking
is required whilst driving. The Brake
Assistant System reduces the time for
ABS (Anti-Lock Brake System) control
to enter and consequently reduces
the braking distance, by providing
additional pressure up to the point of
ABS intervention.
BAS operation
When the vehicle speed is more than
30 km/h (20 mph) and the ABS control
is not entered.
When the brake pedal is depressed
strongly over a certain level.
When the friction of the road surface
is above a certain level.
BAS operation off
The vehicle speed is below 10 km/h (6
mph).
The brake pedal is depressed over a
certain conditions.
The friction of the road surface is
below a certain level.
WARNING
The system may not operate depending
on driver’s driving habit, the degree to
which the brake pedal is depressed and
the road surface condition.
6-36
Driving Your Vehicle
Good braking practices
WARNING
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the brake
pedal. Move the shift lever into the 1st
gear (for manual transmission vehicle)
or N (Neutral) position (for Automated
Manual Transmission vehicle), then
apply the parking brake, and place
the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position.
Vehicles with the parking brake not
fully engaged are at risk for moving
inadvertently and causing injury to
yourself or others.
Wet brakes can be dangerous! The
brakes may get wet if the vehicle is
driven through standing water or if it is
washed. Your vehicle will not stop as
quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet brakes
may cause the vehicle to pull to one
side.
To dry the brakes, apply the brakes
lightly until the braking action returns to
normal, taking care to keep the vehicle
under control at all times. If the braking
action does not return to normal, stop
as soon as it is safe to do so and we
recommend that you call an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.
DO NOT drive with your foot resting on
the brake pedal. Even light, but constant
pedal pressure can result in the brakes
overheating, brake wear, and possibly
even brake failure.
If a tire goes flat while you are driving,
apply the brakes gently and keep the
vehicle pointed straight ahead while you
slow down. When you are moving slowly
enough for it to be safe to do so, pull off
the road and stop in a safe location.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal
when the vehicle is stopped to prevent
the vehicle from rolling forward.
6-37
06
Hazardous driving conditions
When hazardous driving conditions are
encountered such as water, snow, ice,
mud or sand:
Drive cautiously and allow extra distance
for braking.
Avoid sudden movements in braking or
steering.
If stuck in snow, mud, or sand, use
second gear. Accelerate slowly to avoid
spinning the drive wheels.
WARNING
Downshifting with an Automated
manual transmission while driving
on slippery surfaces can cause an
accident. The sudden change in tire
speed could cause the tires to skid. Be
careful when downshifting on slippery
surfaces.
Use sand, rock salt, or other non-slip
material under the drive wheels to
provide traction when stalled in ice,
snow, or mud.
Rocking the vehicle
If it is necessary to rock the vehicle to
free it from snow, sand, or mud, first
turn the steering wheel to the right
and left to clear the area around your
front wheels. Then, shift back and
forth between the 1st and R (Reverse,
for manual transmission vehicle) or
R (Reverse) and a forward gear (for
Automated manual transmission
vehicle). Try to avoid spinning the
wheels, and do not race the engine.
To prevent transmission wear, wait until
the wheels stop spinning before shifting
gears. Release the accelerator pedal
while shifting, and press lightly on the
accelerator pedal while the transmission
is in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in
forward and reverse directions causes
a rocking motion that may free the
vehicle.
NOTICE
If the tires spin at high speed, the tires
can explode and you or others may be
injured. Do not attempt this procedure
if people or objects are anywhere near
the vehicle.
The vehicle can overheat causing an
engine compartment fire or other
damage. Spin the wheels as little as
possible and avoid spinning the wheels
at speeds over 56 km/h (35 mph) as
indicated on the speedometer.
NOTICE
If you are still stuck after rocking the
vehicle a few times, have the vehicle
pulled out by a tow vehicle to avoid
engine overheating, possible damage
to the transmission, and tire damage.
See “Towing” in chapter 8.
63(&,$/'5,9,1*&21',7,216
6-38
Driving Your Vehicle
Smooth cornering
Avoid braking or gear changing in
corners, especially when roads are wet.
Ideally, corners should always be taken
under gentle acceleration.
Driving at night
Night driving presents more hazards
than driving in the daylight. Here are
some important tips to remember:
Slow down and keep more distance
between you and other vehicles, as it
may be more difficult to see at night,
especially in areas where there may
not be any street lights.
Adjust your mirrors to reduce the glare
from other driver’s headlights.
Keep your headlights clean and
properly aimed. Dirty or improperly
aimed headlights will make it much
more difficult to see at night.
Avoid staring directly at the headlights
of oncoming vehicles. You could be
temporarily blinded, and it will take
several seconds for your eyes to
readjust to the darkness.
Driving in the rain
Rain and wet roads can make driving
dangerous. Here are a few things to
consider when driving in the rain or on
slick pavement:
Slow down and allow extra following
distance. A heavy rainfall makes
it harder to see and increases the
distance needed to stop your vehicle.
Replace your windshield wiper blades
when they show signs of streaking or
missing areas on the windshield.
Be sure your tires have enough tread.
If your tires do not have enough tread,
making a quick stop on wet pavement
can cause a skid and possibly lead to
an accident. See “Tire replacement” in
chapter 9.
Turn on your headlights to make it
easier for others to see you.
Driving too fast through large puddles
can affect your brakes. If you must go
through puddles, try to drive through
them slowly.
If you believe your brakes may be wet,
apply them lightly while driving until
normal braking operation returns.
Hydroplaning
If the road is wet enough and you are
going fast enough, your vehicle may
have little or no contact with the road
surface and actually ride on the water.
The best advice is SLOW DOWN when
the road is wet. The risk of hydroplaning
increases as the depth of tire tread
decreases, refer to “Tire replacement” in
chapter 9.
6-39
06
Driving in flooded areas
Avoid driving through flooded areas
unless you are sure the water is no
higher than the bottom of the wheel
hub. Drive through any water slowly.
Allow adequate stopping distance
because brake performance may be
reduced.
After driving through water, dry the
brakes by gently applying them several
times while the vehicle is moving slowly.
6-40
Driving Your Vehicle
Snow or icy conditions
You need to keep sufficient distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front of you.
Apply the brakes gently. Speeding, rapid
acceleration, sudden brake applications,
and sharp turns are potentially
very hazardous practices. During
deceleration, use engine braking to the
fullest extent. Sudden brake applications
on snowy or icy roads may cause skids
to occur.
To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it
may be necessary to use snow tires or to
install tire chains on your tires.
Always carry emergency equipment.
Some of the items you may want to
carry include tire chains, tow straps or
chains, a flashlight, emergency flares,
sand, a shovel, jumper cables, a window
scraper, gloves, ground cloth, coveralls,
a blanket, etc.
Snow tires
WARNING
Snow tires should be equivalent in size
and type to the vehicle’s standard tires.
Otherwise, the safety and handling of
your vehicle may be adversely affected.
If you mount snow tires on your vehicle,
make sure to use radial tires of the same
size and load range as the original tires.
Mount snow tires on all four wheels
to balance your vehicle’s handling in
all weather conditions. The traction
provided by snow tires on dry roads
may not be as high as your vehicle’s
original equipment tires. Check with
the tire dealer for maximum speed
recommendations.
We recommend you use snow tires
when road temperature is below 7 °C
(45 °F).
i Information
Do not install studded tires without first
checking local and municipal regulations
for possible restrictions against their use.
Tire chains
OAI3062020
OAI3062020
Since the sidewalls of radial tires are
thinner than other types of tires, they
may be damaged by mounting some
types of tire chains on them. Therefore,
the use of snow tires is recommended
instead of tire chains. Do not mount
tire chains on vehicles equipped with
aluminum wheels; if possible use a wire
type chain. If tire chains must be used,
Use wire-type chains with a thickness of
less than 15 mm (0.59 in) and install the
tire chain after reviewing the instructions
provided with the tire chains. Damage
to your vehicle caused by improper tire
chain use is not covered by your vehicle
manufacturer’s warranty.
WINTER DRIVING
6-41
06
WARNING
The use of tire chains may adversely
affect vehicle handling:
Drive less than 30 km/h (20 mph)
or the chain manufacturer’s
recommended speed limit,
whichever is lower.
Drive carefully and avoid bumps,
holes, sharp turns, and other road
hazards, which may cause the vehicle
to bounce.
Avoid sharp turns or locked wheel
braking.
i Information
Install tire chains on the front tires.
It should be noted that installing
tire chains on the tires will provide
a greater driving force, but will not
prevent side skids.
Do not install tire chains without
first checking local and municipal
regulations for possible restrictions
against their use.
Chain Installation
When installing tire chains, follow the
manufacturer’s instructions and mount
them as tightly possible. Drive slowly
(less than 30 km/h (20 mph)) with
chains installed. If you hear the chains
contacting the body or chassis, stop and
tighten them. If they still make contact,
slow down until the noise stops. Remove
the tire chains as soon as you begin
driving on cleared roads.
When mounting snow chains, park
the vehicle on level ground away from
traffic. Turn on the vehicle Hazard
Warning Flasher and place a triangular
emergency warning device behind the
vehicle (if available). Always place the
vehicle in N (Neutral), apply the parking
brake and turn off the engine before
installing snow chains.
NOTICE
When using tire chains:
Wrong size chains or improperly
installed chains can damage your
vehicle’s brake lines, suspension,
body and wheels.
Use SAE “S” class or wire chains.
If you hear noise caused by chains
contacting the body, retighten the
chain to prevent contact with the
vehicle body.
To prevent body damage, retighten
the chains after driving 0.5~1.0 km
(0.3~0.6 miles).
Do not use tire chains on vehicles
equipped with aluminum wheels. If
unavoidable, use a wire type chain.
Use wire chains less than 15 mm (0.59
in) wide to prevent damage to the
chain’s connection.
6-42
Driving Your Vehicle
Winter precautions
Use high quality ethylene glycol
coolant
Your vehicle is delivered with high
quality ethylene glycol coolant in the
cooling system. It is the only type of
coolant that should be used because it
helps prevent corrosion in the cooling
system, lubricates the water pump and
prevents freezing. Be sure to replace or
replenish your coolant in accordance
with the maintenance schedule in
chapter 9. Before winter, have your
coolant tested to assure that its freezing
point is sufficient for the temperatures
anticipated during the winter.
Check battery and cables
Winter puts additional burdens on the
battery system. Visually inspect the
battery and cables as described in
chapter 8. The level of charge in your
battery can be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or a service station.
Change to “winter weight” oil if
necessary
In some climates, it is recommended
that a lower viscosity “winter weight”
oil be used during cold weather. See
chapter 2 for recommendations. If you
aren’t sure what weight oil you should
use, we recommend that you consult
with an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check spark plugs and ignition
system
Inspect your spark plugs as described
in chapter 9 and replace them if
necessary. Also check all ignition wiring
and components to be sure they are not
cracked, worn or damaged in any way.
To keep locks from freezing
To keep the locks from freezing, squirt
an approved de-icer fluid or glycerine
into the key opening. If a lock is covered
with ice, squirt it with an approved
de-icing fluid to remove the ice. If the
lock is frozen internally, you may be able
to thaw it out by using a heated key.
Handle the heated key with care to avoid
injury.
Use approved window washer anti-
freeze in system
To keep the water in the window washer
system from freezing, add an approved
window washer anti-freeze solution in
accordance with instructions on the
container. Window washer anti-freeze is
available from an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and most auto parts outlets. Do
not use engine coolant or other types
of anti-freeze as these may damage the
paint finish.
6-43
06
Don’t let your parking brake freeze
Under some conditions, your parking
brake can freeze in the engaged
position. This is most likely to happen
when there is an accumulation of snow
or ice around or near the rear brakes or
if the brakes are wet. If there is a risk
the parking brake may freeze, apply
it only temporarily while you put the
shift lever in N (for Automated Manual
Transmission) or in the first or reverse
gear (for Manual Transmission) and
block the rear wheels so the vehicle
cannot roll. Then release the parking
brake.
Don’t let ice and snow accumulate
underneath
Under some conditions, snow and ice
can build up under the fenders and
interfere with the steering. When driving
in severe winter conditions where this
may happen, you should periodically
check underneath the car to be sure the
movement of the front wheels and the
steering components is not obstructed.
Carry emergency equipment
Depending on the severity of the
weather, you should carry appropriate
emergency equipment. Some of the
items you may want to carry include tire
chains, tow straps or chains, flashlight,
emergency flares, sand, shovel, jumper
cables, window scraper, gloves, ground
cloth, coveralls, blanket, etc.
Don’t place foreign objects
or materials in the engine
compartment
Placement of foreign objects or
materials which prevent cooling of the
engine, in the engine compartment,
may cause a failure or combustion. The
manufacturer is not responsible for the
damage caused by such placement.
Drive your vehicle when water
vapor condenses and accumulates
inside the exhaust pipes
When the vehicle is stopped for a
long time in winter while the engine is
running, water vapor may condense and
accumulate inside the exhaust pipes.
Water in the exhaust pipes may cause
noise, etc., but it is drained driving at
medium to high speed.
6-44
Driving Your Vehicle
Two labels on your driver’s door sill show
how much weight your vehicle was
designed to carry: the Tire and Loading
Information Label and the Certification
Label.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize
yourself with the following terms for
determining your vehicle’s weight
ratings, from the vehicle’s specifications
and the Certification Label:
Base Curb Weight
This is the weight of the vehicle
including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not
include passengers, cargo, or optional
equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight
This is the weight of your new vehicle
when you picked it up from your dealer
plus any aftermarket equipment.
Cargo Weight
This figure includes all weight added to
the Base Curb Weight, including cargo
and optional equipment.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight)
This is the total weight placed on each
axle (front and rear) - including vehicle
curb weight and all payload.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
that can be carried by a single axle (front
or rear). These numbers are shown on
the Certification Label. The total load on
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
This is the Base Curb Weight plus actual
Cargo Weight plus passengers.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
of the fully loaded vehicle (including
all options, equipment, passengers
and cargo). The GVWR is shown on
the Certification Label located on the
driver’s door sill.
Overloading
WARNING
The Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
and the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) for your vehicle are on the
Certification Label attached to the
driver’s (or front passenger’s) door.
Exceeding these ratings can cause an
accident or vehicle damage. You can
calculate the weight of your load by
weighing the items (and people) before
putting them in the vehicle. Be careful
not to overload your vehicle.
VEHICLE WEIGHT
Cruise Control (CC) ..........................................................................................7-2
Cruise Control operation ..........................................................................................7-2
Rear View Monitor (RVM) ...............................................................................7-6
Rear View Monitor operation ....................................................................................7-6
Rear View Monitor malfunction and limitations .....................................................7-7
Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) ....................................................7-8
Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings ............................................................ 7-8
Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation ..........................................................7-9
Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and precautions .........................7-9
7. Driver Assistance System
7
Driver Assistance System
7-2
OTM070111
OTM070111
(1) Cruise indicator
(2) Set speed
Cruise Control will allow you to drive at
speeds above 30 km/h (20 mph) without
depressing the accelerator pedal.
NOTICE
During cruise-speed driving of a
manual transmission vehicle, do not
shift into neutral without depressing
the clutch pedal, as the engine will be
overrevved. If this happens, depress
the clutch pedal or press the Driving
Assist button.
Cruise Control operation
To set speed
OAI3063018L
OAI3063018L
1. Press the Driving Assist button on the
steering wheel to turn the function on.
The CRUISE indicator on the cluster
will illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed, which
must be more than 30 km/h (20 mph).
Information
For manual transmission vehicles, you
should depress the brake pedal at least
once to set the cruise control after starting
the engine.
OAI3063011L
OAI3063011L
3. Push the SET- switch down, and
release it. The Set indicator on the
cluster display will illuminate.
4. Release the accelerator pedal.
&58,6(&21752/ǣ&&Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
07
7-3
Information
The vehicle may slow down or speed up
slightly while going uphill or downhill.
To increase speed
OAI3063012L
OAI3063012L
Push the RES+ switch up and hold it,
while monitoring the speedometer
on the instrument cluster. Release
the toggle switch when the desired
speed is shown and the vehicle will
accelerate to that speed.
Push the RES+ switch up and release
it immediately. The set speed will
increase 2 km/h (1.2 mph) each time
the toggle switch is operated in this
manner.
• Depress the accelerator pedal. When
the vehicle attains the desired speed,
push the SET- switch down.
To decrease speed
OAI3063011L
OAI3063011L
Push the SET- switch down and hold
it. Your vehicle will gradually slow
down. Release the toggle switch at the
speed you want to maintain.
Push the SET- switch down and
release it immediately. The set speed
will decrease 2 km/h (1.2 mph) each
time the toggle switch is operated in
this manner.
Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the
vehicle attains the desired speed, push
the SET- switch down.
To temporarily accelerate
Depress the accelerator pedal. When
you take your foot off the accelerator,
the vehicle will return to the previously
set speed.
If you push SET- switch down at the
increased speed, Cruise Control will
maintain the increased speed.
Driver Assistance System
7-4
To temporarily pause Cruise Control
OAI3063019L
OAI3063019L
Cruise Control will be paused when:
• Depressing the brake pedal.
Depressing the clutch pedal. (for
manual transmission vehicle)
Pressing the CANCEL button located
on the steering wheel. The indicator
will turn off.
Decreasing the vehicle speed lower
than the memory speed by 20 km/h
(12 mph).
Decreasing the vehicle speed to less
than approximately 30 km/h (20 mph).
Information
Each of the above actions will cancel
Cruise Control operation (the SET
indicator light in the instrument cluster
will go off), but only pressing the Driving
Assist button will turn the function off.
If you wish to resume Cruise Control
operation, push the RES+ switch up
located on your steering wheel. You will
return to your previously set speed, unless
the function was turned off using the
Driving Assist button.
To resume Cruise Control
OAI3063012L
OAI3063012L
Push the RES+ switch up. If the vehicle
speed is over 30 km/h (20 mph), the
vehicle will resume the preset speed.
07
7-5
To turn off the Cruise Control
OAI3063018L
OAI3063018L
Pressing the Driving Assist button. The
cruise indicator will go off.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Cruise Control:
Always set the vehicle speed to the
speed limit in your country.
Keep Cruise Control off when the
function is not in use, to avoid
inadvertently setting a speed. Check
that the Cruise ( ) indicator is
off.
Cruise Control does not substitute
for proper and safe driving. It is the
responsibility of the driver to always
drive safely and should always be
aware of unexpected and sudden
situations from occurring.
Always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
Do not use Cruise Control when it
may be unsafe to keep the vehicle at
a constant speed:
- When driving in heavy traffic, or
when traffic conditions make it
difficult to drive at a constant speed
- When driving on rainy, icy, or snow-
covered roads
- When driving on hilly or windy roads
- When driving in windy areas
- When driving with limited view
(possibly due to bad weather, such
as fog, snow, rain and sandstorm)
Do not use Cruise Control when
towing a trailer.
Driver Assistance System
7-6
Rear View Monitor shows the area
behind the vehicle to assist you when
parking or backing up.
Detecting sensor
5 Door
5 Door
OAI3072022
OAI3072022
4 Door
4 Door
OAI3072024
OAI3072024
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting sensor.
Rear View Monitor operation
Rear view
Shift the gear to R (Reverse), the
image will appear on the screen.
Off conditions
The rear view cannot be turned off
when the gear is in R (Reverse).
Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to P
(Park), the rear view will turn off.
5($59,(:021,725ǣ590Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
07
7-7
Rear view while driving
(if equipped)
OAI3053050L
OAI3053050L
The driver is able to check the rear view
on the screen while driving, it is to assist
with safe driving.
Operating conditions
The ignition switch is turned ON.
The rear view monitor button (1) is
pressed when gear shift status is D
(Drive) or N (Neutral).
Off conditions
The rear view monitor button (1) is
pressed again.
When operating
When the vehicle is reversing, the
screen switches to the parking
guidance screen.
When Rear view while driving is
displayed on the screen, an icon ( )
will appear on the upper right side
of the screen indicating that the rear
view is being displayed.
Rear View Monitor malfunction
and limitations
Rear View Monitor malfunction
When Rear View Monitor is not working
properly, or the screen flickers, or
the camera image does not display
normally, we recommend that the
function beinspected by an authorized
HYUNDAIdealer.
Limitations of the Rear View
Monitor
When the vehicle is stopped for a long
time in winter or when the vehicle is
parked in an indoor parking lot, the
exhaust fumes may temporarily blur the
image.
WARNING
The rear view camera does not cover
the complete area behind the vehicle.
The driver should always check the
rear area directly through the inside
and outside rearview mirror before
parking or backing up.
The image shown on the screen may
differ from the actual distance of the
object. Make sure to directly check
the vehicle's surroundings for safety.
Always keep the rear view camera
lens clean. If the lens is covered with
foreign material, it may adversely
affect camera performance and
Rear View Monitor may not operate
normally. However, do not use
chemical solvents such as strong
detergents containing high alkaline
or volatile organic solvents (gasoline,
acetone etc.). This may damage the
camera lens.
Driver Assistance System
7-8
5(9(56(3$5.,1*',67$1&(:$51,1*ǣ3':Ǥ
Reverse Parking Distance Warning will
help warn the driver if an obstacle is
detected within a certain distance when
the vehicle is moving in reverse at low
speeds.
Detecting sensor
OAI3072023
OAI3072023
5 Door
5 Door
4 Door
4 Door
OAI3059059
OAI3059059
[A]: Rear sensors
Refer to the picture above for the
detailed location of the detecting
sensors.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning settings
Warning Volume
6HOHFWœ'ULYHUDVVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ
volume’ from the cluster Settings menu
to change the Warning volume to ‘High’,
‘Medium’, or ‘Low’ for Reverse Parking
Distance Warning.
If you change the Warning Volume,
the warning volume of other Driver
Assistance systems may change.
07
7-9
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning operation
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
• Reverse Parking Distance Warning
will operate when the gear is in R
(Reverse).
• Reverse Parking Distance Warning
detects a person, animal or object in
the rear when the vehicle’s rearward
speed is below 10 km/h (6 mph).
Distance
from object
Warning
indicator
while
driving
backward
Warning
sound
100 ~ 61 cm
(39 ~ 24 in.) Buzzer beeps
intermittently
60 ~ 31 cm
(24 ~ 12 in.) Beeps more
frequently
within 30
cm (12 in.) Beeps
continuously
• The corresponding indicator will
illuminate whenever each senor
detects a person, animal or object
in its sensing range. Also an audible
warning will sound.
When more than two objects are
detected at the same time, the closest
one will be warned with an audible
warning.
The shape of the indicator in the
illustration may differ from the actual
vehicle.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning malfunction and
precautions
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
malfunction
After starting the engine, a beep will
sound when the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse) to indicate the function is
operating properly.
However, if one or more of the following
occurs, first check whether the sensor
is damaged or blocked with foreign
materials. If it still does not work
properly, we recommend that the
function be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
The audible warning does not sound.
The buzzer sounds intermittently.
The ‘Senseor error or blockage.
System limited’ warning message
appears on the cluster.
OBI3070014
OBI3070014
Driver Assistance System
7-10
WARNING
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
is a supplemental function. The
operation of the function can be
affected by several factors (including
environmental conditions). It is the
responsibility of the driver to always
check the rear view before and while
parking.
Your new vehicle warranty does not
cover any accidents or damage to
the vehicle due to the malfunction of
Reverse Parking Distance Warning.
Pay close attention when driving near
objects, pedestrians, and especially
children. Some objects may not be
detected by the ultrasonic sensors,
due to the objects distance, size or
material, all of which can limit the
effectiveness of the sensor.
Limitations of Reverse Parking
Distance Warning
• Reverse Parking Distance Warning
may not operate normally when:
- Moisture is frozen to the sensor
- Sensor is covered with foreign
materials, such as snow or water
(Reverse Parking Distance Warning
will operate normally when such
foreign materials are removed.)
- The weather is extremely hot or cold
- The sensor or sensor assembly is
disassembled
- The surface of the sensor is pressed
hard or an impact is applied with a
hard object
- The surface of the sensor is
scratched with a sharp object
- The sensors or its surrounding
areas are directly sprayed with high
pressure washer
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
may malfunction when:
- Heavy rain or water spray is present
- Water flows on the surface of the
sensor
- Affected by another vehicle’s sensors
- The sensor is covered with snow
- Driving on uneven roads, gravel
roads or bushes
- Objects that generate ultrasonic
waves are near the sensor
- Installing the license plate differently
from the original location
- The vehicle bumper height or sensor
installation has been modified
- Attaching equipments or accessories
around the sensors
The following objects may not be
detected:
- Sharp or slim objects such as ropes,
chains or small poles.
- Objects, which tend to absorb sensor
frequency, such as clothes, spongy
material or snow.
- Objects smaller than 100 cm (40 in.)
in length and narrower than 14 cm (6
in.) in diameter.
- Pedestrians, animals or objects that
are very close to the sensors
Parking Distance Warning Indicators
may be displayed differently from
the actual detected location when
the obstacle is located between the
sensors.
Parking Distance Warning indicator
may not occur sequentially depending
on vehicle speed or obstacle shape.
If Reverse Parking Distance Warning
needs repair, we recommend that
Reverse Parking Distance Warning be
inspected by an authorizedHYUNDAI
dealer.
Hazard warning flasher...................................................................................8-2
In case of an emergency while driving ..........................................................8-2
If the engine stalls while driving .............................................................................. 8-2
If the engine stalls at a crossroad or crossing ......................................................... 8-2
If you have a flat tire while driving ...........................................................................8-3
If the engine will not start ..............................................................................8-3
If the engine doesn’t turn over or turns over slowly ...............................................8-3
If the engine turns over normally but doesn’t start ................................................ 8-3
Jump starting ..................................................................................................8-4
If the engine overheats ................................................................................... 8-7
Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) ......................................................8-9
Check tire pressure ...................................................................................................8-9
Tire pressure monitoring system .............................................................................8-10
Low tire pressure telltale ..........................................................................................8-11
Low tire pressure position telltale and tire pressure telltale ..................................8-11
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring System) malfunction indicator ..........................8-12
Changing a tire with TPMS ......................................................................................8-12
If you have a flat tire ......................................................................................8-14
Jack and tools ..........................................................................................................8-14
Removing and storing the spare tire.......................................................................8-14
Changing tires .........................................................................................................8-15
Jack label ..................................................................................................................8-19
EC declaration of conformity for jack ....................................................................8-20
Towing ...........................................................................................................8-21
Towing service ..........................................................................................................8-21
Removable towing hook ........................................................................................ 8-22
Emergency towing ................................................................................................. 8-23
Emergency commodity ................................................................................8-25
First aid kit ...............................................................................................................8-25
Triangle reflector ..................................................................................................... 8-25
8. Emergency Situations
8
8-2
Emergency Situations
OAI3079001
OAI3079001
The hazard warning flasher serves as
a warning to other drivers to exercise
extreme caution when approaching,
overtaking, or passing your vehicle.
It should be used whenever emergency
repairs are being made or when the
vehicle is stopped near the edge of a
roadway.
To turn the hazard warning flasher on
or off, press the hazard warning flasher
button with the ignition switch in any
position. The button is located in the
crash pad garnish panel.
All turn signal lights will flash
simultaneously.
The hazard warning flasher operates
whether your vehicle is running or not.
The turn signals do not work when the
hazard flasher is on.
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY
WHILE DRIVING
If the engine stalls while driving
Reduce your speed gradually, keeping
a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place.
Turn on your hazard warning flasher.
Try to start the engine again. If your
vehicle will not start, we recommend
that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If the engine stalls at a
crossroad or crossing
If the engine stalls at a crossroad or
crossing, if safe to do so, move the shift
lever to the N (Neutral) position and then
push the vehicle to a safe location.
If your vehicle has a manual
transmission not equipped with a
ignition lock switch, the vehicle can
move forward by shifting to the
2(second) or 3(third) gear and then
turning the starter without depressing
the clutch pedal.
8-3
08
If you have a flat tire while
driving
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow down
while driving straight ahead. Do not
apply the brakes immediately or
attempt to pull off the road as this
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. When the
vehicle has slowed to such a speed
that it is safe to do so, brake carefully
and pull off the road. Drive off the
road as far as possible and park on
firm, level ground. If you are on a
divided highway, do not park in the
median area between the two traffic
lanes.
When the vehicle is stopped, press
the hazard warning flasher button,
move the shift lever into N (Neutral,
for Automated manual transmission)
or neutral (for manual transmission
vehicle), apply the parking brake, and
place the ignition switch in the LOCK/
OFF position.
Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on the
side of the vehicle that is away from
traffic.
When you have a flat tire, follow the
instructions provided later in this
chapter.
IF THE ENGINE WILL NOT
START
If the engine doesn’t turn over
or turns over slowly
Be sure the gear is in N (Neutral). The
engine starts only when the shift lever
is in N (Neutral).
Check the battery connections to be
sure they are clean and tight.
Turn on the interior light. If the light
dims or goes out when you operate
the starter, the battery is drained.
Do not push or pull the vehicle to start
it. This could cause damage to your
vehicle.
See instructions for “Jump Starting”
provided in this chapter.
WARNING
Push or pull starting the vehicle may
cause the catalytic converter to
overload which can lead to damage to
the emission control system.
If the engine turns over normally
but doesn’t start
Check the fuel level and add fuel if
necessary.
If the engine still does not start, we
recommend that you call an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.
8-4
Emergency Situations
Jump starting can be dangerous if done
incorrectly. Follow the jump starting
procedure in this section to avoid serious
injury or damage to your vehicle. If in
doubt about how to properly jump start
your vehicle, we strongly recommend
that you have a service technician or
towing service do it for you.
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH
to you or bystanders, always follow
these precautions when working near
or handling the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions carefully when
handling a battery.
Wear eye protection designed
to protect the eyes from acid
splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks, or
smoking materials away from
the battery.
Hydrogen is always present in
battery cells, is highly
combustible, and may explode
if ignited.
Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
Batteries contain sulfuric acid
which is highly corrosive. Do
not allow acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
If acid gets into your eyes, flush your
eyes with clean water for at least 15
minutes and get immediate medical
attention. If acid gets on your skin,
thoroughly wash the area. If you
feel pain or a burning sensation, get
medical attention immediately.
When lifting a plastic-cased battery,
excessive pressure on the case may
cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a
battery carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle if your battery is frozen.
NEVER attempt to recharge the
battery when the vehicle’s battery
cables are connected to the battery.
The electrical ignition system works
with high voltage. NEVER touch these
components with the engine running
or when the ignition switch is in the
ON position.
Do not allow the (+) and (-) jumper
cables to touch. It may cause sparks.
The battery may rupture or explode
when you jump start with a low or
frozen battery.
Never attempt jump start if you
observe cracks, leaks or other
damage on Battery.
JUMP STARTING
8-5
08
CAUTION
Improper jump starting procedure
can result in battery explosion and
acid burn hazard.
Loosely connected battery cables
could damage the electronic control
units.
To disconnect battery terminals
wait for at least 2 minutes to allow
discharge of high voltage or it could
lead to personal injury.
While disconnecting, always
disconnect the -VE terminal first and
while connecting, always connect the
-VE terminal last.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle:
Only use a 12-volt power supply
(battery or jumper system) to jump
start your vehicle.
Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle by push-starting.
i Information
Pb
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human health.
Dispose the battery according to
your local law(s) or regulation.
Jump starting procedure
1. Position the vehicles close enough
that the jumper cables will reach, but
do not allow the vehicles to touch.
2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in the
engine compartment at all times, even
when the vehicles are turned off.
3. Turn off all electrical devices such
as radios, lights, air conditioning,
etc. Put the vehicles in N (Neutral,
for Automated manual transmission
vehicle) or neutral (for manual
transmission vehicle), and set the
parking brakes. Turn both vehicles
OFF.
OAI3073002L
OAI3073002L
(-)
(+)
Booster Battery
Booster Battery
(-) (+)
Jumper Terminal
Jumper Terminal
Jumper Cables
Jumper Cables
4. Connect the jumper cables in
the exact sequence shown in the
illustration. First connect one jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) jumper
terminal of your vehicle (1).
5. Connect the other end of the jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
6. Connect the second jumper cable to
the black, negative (-) battery/chassis
ground of the assisting vehicle (3).
8-6
Emergency Situations
7. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the black, negative (-)
chassis ground of your vehicle (4).
Do not allow the jumper cables to
contact anything except the correct
battery or jumper terminals or the
correct ground. Do not lean over the
battery when making connections.
8. Start the engine of the assisting
vehicle and let it run at approximately
2,000 RPM for a few minutes. Then
start your vehicle.
WARNING
Do not connect the jumper cable to
the negative (-) jumper terminal of
the discharged battery. A spark could
cause the battery to explode and lead
to a personal injury or vehicle damage.
If your vehicle will not start after a
few attempts, it probably requires
servicing. In this event, please seek
qualified assistance. If the cause of your
battery discharging is not apparent,
we recommend that your vehicle be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
Never connect Jumper Cable directly to
the negative (-) terminal of discharged
Battery (Your Vehicle Battery), or an
Explosion may occur.
Disconnect the jumper cables in the
exact reverse order you connected
them:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from the
black, negative (-) chassis ground of
your vehicle (4).
2. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the black, negative
(-) battery/chassis ground of the
assisting vehicle (3).
3. Disconnect the second jumper cable
from the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
4. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the red, positive (+)
jumper terminal of your vehicle (1).
WARNING
While jump starting your vehicle, avoid
the positive (+) and negative (-) cables
to come in contact. A spark could cause
personal injury.
8-7
08
If your temperature gauge indicates
overheating, you experience a loss of
power, or hear loud pinging or knocking,
the engine may be overheating. If this
happens, you should:
1. Pull off the road and stop as soon as it
is safe to do so.
2. Place the shift lever in N (Neutral,
for Automated manual transmission
vehicle) or neutral (for manual
transmission vehicle) and set the
parking brake. If the air conditioning is
ON, turn it OFF.
3. If the engine coolant is running out
under the vehicle or steam is coming
out from the hood, stop the engine.
Do not open the hood until the coolant
has stopped running or the steaming
has stopped. If there is no visible
loss of engine coolant and no steam,
leave the engine running and check
to be sure the engine cooling fan is
operating. If the fan is not running,
turn the engine off.
WARNING
While the engine is running,
keep hands, clothing and
tools away from the moving
parts such as the cooling
fan and drive belt to
prevent serious injury.
4. Check for coolant leaking from the
radiator, hoses or under the vehicle. (If
the air conditioning had been in use, it
is normal for cold water to be draining
from it when you stop.)
5. If the engine coolant is leaking
out, stop the engine immediately
and we recommend that you call
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
WARNING
NEVER remove the radiator
cap or the drain plug while
the engine and radiator are
hot. Hot coolant and steam
may blow out under
pressure, causing serious injury.
Turn the engine off and wait until the
engine cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the radiator cap. Wrap
a thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the first
stop. Step back while the pressure
is released from the cooling system.
When you are sure all the pressure
has been released, press down on the
cap, using a thick towel, and continue
turning counterclockwise to remove it.
IF THE ENGINE OVERHEATS
8-8
Emergency Situations
6. If you cannot find the cause of the
overheating, wait until the engine
temperature has returned to normal.
Then, if coolant has been lost,
carefully add coolant to the reservoir
to bring the fluid level in the reservoir
up to the halfway mark.
7. Proceed with caution, keeping alert
for further signs of overheating.
If overheating happens again,
we recommend that you call an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
NOTICE
Serious loss of coolant indicates a
leak in the cooling system and we
recommend the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When the engine overheats from
low engine coolant, suddenly adding
engine coolant may cause cracks
in the engine. To prevent damage,
add engine coolant slowly in small
quantities.
8-9
08
OAI3082101
OAI3082101
OSU2I049052
OSU2I049052
(1) Low tire pressure telltale /
TPMS malfunction indicator
(2) Low tire pressure position telltale and
tire pressure telltale (Shown on the
cluster display)
Check tire pressure
OSU2I049054
OSU2I049054
You can check the tire pressure in the
Assist mode on the cluster.
Refer to the “User settings mode” in
chapter 4.
Tire pressure is displayed 1~2 minutes
later after driving.
If tire pressure is not displayed when
the vehicle is stopped, “Drive to
display” message will appear. After
driving, check the tire pressure.
The displayed tire pressure values may
differ from those measured with a tire
pressure gauge.
You can change the tire pressure
unit in the User Settings mode on the
instrument cluster.
- psi, kpa, bar (Refer to the “User
settings mode” in chapter 4).
7,5(35(6685(021,725,1*6<67(0ǣ7306Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
8-10
Emergency Situations
Tire pressure monitoring system
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle
handling, and lead to sudden tire
failure that may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
Each tire, including the spare (if
provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle
manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label. (If your
vehicle has tires of a different size
than the size indicated on the vehicle
placard or tire inflation pressure label,
you should determine the proper tire
inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure
telltale illuminates, you should stop and
check your tires as soon as possible,
and inflate them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated
tire causes the tire to overheat and can
lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life,
and may affect the vehicle’s handling
and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver’s responsibility to
maintain correct tire pressure, even if
under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped
with a TPMS malfunction indicator
to indicate when the system is
not operating properly. The TPMS
malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure telltale. When
the system detects a malfunction, the
telltale will flash for approximately one
minute and then remain continuously
illuminated. This sequence will continue
upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as
long as the malfunction exists. When
the malfunction indicator is illuminated,
the system may not be able to detect
or signal low tire pressure as intended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for
a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate
tires or wheels on the vehicle that
prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly. Always check the TPMS
malfunction telltale after replacing
one or more tires or wheels on your
vehicle to ensure that the replacement
or alternate tires and wheels allow the
TPMS to continue to function properly.
NOTICE
If any of the below happens, we
recommend that you have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure Telltale/ TPMS
Malfunction Indicator does not
illuminate for 3 seconds when the
Engine Start/Stop button is pressed
to the ON position or when the
engine is running.
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for
approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure Position
Telltale remains illuminated.
8-11
08
Low tire pressure
telltale
Low tire pressure position
telltale and tire pressure telltale
OSU2I049054
OSU2I049054
When the tire pressure monitoring
system warning indicators are
illuminated and a warning message
displayed on the cluster display, one
or more of your tires is significantly
under-inflated. The low tire pressure
position telltale light will indicate which
tire is significantly under-inflated by
illuminating the corresponding position
light.
If either telltale illuminates, immediately
reduce your speed, avoid hard cornering
and anticipate increased stopping
distances. You should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible. Inflate
the tires to the proper pressure as
indicated on the vehicle’s placard or tire
inflation pressure label located on the
driver’s side center pillar outer panel.
If you cannot reach a service station or
if the tire cannot hold the newly added
air, replace the low pressure tire with a
spare tire.
If you drive the vehicle for about 10
minutes at speeds above 25 km/h after
replacing the low pressure tire with the
spare tire, the following will happen:
The TPMS malfunction indicator may
blink for approximately 1 minute and
then remain continuously illuminated
because the TPMS sensor is not
mounted on the spare wheel.
NOTICE
In winter or cold weather, the low tire
pressure telltale may be illuminated if
the tire pressure was adjusted to the
recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not mean
your TPMS is malfunctioning because
the decreased temperature leads to a
proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle from a
warm area to a cold area or from a cold
area to a warm area, or the outside
temperature is greatly higher or lower,
you should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to the
recommended tire inflation pressure.
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure makes
the vehicle unstable and can contribute
to loss of vehicle control and increased
braking distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires
can cause the tires to overheat and fail.
8-12
Emergency Situations
TPMS (Tire Pressure
Monitoring System)
malfunction indicator
The TPMS malfunction indicator
will illuminate after it blinks for
approximately one minute when there
is a problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
We recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the TPMS,
the low tire pressure position telltale
will not be displayed even though the
vehicle has an under-inflated tire.
NOTICE
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator may
illuminate after blinking for one minute
if the vehicle is near electric power
supply cables or radio transmitters
such as police stations, government
and public offices, broadcasting
stations, military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow chains
are used or electronic devices such as
computers, chargers, remote starters,
navigation, etc. This may interfere with
normal operation of the TPMS.
Changing a tire with TPMS
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure and Position telltales will come
on. We recommend that the flat tire
be repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible or replace the
flat tire with the spare tire.
NOTICE
It is recommended that you do not
use a puncture-repairing agent not
approved by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer or the equivalent specified for
your vehicle to repair and/or inflate
a low pressure tire. Tire sealant not
approved by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer or the equivalent specified
for your vehicle may damage the tire
pressure sensor.
The spare tire (if equipped) does not
come with a tire pressure monitoring
sensor. When the low pressure tire or
the flat tire is replaced with the spare
tire, the Low Tire Pressure Telltale will
remain on. Also, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator will illuminate after blinking
for one minute if the vehicle is driven
at speed above 25 km/h (15.5 mph) for
approximately 10 minutes.
Once the original wheel equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure
and reinstalled on the vehicle, the
Low Tire Pressure Telltale and TPMS
Malfunction Indicator will go off within a
few minutes of driving.
8-13
08
If the indicators do not extinguish after a
few minutes we recommend to consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the tire
behind the valve stem (except for the
spare tire). You must use TPMS specific
wheels. It is recommended that you
always have your tires serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
You may not be able to identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking at it.
Always use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to measure. Please note that a tire
that is hot (from being driven) will have a
higher pressure measurement than a tire
that is cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has been
sitting for 3 hours and driven for less
than 1.6 km (1 mile) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure.
WARNING
The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors such as nails or road
debris.
If you feel any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off
the accelerator, apply the brakes
gradually and with light force, and
slowly move to a safe position off the
road.
WARNING
Protecting TPMS
Tampering with, modifying, or disabling
the Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) components may interfere
with the system’s ability to warn the
driver of low tire pressure conditions
and/or TPMS malfunctions. Tampering
with, modifying, or disabling the Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
components may void the warranty for
that portion of the vehicle.
8-14
Emergency Situations
WARNING
Changing a tire can be dangerous.
Follow the instructions in this section
when changing a tire to reduce the risk
of serious injury or death.
Jack and tools
OAI3073004L
OAI3073004L
M Jack
N Jack handle
O Wheel lug nut wrench
P Towing hook
The jack, jack handle, and wheel lug nut
wrench, towing hook are stored in the
luggage compartment.
The jack is provided for emergency tire
changing only.
Removing and storing the spare
tire
OBI3081009
OBI3081009
Turn the winged hold down bolt
counterclockwise to remove the spare
tire.
Store the spare tire in the same
compartment by turning the winged
hold down bolt clockwise.
To prevent the spare tire and tools from
“rattling” store them in their proper
location.
OBI3081010
OBI3081010
If it is hard to loosen the tire hold-down
wing bolt by hand, you can loosen it
easily using the wheel lug nut wrench.
1. Put the wrench (1) inside of the tire
hold-down wing bolt.
2. Turn the tire hold-down wing bolt
counterclockwise with the wrench.
IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE
8-15
08
Changing tires
WARNING
A vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack
causing serious injury or death to you
or those nearby. Take the following
safety precautions:
Do not get under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
NEVER attempt to change a tire in
the lane of traffic. ALWAYS move the
vehicle completely off the road on
level, firm ground away from traffic
before trying to change a tire. If you
cannot find a level, firm place off
the road, call a towing service for
assistance.
Be sure to use the jack provided with
the vehicle.
ALWAYS place the jack on the
designated jacking positions on the
vehicle and NEVER on the bumpers
or any other part of the vehicle for
jacking support.
Do not start or run the engine while
the vehicle is on the jack.
Do not allow anyone to remain in the
vehicle while it is on the jack.
Keep children away from the road
and the vehicle.
Follow these steps to change your
vehicle’s tire:
1. Park on a level and firm surface.
2. Move the shift lever into N (Neutral,
for Automated manual transmission
vehicle) or neutral (for manual
transmission vehicle), apply the
parking brake, and place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF position.
3. Press the hazard warning flasher
button.
4. Remove the wheel lug nut wrench,
jack, jack handle, and spare tire from
the vehicle.
5. Block both the front and rear of the
tire diagonally opposite of the tire you
are changing.
OAI3082102
OAI3082102
6. Loosen the wheel lug nuts
counterclockwise one turn each in
the order shown above, but do not
remove any lug nuts until the tire has
been raised off of the ground.
8-16
Emergency Situations
OAI3073009L
OAI3073009L
7. Place the jack at the designated
jacking position under the frame
closest to the tire you are changing.
The jacking positions are plates
welded to the frame with two tabs
and a raised dot. Never jack any other
position or part of the vehicle.
OAI3I071021
OAI3I071021
8. Insert the jack handle into the jack and
turn it clockwise, raising the vehicle
until the tire clears the ground. Before
removing the wheel lug nuts, make
sure the vehicle is stable on the jack.
9. Loosen the lug nuts with the wheel
lug nut wrench and remove them with
your fingers. Remove the wheel from
the studs and lay it flat on the ground
out of the way. Before removing the
wheel lug nuts, make sure the vehicle
is stable on the jack.
10. Install the spare tire onto the studs of
the hub.
11. Tighten the lug nuts with your fingers
onto the studs with the smaller end of
the lug nuts closest to the wheel.
12. Lower the vehicle to the ground
by turning the jack handle
counterclockwise.
OAI3082103
OAI3082103
13. Use the wheel lug nut wrench to
tighten the lug nuts in the order
shown. Double-check each lug nut
until they are tight. After changing
tires, we recommend that an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer tighten
the lug nuts to their proper torque as
soon as possible. The wheel lug nut
should be tightened to 11~13 kgf.m
(79~94 lbf.ft).
8-17
08
If you have a tire gauge, check the tire
pressure (see “Tires and Wheels” in
chapter 2 for tire pressure instructions.).
If the pressure is lower or higher than
recommended, drive slowly to the
nearest service station and adjust it to
the recommended pressure. Always
reinstall the valve cap after checking
or adjusting tire pressure. If the cap is
not replaced, air may leak from the tire.
If you lose a valve cap, buy another
and install it as soon as possible. After
changing tires, secure the flat tire and
return the jack and tools to their proper
storage locations.
i Information
Check the tire pressure as soon as possible
after installing a spare tire. Adjust it to
the recommended pressure.
NOTICE
Your vehicle has metric threads on
the studs and lug nuts. Make certain
during tire changing that the same
nuts that were removed are reinstalled.
If you have to replace your lug nuts
make sure they have metric threads to
avoid damaging the studs and ensure
the wheel is properly secured to the
hub. We recommend that you consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
If any of the equipment such as the jack,
lug nuts, studs, or other equipment is
damaged or in poor condition, do not
attempt to change the tire and call for
assistance.
Use of compact spare tires
(if equipped)
Compact spare tires are designed for
emergency use only. Drive carefully on
the compact spare tire and always follow
the safety precautions.
WARNING
To prevent compact spare tire failure
and loss of control possibly resulting in
an accident:
Use the compact spare tire only in an
emergency.
NEVER operate your vehicle over 80
km/h (50 mph).
Do not exceed the vehicle’s
maximum load rating or the load
carrying capacity shown on the
sidewall of the compact spare tire.
Do not use the compact spare tire
continuously. Repair or replace the
original tire as soon as possible to
avoid failure of the compact spare
tire.
8-18
Emergency Situations
When driving with the compact spare
tire mounted to your vehicle:
Check the tire pressure after installing
the compact spare tire. The compact
spare tire should be inflated to 420
kPa (60 psi).
Do not take this vehicle through an
automatic car wash while the compact
spare tire is installed.
Do not use the compact spare tire on
any other vehicle because this tire
has been designed especially for your
vehicle.
The compact spare tire’s tread life
is shorter than a regular tire. Inspect
your compact spare tire regularly and
replace worn compact spare tires with
the same size and design, mounted on
the same wheel.
Do not use more than one compact
spare tire at a time.
Do not tow a trailer while the compact
spare tire is installed.
i Information
When the original tire and wheel are
repaired and reinstalled on the vehicle,
the lug nut torque must be set correctly
to prevent wheel vibration. The correct
lug nut tightening torque is 11~13 kgf.m
(79~94 lbf.ft).
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the compact
spare tire and your vehicle:
Drive slowly enough for the road
conditions to avoid all hazards, such
as a potholes or debris.
Avoid driving over obstacles. The
compact spare tire diameter is
smaller than the diameter of a
conventional tire and reduces the
ground clearance approximately 25
mm (1 inch).
Do not use tire chains on the compact
spare tire. Because of the smaller
size, a tire chain will not fit properly.
Do not use the compact spare tire
on any other wheels, nor should
standard tires, snow tires, wheel
covers or trim rings be used with the
compact spare wheel.
Do not suddenly accelerate or
decelerate 0 l 40 km/h (0 l 25
mph) in any driving mode. It may
cause leakage of transfer oil.
8-19
08
1. Model Name
2. Maximum allowable load
3. When using the jack, set your parking
brake.
4. When using the jack, stop the engine.
5. Do not get under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
6. The designated locations under the
frame
7. When supporting the vehicle, the base
plate of jack must be vertical under
the lifting point.
8. Shift into Reverse gear on vehicles
with manual transmission or move the
shift lever to the N (Neutral) position
on vehicles with Automated manual
transmission
9. The jack should be used on firm level
ground.
10. Jack manufacture
11. Production date
12. Representative company and address
Jack label
Example
Example
• Type B
• Type A
OHYK065011
OHYK065011
OHYK065010
OHYK065010
The actual Jack label in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more detailed specifications, refer to the label attached to the jack.
8-20
Emergency Situations
EC Declaration of conformity for Jack
NX4I082001
NX4I082001
8-21
08
Towing service
OAI3082105
OAI3082105
[A] : Dollies
If emergency towing is necessary,
we recommend having it done by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a
commercial tow-truck service. Proper
lifting and towing procedures are
necessary to prevent damage to the
vehicle. The use of wheel dollies or
flatbed is recommended.
It is acceptable to tow the vehicle with
the rear wheels on the ground (without
dollies) and the front wheels off the
ground. If any of the loaded wheels or
suspension components are damaged or
the vehicle is being towed with the front
wheels on the ground, use a towing dolly
under the front wheels.
When being towed by a commercial tow
truck and wheel dollies are not used, the
front of the vehicle should always be
lifted, not the rear.
NOTICE
Do not tow the vehicle with 4 wheels
on the ground (such as dinghy towing
behind a motorhome or other motor
vehicle) as this can seriously damage
the Transmission.
OAI3079011
OAI3079011
Do not tow the vehicle with the front
wheels on the ground as this may
cause damage to the vehicle and the
Transmissions.
OAI3079013
OAI3079013
Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. Use a wheel lift or flatbed
equipment.
OAI3079012
OAI3079012
TOWING
8-22
Emergency Situations
When towing your vehicle in an
emergency without wheel dollies:
1. Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position.
2. Place the shift lever in N (Neutral).
3. Release the parking brake.
NOTICE
Failure to place the shift lever in N
(Neutral) when being towed with the
front wheels on the ground can cause
internal damage to the transmission
Removable towing hook
5 Door
5 Door
OAI3082108
OAI3082108
4 Door
4 Door
OAI3082107
OAI3082107
1. Open the tailgate/trunk, and remove
the towing hook from the tool case.
2. Remove the hole cover pressing the
lower part of the cover on the front
bumper.
3. Install the towing hook by turning it
clockwise into the hole until it is fully
secured.
4. Remove the towing hook and install
the cover after use.
8-23
08
Emergency towing
Front
Front
OAI3082106
OAI3082106
Rear
Rear
OAI3082104
OAI3082104
If towing is necessary, we recommend
you have it done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or a commercial tow
truck service.
If towing service is not available in
an emergency, your vehicle may be
temporarily towed using a cable or chain
secured to the emergency towing hook
at the front (or rear) of the vehicle.
Use extreme caution when towing the
vehicle with a cable or chain. A driver
must be in the vehicle to steer it and
operate the brakes.
Towing in this manner may be done
only on hard-surfaced roads for a short
distance and at low speeds.
Also, the wheels, axles, power train,
steering and brakes must all be in good
condition.
CAUTION
The driver must be in the vehicle for
steering and braking operations when
the vehicle is being towed. Passengers
other than the driver must not be in the
vehicle.
Always follow these emergency towing
precautions:
Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position so the steering wheel is not
locked.
Place the shift lever in N (Neutral).
Release the parking brake.
Depress the brake pedal with more
force than normal since you will have
reduced braking performance.
More steering effort will be required
because the power steering system
will be disabled.
Use a vehicle heavier than your own to
tow your vehicle.
The drivers of both vehicles should
communicate with each other
frequently.
Before emergency towing, check that
the hook is not broken or damaged.
Fasten the towing cable or chain
securely to the hook.
Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady and
even force.
8-24
Emergency Situations
OAI3079017
OAI3079017
Use a towing cable or chain less than 5
m (16 feet) long. Attach a white or red
cloth (about 30 cm (12 inches) wide)
in the middle of the cable or chain for
easy visibility.
Drive carefully so the towing cable or
chain remains tight during towing.
Before towing, check the Automated
manual transmission for fluid leaks
under your vehicle. If the Automated
manual transmission fluid is leaking,
flatbed equipment or a towing dolly
must be used.
NOTICE
Accelerate or decelerate the vehicle
in a slow and gradual manner while
maintaining tension on the tow rope
or chain to start or drive the vehicle,
otherwise tow hooks and the vehicle
may be damaged.
NOTICE
To avoid damage to your vehicle and
vehicle components when towing:
Always pull straight ahead when
using the towing hooks. Do not pull
from the side or at a vertical angle.
Do not use the towing hooks to pull
a vehicle out of mud, sand or other
conditions from which the vehicle
cannot be driven out under its own
power.
The vehicle should be towed at a
speed of 25 km/h (15 mph) or less
within the distance of 20 km (12
miles). (for Manual transmission/
Automated manual transmission
vehicle)
8-25
08
Your vehicle is equipped with
emergency commodities to help you
respond to emergency situation.
First aid kit
Supplies for use in giving first aid such
as bandage and adhesive tape, etc., are
provided.
Triangle reflector
Place the triangle reflector on the road
to warn oncoming vehicles during
emergencies, such as when the vehicle
is parked by the roadside due to
problems.
(0(5*(1&<&2002',7<ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
8-26
Emergency Situations
Engine compartment ......................................................................................9-4
Maintenance services .....................................................................................9-5
Owner’s responsibility ..............................................................................................9-5
Owner maintenance precautions ...........................................................................9-5
Owner maintenance ....................................................................................... 9-7
Owner maintenance schedule ..................................................................................9-7
Scheduled maintenance service ...................................................................9-9
Normal maintenance schedule (gasoline engine) .................................................9-10
Maintenance under severe usage conditions (gasoline engine) ..........................9-14
Normal maintenance schedule - CNG Components .............................................9-16
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items ........................................... 9-18
Engine oil .......................................................................................................9-22
Checking the engine oil level .................................................................................9-22
Changing the engine oil and filter .......................................................................... 9-23
Engine coolant ..............................................................................................9-25
Checking the coolant level ..................................................................................... 9-25
Recommended engine coolant ...............................................................................9-27
Changing the coolant ..............................................................................................9-27
Brake/clutch fluid .........................................................................................9-28
Checking the brake/clutch fluid level ....................................................................9-28
Washer fluid ..................................................................................................9-30
Checking the washer fluid level .............................................................................9-30
Parking brake .................................................................................................9-31
Checking the parking brake ....................................................................................9-31
Air cleaner .....................................................................................................9-32
Filter replacement ................................................................................................... 9-32
Climate control air filter................................................................................9-34
Filter inspection .......................................................................................................9-34
9. Maintenance
9
9
Filter replacement ...................................................................................................9-34
Wiper blades .................................................................................................9-36
Blade inspection ......................................................................................................9-36
Blade replacement ..................................................................................................9-36
Battery ...........................................................................................................9-39
For best battery service ..........................................................................................9-39
Battery capacity label .............................................................................................9-41
Battery recharging ..................................................................................................9-42
Reset items ..............................................................................................................9-42
Battery replacement ...............................................................................................9-42
Tires and wheels ..........................................................................................9-43
Tire care ...................................................................................................................9-43
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures .......................................................9-43
Checking tire inflation pressure .............................................................................9-44
Tire rotation ............................................................................................................9-45
Wheel alignment and tire balance .........................................................................9-46
Tire replacement ..................................................................................................... 9-47
Wheel replacement ................................................................................................9-48
Tire traction .............................................................................................................9-48
Tire maintenance ....................................................................................................9-49
Tire sidewall labeling ...............................................................................................9-49
Low aspect ratio tire................................................................................................9-52
Fuses ..............................................................................................................9-54
Instrument panel fuse replacement ......................................................................9-55
Engine compartment panel fuse replacement ..................................................... 9-57
9
Fuse/relay panel description ..................................................................................9-58
Light bulbs .....................................................................................................9-69
Headlight, Parking (Position) Light, Turn Signal Light, Daytime Running Light
bulb replacement ....................................................................................................9-70
Side repeater light replacement .............................................................................9-73
Rear combination light bulb replacement .............................................................9-74
High mounted stop light ..........................................................................................9-77
License plate light bulb replacement ....................................................................9-77
Interior light bulb replacement ..............................................................................9-78
Appearance care ...........................................................................................9-79
Exterior care ............................................................................................................9-79
Interior care .............................................................................................................9-85
Emission control system.............................................................................. 9-88
Crankcase emission control system ......................................................................9-88
Evaporative emission control system ....................................................................9-88
Exhaust emission control system ...........................................................................9-89
9. Maintenance
9-4
Maintenance
1. Engine coolant reservoir
2. Engine oil filler cap
3. Brake/clutch* fluid reservoir
4. Air cleaner
5. Fuse box
6. Battery
7. Windshield washer fluid reservoir
8. Radiator cap
9. Engine oil dipstick
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
Gasoline Engine (G 1.2 MPI)
Gasoline Engine (G 1.2 MPI)
The actual engine room in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAI3089001
OAI3089001
9-5
09
You should exercise the utmost care
to prevent damage to your vehicle and
injury to yourself whenever performing
any maintenance or inspection
procedures. Inadequate, incomplete
or insufficient servicing may result in
operational problems with your vehicle
that could lead to vehicle damage, an
accident, or personal injury.
Owner’s responsibility
i Information
Maintenance Service and Record
Retention are the owner’s responsibility.
We recommend in general that you have
your vehicle serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
You should retain documents that show
proper maintenance has been performed
on your vehicle in accordance with
the scheduled maintenance service
charts shown on the following pages.
You need this information to establish
your compliance with the servicing
and maintenance requirements of your
vehicle warranties.
Detailed warranty information is
provided in your Service Passport.
Repairs and adjustments required as
a result of improper maintenance or a
lack of required maintenance are not
covered when your vehicle is covered by
warranty.
Owner maintenance
precautions
Improper or incomplete service may
result in problems. This chapter gives
instructions only for the maintenance
items that are easy to perform.
i Information
Improper owner maintenance during the
warranty period may affect warranty
coverage. For details, read the separate
Service Passport provided with the
vehicle. If you’re unsure about any
servicing or maintenance procedure, we
recommend that the system be serviced by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Maintenance work
Performing maintenance work on a
vehicle can be dangerous. You can
be seriously injured while performing
some maintenance procedures.
If you lack sufficient knowledge
and experience or the proper tools
and equipment to do the work, we
recommend that the system be
serviced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Working under the hood with the
engine running is dangerous. It
becomes even more dangerous when
you wear jewelry or loose clothing.
These can become entangled in
moving parts and result in injury.
Therefore, if you must run the engine
while working under the hood, make
certain that you remove all jewelry
(especially rings, bracelets, watches,
and necklaces) and all neckties,
scarves, and similar loose clothing
before getting near the engine or
cooling fans.
MAINTENANCE SERVICES
9-6
Maintenance
WARNING
Do not leave gloves, rags or any other
combustible material in the engine
compartment. Doing so may cause a
heat-induced fire.
NOTICE
Do not put heavy objects or apply
excessive force on top of the engine
cover (if equipped) or fuel related
parts.
When you inspect the fuel system
(fuel lines and fuel injection devices),
we recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not drive long time with the
engine cover (if equipped) removed.
When checking the engine room, do
not go near fire. Fuel, washer fluid,
etc., are flammable oils that may
cause fire.
Before touching the battery, ignition
cables and electrical wiring, you
should disconnect the battery “-”
terminal. Otherwise, you may get
an electric shock from the electric
current.
When you remove the interior trim
cover with a flat head (-) driver, be
careful not to damage the cover.
Be careful when you replace and
clean bulbs to avoid burns or
electrical shock.
9-7
09
The following lists are vehicle checks
and inspections that should be
performed at the frequencies indicated
to help ensure safe, dependable
operation of your vehicle.
Any adverse conditions should be
brought to the attention of your dealer
as soon as possible.
These Owner Maintenance Checks are
generally not covered by warranties and
you may be charged for labor, parts and
lubricants used.
Owner maintenance schedule
When you stop for fuel:
Check the coolant level in coolant
reservoir.
Check the windshield washer fluid
level.
Look for low or under-inflated tires.
Check the radiator and condenser.
Check if the front of the radiator and
condenser are clean and not blocked
with leaves, dirt or insects etc.
If any of the above parts are extremely
dirty or you are not sure of their
condition, we recommend that you
contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
Be careful when checking your engine
coolant level if the engine is hot.
Scalding hot coolant and steam may
blow out under pressure. This could
cause burns or other serious injury.
OWNER MAINTENANCE
9-8
Maintenance
While operating your vehicle:
Note any changes in the sound of the
exhaust or any smell of exhaust fumes
in the vehicle.
Check for vibrations in the steering
wheel. Notice any increased steering
effort or looseness in the steering
wheel, or change in its straight-ahead
position.
Notice if your vehicle constantly turns
slightly or “pulls” to one side when
traveling on smooth, level road.
When stopping, listen and check for
unusual sounds, pulling to one side,
increased brake pedal travel or “hard-
to-push” brake pedal.
If any slipping or changes in the
operation of your transmission occurs,
check the transmission fluid level.
Check the parking brake.
Check for fluid leaks under your
vehicle (water dripping from the air
conditioning system during or after
use is normal).
At least monthly:
Check the coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir.
Check the operation of all exterior
lights, including the stoplights, turn
signals and hazard warning flashers.
Check the inflation pressures of all
tires including the spare for tires that
are worn, show uneven wear, or are
damaged.
Check for loose wheel lug nuts.
At least twice a year
(for example, every Spring and Fall):
Check the radiator, heater and air
conditioning hoses for leaks or
damage.
Check the windshield washer spray
and wiper operation. Clean wiper
blades with clean cloth dampened
with washer fluid.
Check the headlight alignment.
Check the muffler, exhaust pipes,
shields and clamps.
Check the lap/shoulder belts for wear
and function.
At least once a year:
Clean the body and door drain holes.
Lubricate the door hinges and checks,
and hood hinges.
Lubricate the door and hood locks and
latches.
Lubricate the door rubber
weatherstrips.
Check the air conditioning system.
Inspect and lubricate Automated
manual transmission linkage and
controls.
Clean the battery and terminals.
Check the brake/clutch fluid level.
9-9
09
*1. As it is normal for engine oil to be consumed during driving, the amount of engine
oil should be checked regularly. Operating with an insufficient amount of oil can
damage the engine, and such damage is not covered by warranty.
*2. Check the engine oil level and leak every 500km(350miles) or before starting a long
trip.
*3. The engine oil change interval for normal operating conditions is based on the
use of the recommended engine specification. If the recommended engine
oil specification is not used, then replace the engine oil according to the
maintenance schedule under severe operating conditions.
*4. Inspect for excessive valve noiseand/or engine vibration and adjust if necessary.
We recommend that an authorized HYUNDAI dealer should perform the operation.
*5. When adding coolant, use only deionized water or soft water for your vehicle and
never mix hard water in the coolant filled at the factory. An improper coolant
mixture can result in serious malfunction or engine damage.
*6. Transmission fluid and differential oil should be changed anytime the vehicle has
been submerged in water.
*7. This maintenance schedule depends on fuel quality. It is applicable only when
using a qualified fuel <”EN228 or equivalent”>. If there are some important safety
matters like fuel flow restriction, surging, loss of power, hard starting problem
etc., replace the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule. We
recommend that you consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for details.
*8. Inspect drive belt tensioner, idler & alternator pulley, starter & all chassis electrical
items. Correct or replace if necessary.For your convenience, it can be replaced
prior to it’s interval when you do maintenance of other items.
*9. For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it’s interval when you do
maintenance of other items.
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICE
9-10
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE ITEM
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Years -12345678
Months 2 1224364860728496
Kmsx1,000 1.51020304050607080
ENGINE BAY
Engine oil & filter*1 *2 *3IRRRRRRRR
Drive belt - IIIIIIII
Air Filter C C C R C C R C C
Battery condition & specific gravity I IIIIIIII
Spark Plugs*9Replace at every 60,000 kms
Valve clearance*4Inspect at every 90,000 kms or 108 months
Vaccum Hose - - - I - - I - I
Idler / damper pulley/Adj. Bolt Inspect when replacing the drive belt or timing belt/chain
Brake/Clutch fluid Inspect at every service; Replace at every 40,000 km or 36 months
Engine Coolant (topup & specify gravity)*5Inspect at every service;
Replace first at 1,00,000 Km or 60 months; then at every 40,000 Km or 24 months
Manual transaxle fluid*6No check, No service required
Automated manual Transmission fluid
(if equipped)*6Inspect at every 60,000 kms or 48 months
I : Inspect and if necessary adjust,top-up, clean or replace C : Clean and Replace if necessary R : Replace
NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE - PETROL ENGINE (CONT.)
9-11
09
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE ITEM
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Years -12345678
Months 2 1224364860728496
Kmsx1,000 1.51020304050607080
VEHICLE ON FLOOR
Wiper (wiper blade , washer fluid) I I IIIIIII
Brake/Clutch (Pedal free play/Pipes/Hoses/
Connectors) IIIIIIIII
Fuel filler cap - I IIIIIII
Climate control air filter I C R C R C R C R
Check AC system (refrigerant/Compressor) I I IIIIIII
Cooling system (water pump,hoses) & leakage I I IIIIIII
VEHICLE ON LIFT
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots I I IIIIIII
Exhaust system I IIIIIII
Fuel filter*7---I--R--
Front & rear suspension (linkages & ball joints) ------I-I
NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE - PETROL ENGINE (CONT.)
I : Inspect and if necessary adjust,top-up, clean or replace C : Clean and Replace if necessary R : Replace
9-12
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE ITEM
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Years -12345678
Months 2 1224364860728496
Kmsx1,000 1.51020304050607080
Tyre Pressure,condition & rotation - I,TR I,TR I,TR I,TR I,TR I,TR I,TR I,TR
Fuel lines, hoses and connections - IIIIIIII
Driveshafts & boots IIIIIIIII
Fluid leakages IIIIIIIII
Front and rear wheel bearings & bushes Inspect and if necessary, adjust, clean or replace
Parking brake (disc/drum ,shoe & operation) - C CCCCCCC
Wheel Alignment & Balancing - Inspect and if necessary, adjust
FINAL CHECKS
Bolt and nuts on chasis and body I IIIIIIII
Lubricate locks & hinges I L LLLLLLL
Check all electrical systems (Drive belts ,alterna-
tor)*8--IIIIIII
Warning lights operation & GDS system check IIIIIIIII
Ext & int. lights, horn & gauges IIIIIIIII
NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE - PETROL ENGINE (CONT.)
C : Clean and Replace if necessary R : Replace
I : Inspect and if necessary adjust,top-up, clean or replace
9-13
09
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE ITEM
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Years -12345678
Months 2 1224364860728496
Kmsx1,000 1.51020304050607080
Power window IIIIIIIII
Sunroof operation (if equipped) - C CCCCCCC
All seat belt operation IIIIIIIII
Road test - - - I ----I
NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE - PETROL ENGINE (CONT.)
I : Inspect and if necessary adjust,top-up, clean or replace C : Clean and Replace if necessary R : Replace
9-14
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE UNDER SEVERE USAGE CONDITIONS (PETROL ENGINE)
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars mainly used under severe driving conditions.
Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals.
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace R : Replace or change
Maintenance item Maintenance
operation Maintenance intervals Driving
condition
Engine oil and engine oil filter R Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or 6 months A, B, C, D, E, F, G,
H, I, J, K, L
Air cleaner filter R Replace more frequently
depending on the condition C, E
Spark plugs R Replace more frequently
depending on the condition A, B, F, G,
H, I, K
Manual transmission fluid (if equipped) R Every 120,000 km (80,000 miles) C, D, E, F,
G, H, I, J
Automated manual transmission fluid (if euqipped) R Every 120,000 km (80,000 miles) C, D, E, F,
G, H, I, J
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots I Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition C, D, E, F, G
Front suspension ball joints I Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition C, D, E, F, G
9-15
09
Maintenance item Maintenance
operation Maintenance intervals Driving
condition
Disc brakes and pads, calipers and rotors I Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition C, D, E, G, H
Drum brakes and linings (if equipped) I Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition C, D, E, G, H
Parking brake I Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition C, D, G, H
Driveshaft and boots I Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition C, D, E, F,
G, H, I, J
Climate control air filter R Replace more frequently
depending on the condition C, E
Severe driving conditions
A : Repeated short distance driving
B : Extensive idling
C : Driving in dusty, rough roads
D : Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in
very cold weather
E : Driving in the condition of inflowing sand or dust into engine
F : Driving in heavy traffic area
G : Driving in mountainous areas
H : Towing a trailer
I : Driving for patrol car, taxi, commercial car or vehicle towing
J : Driving over 170 km/h (106 mile/h)
9-16
Maintenance
NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE - CNG COMPONENTS
MAINTENANCE INTERVALS
Km x 1,000
MAINTENANCE ITEM 1.5 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
CNG fuel system compartments I I I I I I I I I
Vaporizer assembly *1Tar drain plug *2Drain at Every 20,000 km
Diaphragm kit ‘o’ rings Replace at every 80,000 km.
Replacement mandatory on every dissassembly.
CNG solenoid assembly CNG filter I C C R C C R C C
Solenoid valve I I I C I I C I I
CNG fuel line and hose for damage, leakage I I I I I I I I I
CNG gas fuel filter (Gaseous fuel filter) I I I R I I R I I
CNG gas injector Replace at every 80,000 km.
CNG fuel tank *1 *3IIIIIIIII
Spark plug Replace at every 160,000 km.
NOTE : Time interval between any two consecutive services should not exceed more than six months.
I : Inspect
R : Replace
C : Clean (After Inspection Adjust, Repair, Clean or Replace if necessary)
9-17
09
*1 : Check with soapy water for leakage at pipe assembly and major parts.
1) Vaporizer and inlet/outlet connection
2) Injector/fuel delivery pipe assembly and inlet/outlet connection
3) Fuel hose connection in the engine room
4) Fuel feed line
5) Gaseous fuel filter body and inlet/outlet connection
6) Multi valve body and feed/return connection
7) CNG filling inlet
8) Emergency valve body and inlet/outlet connection
9) Bombe assembly
10) Fuel gauge
11) Refuel valve body and connection
*2 : It is recommanded to visit the nearest HYUNDAI Authorised Workshop for draining Tar at every 15,000 km.
*3 : CNG Fuel Tank has to be tested by Goverment approved agency at every 5 years.
9-18
Maintenance
Engine oil and filter
The engine oil and filter should be
changed at the intervals specified in
the maintenance schedule. If the car
is being driven in severe conditions,
more frequent oil and filter changes are
required.
Drive belts
Inspect all drive belts for evidence
of cuts, cracks, excessive wear or oil
saturation and replace if necessary.
Drive belts should be checked
periodically for proper tension and
adjusted as necessary.
NOTICE
When you are inspecting the belt, place
the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF or
ACC position.
Fuel filter
A clogged filter can limit the speed
at which the vehicle may be driven,
damage the emission system and cause
multiple issues such as hard starting.
If an excessive amount of foreign
matter accumulates in the fuel tank, the
filter may require replacement more
frequently.
After installing a new filter, run the
engine for several minutes, and check
for leaks at the connections.
We recommend that the fuel filter be
replaced by an authoized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections
Check the fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
We recommend that the fuel lines, fuel
hoses and connections be replaced by
an authoized HYUNDAI dealer.
Vapor hose and fuel filler cap
The vapor hose and fuel filler cap should
be inspected at those intervals specified
in the maintenance schedule. Make sure
that a new vapor hose or fuel filler cap is
correctly replaced.
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS
9-19
09
Vacuum crankcase ventilation
hoses (if equipped)
Inspect the surface of hoses for
evidence of heat and/or mechanical
damage. Hard and brittle rubber,
cracking, tears, cuts, abrasions, and
excessive swelling indicate deterioration.
Particular attention should be paid to
examine those hose surfaces nearest to
high heat sources, such as the exhaust
manifold.
Inspect the hose routing to assure that
the hoses do not come in contact with
any heat source, sharp edges or moving
component which might cause heat
damage or mechanical wear. Inspect
all hose connections, such as clamps
and couplings, to make sure they are
secure, and that no leaks are present.
Hoses should be replaced immediately if
there is any evidence of deterioration or
damage.
Air cleaner filter
We recommend that the air cleaner filter
be replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Spark plugs
Make sure to install new spark plugs of
the correct heat range.
When assembling parts, be sure to
wipe out foreign substances inside
and outside of the boot bottom of the
ignition coil and the insulator of the
spark plug with a soft cloth to prevent
contamination of the spark plug
insulator.
WARNING
Do not disconnect and inspect spark
plugs when the engine is hot. You may
burn yourself.
Cooling system
Check cooling system components, such
as radiator, coolant reservoir, hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Coolant
The coolant should be changed at the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
Manual transmission fluid
(if equipped)
Inspect the manual transmission fluid
according to the maintenance schedule.
Automated manual transmission
fluid (if equipped)
Inspect the Automated manual
transmission fluid according to the
maintenance schedule.
9-20
Maintenance
NOTICE
The use of non-specified fluid
(even marked as compatible with
genuine) could result in shift quality
deterioration and vibrations,
eventually, the transmission failure.
Use only specified Automated
manual transmission fluid. (Refer to
the “Recommended lubricants and
capacities” in chapter 2.)
Brake hoses and lines
Visually check for proper installation,
chafing, cracks, deterioration and any
leakage. Replace any deteriorated or
damaged parts immediately.
Brake/clutch fluid (if equipped)
Check brake/clutch fluid level in the
brake fluid reservoir. The level should
be between “MIN” (Minimum) and
“MAX” (Maximum) marks on the side of
the reservoir. Use only hydraulic brake/
clutch fluid conforming to DOT 4.
Parking brake
Inspect the parking brake system
including the parking brake lever and
cables.
Rear brake drums and linings
(if equipped)
Check the rear brake drums and linings
for scoring, burning, leaking fluid,
broken parts, and excessive wear.
Brake pads, calipers and discs
Check the pads for excessive wear, discs
for run out and wear, and calipers for
fluid leakage.
Suspension mounting bolts
Check the suspension connections for
looseness or damage. Retighten to the
specified torque.
9-21
09
Steering gear box, linkage &
boots/lower arm ball joint
With the vehicle stopped and engine
off, check for excessive free-play in the
steering wheel.
Check the linkage for bends or damage.
Check the dust boots and ball joints
for deterioration, cracks, or damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Drive shafts and boots
Check the drive shafts, boots and
clamps for cracks, deterioration, or
damage. Replace any damaged parts
and, if necessary, repack the grease.
Air conditioning refrigerant
(if equipped)
Check the air conditioning lines and
connections for leakage and damage.
9-22
Maintenance
ENGINE OIL
Engine oil is used for lubricating,
cooling, and operating various hydraulic
components in the engine. Engine oil
consumption while driving is normal,
and it is necessary to check and refill the
engine oil regularly. Also, check and refill
the oil level within the recommended
maintenance schedule to prevent
deterioration of oil performance.
Check the engine oil following the below
procedure.
Checking the engine oil level
1. Follow all of the oil manufacturer’s
precautions.
2. Be sure the vehicle is on the lovel
ground in P (Park) with the parking
brake set. if possible, block the
wheels.
3. Turn the engine on and warm
the engine up until the coolant
temperature reaches a constant
normal temperature.
4. Turn the engine off, remove the oil
filler cap and pull the dipstick out.
Wait for 15 minutes for the oil to return
to the oil pan.
5. Wipe the dipstick clean and re-insert it
fully.
OAI3089002
OAI3089002
6. Pull the dipstick out again and check
the level.
OAI3089003
OAI3089003
7. If the oil level is below L, add enough
oil to bring the level to F (Full). Do not
overfill.
Use a funnel to help prevent oil from
being spilled on engine components.
Use only the specified engine oil. (Refer
to the “Recommended lubricants and
capacities” in chapter 2.)
WARNING
Radiator hoseBe very careful not to
touch the radiator hose when checking
or adding the engine oil as it may be
hot enough to burn you.
9-23
09
NOTICE
To prevent damage to you engine:
Do not spill engine oil when adding or
changing engine oil. Wipe off spilled
oil immediately.
The engine oil consumption may
increase while you break in a new
vehicle and it will be stabilized after
driving 6,000 km (4,000 miles).
The engine oil consumption can be
affected by driving habits, climate
conditions, traffic conditions,
oil quality, etc. Therefore, it is
recommended that you inspect the
engine oil level regularly and refill it if
necessary.
Changing the engine oil and
filter
We recommend that the engine oil
and filter be replaced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If the maintenance schedule to
replace engine oil is exceeded,
the engine oil performance may
deteriorate, and the engine condition
may be affected. Therefore, replace
the engine oil according to the
maintenance schedule.
To keep the engine in optimal
condition, use the recommended
engine oil and filter. If the
recommended engine oil and filter are
not used replace it according to the
maintenance schedule under severe
usage conditions.
The purpose of the maintenance
schedule for engine oil replacement
is to prevent oil deterioration and it is
irrelevant to oil consumption. Check
and refill engine oil regularly.
9-24
Maintenance
CAUTION
The engine oil is very hot immediately
after the vehicle has been driven and
can cause burns during replacement.
Replace the engine oil after the engine
oil has cooled down.
WARNING
Used engine oil may cause skin
irritation or cancer if left in contact
with the skin for prolonged periods
of time. Used engine oil contains
chemicals that have caused cancer in
laboratory animals. Always protect your
skin by washing your hands thoroughly
with soap and warm water as soon as
possible after handling used oil.
9-25
09
The high-pressure cooling system
has a reservoir filled with year-round
antifreeze coolant. The reservoir is filled
at the factory.
Check the antifreeze protection and
coolant level at least once a year, at the
beginning of the winter season, and
before traveling to a colder climate.
NOTICE
Do not drive with no engine coolant.
It may cause water pump failure and
engine seizure, etc.
When the engine overheats from
low engine coolant, suddenly adding
engine coolant may cause cracks
in the engine. To prevent damage,
add engine coolant slowly in small
quantities.
Checking the coolant level
OAI3089004I
OAI3089004I
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen or
deteriorated hoses.
The coolant level should be filled
between F (Full) and L (Low) marked on
the side of the coolant reservoir when
the engine is cool.
If the coolant level is low, add enough
distilled (deionized) water.
Bring the level to F (Full), but do
not overfill. If frequent additions are
required, we recommend that the
system be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ENGINE COOLANT
9-26
Maintenance
OAI3089005
OAI3089005
WARNING
Removing radiator cap
Never attempt to remove the radiator
cap while the engine is operating or
hot. Doing so might lead to cooling
system and engine damage and could
result in serious personal injury from
escaping hot coolant or steam.
Turn the engine off and wait until it
cools down. Use extreme care when
removing the radiator cap. Wrap
a thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the first
stop. Step back while the pressure
is released from the cooling system.
When you are sure all the pressure
has been released, press down on the
cap, using a thick towel, and continue
turning counterclockwise to remove
it.
Even if the engine is not operating,
do not remove the radiator cap
or the drain plug while the engine
and radiator are hot. Hot coolant
and steam may still blow out under
pressure, causing serious injury.
WARNING
The electric motor (cooling
fan) is controlled by engine
coolant temperature,
refrigerant pressure and
vehicle speed. It may
sometimes operate even when the
engine is not running. Use extreme
caution when working near the blades
of the cooling fan so that you are not
injured by a rotating fan blades. As the
engine coolant temperature decreases,
the electric motor will automatically
shut off. This is a normal condition.
9-27
09
Recommended engine coolant
Use only soft (distilled) water in the
coolant mixture.
The engine in your vehicle has
aluminum engine parts and must be
protected by an ethylene-glycol-based
coolant to prevent corrosion and
freezing.
DO NOT USE alcohol or methanol
coolant or mix them with the specified
coolant.
Do not use a solution that contains
more than 60% antifreeze or less than
35% antifreeze, which would reduce
the effectiveness of the solution.
For mixture percentage, refer to the
following table.
Ambient
Temperature
Mixture Percentage
(volume)
Antifreeze Water
-15 °C (5 °F) 35 65
-25 °C (-13 °F) 40 60
-35 °C (-31 °F) 50 50
-45 °C (-49 °F) 60 40
WARNING
Radiator cap
Do not remove the radiator
cap when the engine and
radiator are hot. Scalding
hot coolant and steam
may blow out under pressure causing
serious injury.
Changing the coolant
We recommend that the coolant be
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
NOTICE
Put a thick cloth or fabric around the
radiator cap before refilling the coolant
in order to prevent the coolant from
overflowing into engine parts such as
the alternator.
WARNING
Coolant
Do not use radiator coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir.
Radiator coolant can severely
obscure visibility when sprayed on
the windshield and may cause loss
of vehicle control or damage to paint
and body trim.
9-28
Maintenance
Checking the brake/clutch fluid
level
OAI3089006
OAI3089006
Check the fluid level in the reservoir
periodically. The fluid level should be
between MAX (Maximum) and MIN
(Minimum) marks on the side of the
reservoir.
Before removing the reservoir cap and
adding the brake/clutch fluid, clean
the area around the reservoir cap
thoroughly to prevent brake/clutch fluid
contamination. If the level is low, add
the fluid to the MAX (Maximum) level.
The level will fall with accumulated
mileage. This is a normal condition
associated with the wear of the brake
linings and/or clutch disc (if equipped).
If the fluid level is excessively low, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Use only the specified brake/clutch fluid.
(Refer to “Recommended lubricants or
capacities” in chapter 2.)
Never mix different types of fluid.
WARNING
Loss of brake fluid
In the event the brake system
requires frequent additions of fluid,
we recommend that the system be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
i Information
Before removing the brake/clutch filter
cap, read the warning on the cap.
WARNING
Clean the filler cap before removing.
Use only DOT 4 brake/clutch fluid from
a sealed container.
%5$.(&/87&+ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ)/8,'
9-29
09
WARNING
Brake/clutch fluid
When changing and adding the brake/
clutch fluid, handle it carefully. Do not
let it come in contact with your eyes. If
the brake/clutch fluid come in contact
with your eyes, immediately flush them
with a large quantity of fresh tap water.
Have your eyes examined by a doctor
as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Do not allow the brake/clutch fluid to
contact the vehicle’s body paint, as it
will result in paint damage.
NEVER use brake/clutch fluid which
have been exposed to open air for an
extended time, as its quality cannot
be guaranteed. It should be properly
disposed.
Don’t put in the wrong kind of fluid.
A few drops of mineral-based oil
in your brake/clutch system can
damage brake/clutch system parts.
9-30
Maintenance
Checking the washer fluid level
OAI3089007
OAI3089007
Check the fluid level in the washer fluid
reservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plain
water may be used if washer fluid is not
available.
However, use washer solvent with
antifreeze characteristics in cold
climates to prevent freezing.
WARNING
Coolant
Do not use radiator coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir.
Radiator coolant can severely
obscure visibility when sprayed on
the windshield and may cause loss
of vehicle control or damage to the
paint and body trim.
Windshield washer fluid agents
contain some amounts of alcohol
and can be flammable under certain
circumstances. Do not allow sparks
or flame come in contact with the
washer fluid or the washer fluid
reservoir. Damage to the vehicle or
occupants could occur.
Windshield washer fluid is poisonous
to humans and animals. Do not drink
and avoid coming in contact with
the windshield washer fluid. Serious
injury or death could occur.
WASHER FLUID
9-31
09
Checking the parking brake
OAI3069006
OAI3069006
Check the stroke of the parking brake by
counting the number of “clicks’’ heard
while fully applying it from the released
position.
Also, the parking brake alone should
securely hold the vehicle on a fairly
steep grade. If the stroke is more or less
than specified, we recommend that the
system be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Stroke : 5~7 “clicks’’ at a force of 20 kg
(44 lbs, 196 N).
PARKING BRAKE
9-32
Maintenance
AIR CLEANER
Filter replacement
The air cleaner filter can be cleaned for
inspection using compressed air.
Do not attempt to wash or to rinse it.
Otherwise, water will damage the filter.
If soiled, the air cleaner filter must be
replaced.
OAI3089040
OAI3089040
OAI3089041
OAI3089041
1. Loosen the hose clamp and remove
hose from cleaner.
2. Open the cleaner cover by openingthe
clips.
OAH2078017
OAH2078017
3. Remove the used filter and wipe
the inside of the air cleaner housing
carefully not to remain dusts incover
housing.
4. Place the new filter with clean hands
and ensure the rubber gasket is not
taken off.
5. Reassemble in the reverse order of
removal.
9-33
09
i Information
If the vehicle is operated in extremely
dusty or sandy areas, replace the element
more often than the usual recommended
intervals (refer to “Maintenance Under
Severe Usage Conditions” in this chapter).
NOTICE
Do not drive with the air cleaner filter
removed. This will result in excessive
engine wear.
When removing the air cleaner filter
after loosening the hose be careful
that dust or dirt does not enter the
air intake hose or engine side, or else
damage may result.
Use HYUNDAI genuine parts or the
equivalent specified for your vehicle.
Use of non-genuine parts could
damage the air flow sensor.
9-34
Maintenance
Filter inspection
If the vehicle is operated in the severely
air-polluted cities or on dusty rough
roads for a long period, it should be
inspected more frequently and replaced
earlier. When you, the owner, replace
the climate control air filter, replace it
performing the following procedure,
and be careful to avoid damaging other
components.
Replace the filter according to the
maintenance Schedule.
Filter replacement
OAI3059035
OAI3059035
1. Open the glove box.
OAI3089009
OAI3089009
2. Push in both sides of the glove box as
shown. This will ensure that the glove
box stopper pins will get released
from its holding location allowing the
glove box to hang.
OAH2078021
OAH2078021
3. Remove the climate control air filter
cover.
CLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER
9-35
09
ODH073012
ODH073012
4. Clean the climate control air filter.
5. Reassemble in the reverse order of
disassembly.
NOTICE
Install a new climate control air filter
in the correct direction with the arrow
symbol () facing downwards.
Otherwise, the climate control effects
may decrease, possibly with a noise.
9-36
Maintenance
Blade inspection
1JBA5122
1JBA5122
i Information
Commercial hot waxes applied by
automatic car washes have been known to
make the windshield difficult to clean.
Contamination of either the windshield
or the wiper blades with foreign matter
can reduce the effectiveness of the
windshield wipers. Common sources
of contamination are insects, tree sap,
and hot wax treatments used by some
commercial car washes. If the blades
are not wiping properly, clean both the
window and the blades with a good
cleaner or mild detergent, and rinse
thoroughly with clean water.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper blades,
do not use gasoline, kerosene, paint
thinner, or other solvents on or near
them.
Blade replacement
When the wipers no longer clean
adequately, the blades may be worn or
cracked, and require replacement.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
or other components, do not attempt
to move the wipers manually.
NOTICE
The use of a non-specified wiper blade
could result in wiper malfunction and
failure.
WIPER BLADES
9-37
09
Front windshield wiper blade
OLMB073020
OLMB073020
1. Raise the wiper arm and turn the wiper
blade assembly to expose the plastic
locking clip.
NOTICE
Do not allow the wiper arm to fall
against the windshield, since it may
chip or crack the windshield.
OLMB073021
OLMB073021
OLMB073022
OLMB073022
2. Compress the clip and slide the blade
assembly downward.
3. Lift it off the arm.
4. Install the blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
9-38
Maintenance
Rear window wiper blade
(if equipped)
OLMB073023
OLMB073023
1. Raise the wiper arm and rotate the
wiper blade assembly (1).
2. Pull out the wiper blade assembly.
OLMB073024
OLMB073024
3. Install the new blade assembly by
inserting the center part into the slot
in the wiper arm until it clicks into
place.
4. Make sure the blade assembly is
installed firmly by trying to pull it
slightly.
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
or other components, we recommend
that the wiper blade be replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-39
09
For best battery service
OAI3089010
OAI3089010
Keep the battery securely mounted.
Keep the battery top clean and dry.
• Keep the terminals and connections
clean, tight, and coated with
petroleum jelly or terminal grease.
Rinse any spilled electrolyte from the
battery immediately with a solution of
water and baking soda.
If the vehicle is not going to be used
for an extended time, disconnect the
negative terminal cable of the battery
to prevent discharge.
i Information - For batteries
marked with UPPER and
LOWER
OHYK077011
OHYK077011
If your vehicle is equipped with a battery
marked with LOWER (MIN) and UPPER
(MAX) on the side, you should check the
electrolyte level.
The electrolyte level should be between
LOWER (MIN) and UPPER (MAX).
Be careful not to spill distilled (or
de-mineralized) water over the battery
surface or other adjacent components.
Also, do not overfill the battery cells.
If not, it may corrode the battery or other
components. Finally, securely close the
cell cap. However, we recommend you to
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for better battery service.
NOTICE
If the Electrolyte level is Low, add
distilled (or demineralized) water.
Never add sulfuric acid or other
electrolyte.
BATTERY
9-40
Maintenance
WARNING
Battery dangers
Always read the following
instructions carefully when
handling a battery.
Keep lighted cigarettes and
all other flames or sparks
away from the battery.
Hydrogen, a highly
combustible gas, is always
present in battery cells and
may explode if ignited.
Keep batteries out of the
reach of children because
batteries contain highly
corrosive SULFURIC ACID.
Do not allow battery acid to
contact your skin, eyes,
clothing or paint finish.
If any electrolyte gets into
your eyes, flush your eyes
with clean water for at least
15 minutes and get
immediate medical
attention. If electrolyte gets
on your skin, thoroughly
wash the contacted area. If
you feel a pain or a burning
sensation, get medical
attention immediately.
Wear eye protection when
charging or working near a
battery. Always provide
ventilation when working in
an enclosed space.
An inappropriately
disposed battery can be
harmful to the environment
and human health. Dispose
the battery according to
your local law(s) or
regulation.
The battery contains lead.
Do not dispose of it after
use. Please return the
battery to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer to be
recycled.
When lifting a plastic-cased battery,
excessive pressure on the case may
cause battery acid to leak, resulting
in personal injury. Lift with a battery
carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
Never attempt to recharge the
battery when the battery cables are
connected.
The electrical ignition system works
with high voltage. Never touch these
components with the engine running
or the ignition switched on.
Failure to follow the above warnings
can result in serious bodily injury or
death.
9-41
09
NOTICE
If you connect unauthorized electronic
devices to the battery, the battery may
be discharged. Never use unauthorized
devices.
WARNING
Always follow these instructions when
handling your vehicle’s battery to
prevent damage to your battery:
When you do not use the vehicle for a
long time in a low temperature area,
disconnect the battery and keep it
indoors.
Always charge the battery fully to
prevent battery case damage in low
temperature areas.
Prevent liquid from wetting the
battery terminals. The performance
of the battery may be degraded, and
may cause injury. Be cautious when
loading liquid in the trunk.
Do not tilt the battery.
If you connect unauthorized
electronic devices to the battery, the
battery may be discharged. Never
use unauthorized devices.
Battery capacity label
OAI3093012L
OAI3093012L
Example
Example
The actual battery label in the vehicle
may differ from the illustration.
1. CMF45L-DIN : The HYUNDAI model
name of battery
2. 12V : The nominal voltage
3. 45Ah(20HR) : The nominal capacity (in
Ampere hours)
4. RC 80min : The nominal reserve
capacity (in min.)
5. CCA410 : The cold-test current in
amperes by SAE
6. 410A : The cold-test current in
amperes by EN
9-42
Maintenance
Battery recharging
Your vehicle has a maintenance-free,
calcium-based battery.
If the battery becomes discharged in a
short time (because, for example, the
headlights or interior lights were left
on while the vehicle was not in use),
recharge it by slow charging (trickle)
for 10 hours.
If the battery gradually discharges
because of high electric load while the
vehicle is being used, recharge it at
20-30A for two hours.
WARNING
Recharging battery
When recharging the battery, observe
the following precautions:
The battery must be removed from
the vehicle and placed in an area with
good ventilation.
Do not allow cigarettes, sparks, or
flame near the battery.
Watch the battery during charging,
and stop or reduce the charging
rate if the battery cells begin
gassing (boiling) violently or if the
temperature of the electrolyte of any
cell exceeds 49°C (120°F).
Wear eye protection when checking
the battery during charging.
Disconnect the battery charger in the
following order.
1. Turn off the battery charger main
switch.
2. Unhook the negative clamp from the
negative battery terminal.
3. Unhook the positive clamp from the
positive battery terminal.
WARNING
Before performing maintenance or
recharging the battery, turn off all
accessories and stop the engine.
The negative battery cable must be
removed first and installed last when
the battery is disconnected.
Reset items
Items should be reset after the battery
has been discharged or the battery has
been disconnected.
Auto up/down window
(See chapter 5)
Climate control system
(See chapter 5)
Audio (See chapter 5)
Battery replacement
Replacing a Battery required
precautionary measures.
We recommend that you consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Make sure the battery is installed
securely when the it is replaced.
If the battery vibrates while driving,the
case and electrode plate can be
damaged.
9-43
09
Tire care
For proper maintenance, safety and
maximum fuel economy, you must
always maintain recommended tire
inflation pressures and stay within
the load limits and weight distribution
recommended for your vehicle.
Recommended cold tire
inflation pressures
All tire pressures (including the spare)
should be checked when the tires are
cold. “Cold Tires” means the vehicle has
not been driven for at least three hours
or driven less than 1.6 km (one mile).
Recommended pressures must be
maintained for the best ride, top vehicle
handling, and minimum tire wear.
For recommended inflation pressure,
refer to “Tire and wheels” in chapter 2.
OAI3019023
OAI3019023
All specifications (sizes and pressures)
can be found on a label attached to the
driver’s side center pillar.
WARNING
Tire underinflation
Severe underinflation (70 kPa (10 psi) or
more) can lead to severe heat build-up,
causing blowouts, tread separation and
other tire failures that can result in the
loss of vehicle control leading to severe
injury or death. This risk is much higher
on hot days and when driving for long
periods at high speeds.
NOTICE
Underinflation also results in
excessive wear, poor handling
and reduced fuel economy. Wheel
deformation also is possible. Keep
your tire pressures at the proper
levels. If a tire frequently needs
refilling, we recommend that the
system be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Overinflation produces a harsh ride,
excessive wear at the center of the
tire tread, and a greater possibility of
damage from road hazards.
NOTICE
Warm tires normally exceed
recommended cold tire pressures
by 28 to 41 kPa (4 to 6 psi). Do not
release air from warm tires to adjust
the pressure or the tires will be
underinflated.
Be sure to reinstall the tire inflation
valve caps. Without the valve cap,
dirt or moisture could get into the
valve core and cause air leakage. If a
valve cap is missing, install a new one
as soon as possible.
TIRES AND WHEELS
9-44
Maintenance
WARNING
Tire Inflation
Overinflation or underinflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect
vehicle handling, and lead to sudden
tire failure. This could result in loss of
vehicle control and potential injury.
NOTICE
Tire pressure
Always observe the following:
Check tire pressure when the tires
are cold. (After vehicle has been
parked for at least three hours or
hasn’t been driven more than 1.6 km
(one mile) since startup.)
Check the pressure of your spare tire
each time you check the pressure of
other tires.
Never overload your vehicle. Be
careful not to overload a vehicle
luggage rack if your vehicle is
equipped with one.
Worn, old tires can cause accidents.
If your tread is badly worn, or if your
tires have been damaged, replace
them.
Checking tire inflation pressure
Check your tires once a month or more.
Also, check the tire pressure of the spare
tire.
How to check
Use a good quality gage to check
tire pressure. You can not tell if your
tires are properly inflated simply by
looking at them. Radial tires may look
properly inflated even when they’re
underinflated.
Check the tire’s inflation pressure when
the tires are cold. - “Cold” means your
vehicle has been sitting for at least three
hours or driven no more than 1.6 km (1
mile).
Remove the valve cap from the tire valve
stem. Press the tire gage firmly onto the
valve to get a pressure measurement. If
the cold tire inflation pressure matches
the recommended pressure on the tire
and loading information label, no further
adjustment is necessary. If the pressure
is low, add air until you reach the
recommended amount.
If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the
center of the tire valve. Recheck the
tire pressure with the tire gage. Be
sure to put the valve caps back on the
valve stems. They help prevent leaks by
keeping out dirt and moisture.
9-45
09
WARNING
Inspect your tires frequently for
proper inflation as well as wear and
damage. Always use a tire pressure
gauge.
Tires with too much or too little
pressure wear unevenly causing poor
handling, loss of vehicle control,
and sudden tire failure leading to
accidents, injuries, and even death.
The recommended cold tire pressure
for your vehicle can be found in this
manual and on the tire label located
on the driver’s side center pillar.
Worn tires can cause accidents.
Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Remember to check the pressure
of your spare tire. HYUNDAI
recommends that you check the
spare every time you check the
pressure of the other tires on your
vehicle.
Tire rotation
To equalize tread wear, it is
recommended that the tires be rotated
according to the maintenance schedule
or sooner if irregular wear develops.
During rotation, check the tires for
correct balance.
When rotating tires, check for uneven
wear and damage. Abnormal wear
is usually caused by incorrect tire
pressure, improper wheel alignment,
out-of-balance wheels, severe braking
or severe cornering. Look for bumps
or bulges in the tread or side of tire.
Replace the tire if you find either of
these conditions. Replace the tire if
fabric or cord is visible. After rotation,
be sure to bring the front and rear tire
pressures to specification and check lug
nut tightness.
Refer to “Tire and wheels” in chapter 2.
9-46
Maintenance
CBGQ0706
CBGQ0706
With a full-size spare tire (if equipped)
With a full-size spare tire (if equipped)
Without a spare tire
Without a spare tire
CBGQ0707
CBGQ0707
Directional tires (if equipped)
Directional tires (if equipped)
CBGQ0707A
CBGQ0707A
Disc brake pads should be inspected for
wear whenever tires are rotated.
i Information
Rotate radial tires that have an
asymmetric tread pattern only from front
to rear and not from right to left.
WARNING
Do not use the compact spare tire for
tire rotation.
Do not mix bias ply and radial ply
tires under any circumstances.
This may cause unusual handling
characteristics that could result
in death, severe injury or property
damage.
Wheel alignment and tire
balance
The wheels on your vehicle were aligned
and balanced carefully at the factory to
give you the longest tire life and best
overall performance.
In most cases, you will not need to have
your wheels aligned again. However,
if you notice unusual tire wear or your
vehicle pulling one way or the other, the
alignment may need to be reset.
If you notice your vehicle vibrating when
driving on a smooth road, your wheels
may need to be rebalanced.
NOTICE
Improper wheel weights can damage
your vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Use
only approved wheel weights.
9-47
09
Tire replacement
OEN076053
OEN076053
Tread wear indicator
Tread wear indicator
If the tire is worn evenly, a tread wear
indicator will appear as a solid band
across the tread. This shows there is
less than 1.6 mm (1/16 inch) of tread left
on the tire. Replace the tire when this
happens.
Do not wait for the band to appear
across the entire tread before replacing
the tire.
NOTICE
When replacing the tires, recheck and
tighten the wheel nuts after driving
about 1,000 km (620 miles). If the
steering wheel shakes or the vehicle
vibrates while driving, the tire might
be out of balance so align the tire
balance. If the problem is not solved,
we recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Replacing tires
To reduce the chance or serious or fatal
injuries from an accident caused by tire
failure or loss of vehicle control:
Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of braking
effectiveness, steering control, and
traction.
Do not drive your vehicle with too
little or too much pressure in your
tires. This can lead to uneven wear
and tire failure.
When replacing tires, never mix
radial and bias-ply tires on the
same car. You must replace all tires
(including the spare) if moving from
radial to bias-ply tires.
It is best to replace all four tires at the
same time. If that is not possible, or
necessary, then replace the two front
or two rear tires as a pair. Replacing
just one tire can seriously affect your
vehicle’s handling.
Using tires and wheels other than
the recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics and
poor vehicle control, resulting in a
serious accident.
Wheels that do not meet HYUNDAI’s
specifications may fit poorly and
result in damage to the vehicle or
unusual handling and poor vehicle
control.
The works by comparing the speed of
the wheels. Tire size can affect wheel
speed. When replacing tires, all 4
tires must use the same size originally
supplied with the vehicle. Using tires
of a different size can cause the ABS
(Anti-lock Brake System) and ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) to work
irregularly. (if equipped)
9-48
Maintenance
Compact spare tire replacement
(if equipped)
A compact spare tire has a shorter tread
life than a regular size tire. Replace
it when you can see the tread wear
indicator bars on the tire. The replaced
compact spare tire should be the same
size and design tire as the one provided
with your new vehicle and should be
mounted on the same compact spare
tire wheel. The compact spare tire is not
designed to be mounted on a regular
size wheel, and the compact spare tire
wheel is not designed to mount a regular
size tire.
Wheel replacement
When replacing the metal wheels for any
reason, make sure the new wheels are
equivalent to the original factory units in
diameter, rim width and offset.
WARNING
A wheel that is not the correct size may
adversely affect wheel and bearing life,
braking and stopping abilities, handling
characteristics, ground clearance,
body-to-tire clearance, snow chain
clearance, speedometer and odometer
calibration, headlight aim and bumper
height.
Tire traction
Tire traction can be reduced if you drive
on worn tires, tires that are improperly
inflated or on slippery road surfaces.
Tires should be replaced when tread
wear indicators appear. Slow down
whenever there is rain, snow or ice on
the road, to reduce the possibility of
losing control of the vehicle.
9-49
09
Tire maintenance
In addition to proper inflation, correct
wheel alignment helps decrease tire
wear. If you find a tire worn unevenly,
have your dealer check the wheel
alignment.
When you have new tires installed,
make sure they are balanced. This will
increase vehicle ride comfort and tire
life. Additionally, a tire should always
be rebalanced if it is removed from the
wheel.
Tire sidewall labeling
I030B04JM
I030B04JM
2
2
1
1
7
7
5,6
5,6
3
3
4
4
1
1
This information identifies and describes
the fundamental characteristics of
the tire and also provides the tire
identification number (TIN) for safety
standard certification. The TIN can be
used to identify the tire in case of a
recall.
1. Manufacturer or brand name
Manufacturer or Brand name is shown.
2. Tire size designation
A tire’s sidewall is marked with a tire
size designation. You will need this
information when selecting replacement
tires for your car. The following explains
what the letters and numbers in the tire
size designation mean.
Example of tire size designation:
(These numbers are provided as an
example only; your tire size designator
could vary depending on your vehicle.)
165/70R14 81T
165 - Tire width in millimeters.
70 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s chapter
height as a percentage of its width.
R - Tire construction code (Radial).
14 - Rim diameter in inches.
81 - Load Index, a numerical code
associated with the maximum load the
tire can carry.
T - Speed Rating Symbol. See the speed
rating chart in this chapter for additional
information.
9-50
Maintenance
Wheel size designation
Wheels are also marked with important
information that you need if you ever
have to replace one. The following
explains what the letters and numbers in
the wheel size designation mean.
Example wheel size designation:
5.0JX14
5.0 - Rim width in inches.
J - Rim contour designation.
14 - Rim diameter in inches
Tire speed ratings
The chart below lists many of the
different speed ratings currently being
used for passenger car tires. The speed
rating is part of the tire size designation
on the sidewall of the tire. This symbol
corresponds to that tire’s designed
maximum safe operating speed.
Speed Rating
Symbol Maximum Speed
S180 km/h (112 mph)
T190 km/h (118 mph)
H 210 km/h (130 mph)
V 240 km/h (149 mph)
W 270 km/h (168 mph)
Y 300 km/h (186 mph)
3. Checking tire life (TIN : Tire
Identification Number)
Any tires that are over 6 years old,
based on the manufacturing date,
(including the spare tire) should be
replaced by new ones. You can find
the manufacturing date on the tire
sidewall (possibly on the inside of
the wheel), displaying the DOT Code.
The DOT Code is a series of numbers
on a tire consisting of numbers and
English letters. The manufacturing date
is designated by the last four digits
(characters) of the DOT code.
DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO
The front part of the DOT means a plant
code number, tire size and tread pattern
and the last four numbers indicate week
and year manufactured.
For example:
DOT XXXX XXXX 2223 represents that
the tire was produced in the 22th week
of 2023.
WARNING
Tire age
Tires degrade over time, even when
they are not being used.
Regardless of the remaining tread, it is
recommended that tires generally be
replaced after six (6) years of normal
service. Heat caused by hot climates
or frequent high loading conditions can
accelerate the aging process. Failure to
follow this warning could cause sudden
tire failure, which could lead to a loss
of control and an accident involving
serious injury or death.
9-51
09
4. Tire ply composition and material
The number of layers or plies of
rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the
materials in the tire, which include steel,
nylon, polyester, and others. The letter
“R” means radial ply construction; the
letter “D” means diagonal or bias ply
construction; and the letter “B” means
belted-bias ply construction.
5. Maximum permissible inflation
pressure
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure. Refer to
the Tire and Loading Information label
for recommended inflation pressure.
6. Maximum load rating
This number indicates the maximum
load in kilograms and pounds that can
be carried by the tire. When replacing
the tires on the vehicle, always use a
tire that has the same load rating as the
factory installed tire.
7. Uniform tire quality grading
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall between
tread shoulder and maximum chapter
width.
For example:
TREAD wear 200
TRACTION AA
TEMPERATURE A
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a comparative
rating based on the wear rate of the tire
when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150 would
wear one-and-a-half times (1½) as well
on the government course as a tire
graded 100.
The relative performance of tires
depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may depart
significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service
practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
These grades are molded on the side-
walls of passenger vehicle tires. The
tires available as standard or optional
equipment on your vehicle may vary
with respect to grade.
9-52
Maintenance
Traction - AA, A, B & C
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those grades
represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet
pavement measured under controlled
conditions on specified government
test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.
A tire marked C may have poor traction
performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this tire
is based on straight-ahead braking
traction tests, and does not include
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning,
or peak traction characteristics.
Temperature -A, B & C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B, and C, representing the tire’s
resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat when
tested under controlled conditions on a
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can cause
the material of the tire to degenerate
and reduce tire life, and excessive
temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. Grades B and A represent higher
levels of performance on the laboratory
test wheel than the minimum required
by law.
WARNING
Tire temperature
The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly
inflated and not overloaded. Excessive
speed, underinflation or excessive
loading, either separately or in
combination, can cause heat build-up
and sudden tire failure. This can cause
loss of vehicle control and serious
injury or death.
Low aspect ratio tire
(if equipped)
Low aspect ratio tires, whose aspect
ratio is lower than 50, are provided for
sporty looks.
Because the low aspect ratio tires are
optimized for handling and braking, it
may be more uncomfortable to ride in
and there is more noise compare with
normal tires.
9-53
09
NOTICE
Because the sidewall of the low aspect
ratio tire is shorter than the normal, the
wheel and tire of the low aspect ratio
tire is easier to be damaged. So, follow
the instructions below.
- When driving on a rough road or
off road, drive cautiously because
tires and wheels may be damaged.
And after driving, inspect tires and
wheels.
- When passing over a pothole, speed
bump, manhole, or curb stone, drive
slowly so that the tires and wheels
are not damaged.
- If the tire is impacted, we
recommend that you inspect the tire
condition or contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
- To prevent damage to the tire,
inspect the tire condition and
pressure every 3,000 km
(1,864 miles).
NOTICE
It is not easy to recognize the tire
damage with your own eyes. But,
if there is the slightest hint of tire
damage, even though you cannot see
the tire damage with your own eyes,
have the tire checked or replaced
because the tire damage may cause
air leakage from the tire.
If the tire is damaged by driving
on a rough road, off road, pothole,
manhole, or curb stone, it will not be
covered by the warranty.
You can find out the tire information
on the tire sidewall.
9-54
Maintenance
OTA070039
OTA070039
Blade type
Blade type
Normal
Normal
Blown
Blown
Cartridge type
Cartridge type
Multi fuse
Multi fuse
Normal
Normal
Blown
Blown
Normal
Normal
Blown
Blown
A vehicle’s electrical system is protected
from electrical overload damage by
fuses.
This vehicle has 2 fuse panels, one
located in the driver’s side panel bolster,
the other in the engine compartment.
If any of your vehicle’s lights,
accessories or controls do not work,
check the appropriate circuit fuse. If a
fuse has blown, the element inside the
fuse will be melted or broken.
If the electrical system does not work,
first check the driver’s side fuse panel.
Before replacing a blown fuse, turn the
engine and all switches off, and then
disconnect the negative battery cable.
Always replace a blown fuse with one of
the same rating.
If the replacement fuse blows, this
indicates an electrical problem.
Avoid using the system involved and
we recommend that all inspect an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
Three kinds of fuses are used: blade type
for lower amperage rating, cartridge
type, and multi fuse for higher amperage
ratings.
WARNING
NEVER replace a fuse with anything but
another fuse of the same rating.
A higher capacity fuse could cause
damage and possibly cause a fire.
Do not install a wire or aluminum
foil instead of the proper fuse -
even as a temporary repair. It may
cause extensive wiring damage and
possibly a fire.
NOTICE
Do not use a screwdriver or any other
metal object to remove fuses because
it may cause a short circuit and damage
the system.
i Information
The actual fuse/relay panel label may
differ from equipped items.
FUSES
9-55
09
NOTICE
When replacing a blown fuse or relay
with a new one, make sure the new
fuse or relay fits tightly into the clips.
The incomplete fastening fuse or
relay may cause the vehicle wiring
and electric systems damage and a
possible fire.
Do not remove fuses, relays and
terminals fastened with bolts or nuts.
The fuses, relays and terminals may
be fastened incompletely, and it may
cause a possible fire. If fuses, relays
and terminals fastened with bolts or
nuts are blown, consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not input any other objects
except fuses or relays into fuse/relay
terminals such as a driver or wiring. It
may cause contact failure and system
malfunction.
Check the blown fuse with checking
the fuse information on the fuse box
cover.
• Replace the blown fuse on the safe
place after turning off the ignition
switch and all electric switches and
disconnecting the negative battery
cable.
Instrument panel fuse
replacement
OAI3089011
OAI3089011
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches OFF.
3. Open the fuse panel cover.
4. Refer to the label on the inside of
the fuse panel cover to locate the
suspected fuse location.
9-56
Maintenance
OAI3089012
OAI3089012
5. Pull the suspected fuse straight out.
Use the removal tool provided in the
engine compartment fuses panel
cover.
6. Check the removed fuse; replace it if
it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in
the instrument panel fuse panels (or in
the engine compartment fuse panel).
7. Push in a new fuse of the same rating,
and make sure it fits tightly in the
clips.If it fits loosely, we recommend
that you consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
In an emergency, if you do not have
a spare fuse, use a fuse of the same
rating from a circuit you may not need
for operating the vehicle, such as the
cigarette lighter fuse.
If the headlights or other electrical
components do not work and the fuses
are undamaged, check the fuse panel
in the engine compartment. If a fuse
is blown, it must be replaced with the
same rating.
Memory fuse
OAI3089013
OAI3089013
Your vehicle is equipped with the
memory fuse to prevent battery
discharge if your vehicle is parked
without being operated for prolonged
periods. Use the following procedures
before parking the vehicle for prolonged
periods.
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Turn off the headlights and tail lights.
3. Open the driver’s side panel cover and
pull up the memory fuse.
i Information
If the memory fuse is pulled up from
the fuse panel, the warning chime,
audio, clock and interior lamps, etc.,
will not operate. Some items must
be reset after replacement. Refer to
“Battery” in this chapter.
Even though the memory fuse is pulled
up, the battery can still be discharged
by operation of the headlights or other
electrical devices.
9-57
09
Engine compartment panel fuse
replacement
OAI3089014
OAI3089014
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches OFF.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tab and pulling up.
4. Check the removed fuse; replace
it if it is blown. To remove or insert
the fuse, use the removal tool in the
engine compartment fuse panel.
5. Push in a new fuse of the same rating,
and make sure it fits tightly in the
clips. If it fits loosely, we recommend
that you consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
After checking the fuse panel in the
engine compartment, securely
install the fuse panel cover. You may
hear a clicking sound if the cover is
securely latched. If it is not securely
latched, electrical failure may occur
from water contact.
Multi fuse (Main fuse)
OAI3089014
OAI3089014
OAI3089015
OAI3089015
If the multi fuse is blown, it must be
removed as follows:
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tab and pulling it up.
4. Remove the nuts shown in the picture
above.
5. Replace the fuse with a new one of
the same rating.
6. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
If the multi fuse is blown, we
recommend that you consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-58
Maintenance
Fuse/relay panel description
Inner fuse panel
OBI3090015
OBI3090015
Inside the fuse/relay panel covers, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing
fuse/relay name and capacity.
ICU
ICU
PCB
PCB
OAI3089018/OAI3089017
OAI3089018/OAI3089017
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle.
It is accurate at the time of printing.
When you inspect the fuse panel in your
vehicle, refer to the fuse panel label.
9-59
09
Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
rating Circuit Protected
ROOM LAMP 10A PCB/ICU: Room Lamp
OUTSIDE
MIRROR
HEATED 10A Outside Mirror Heated
POWER
WINDOW LH 25A FRT Power Window LH
SENSOR S10A F_Water Sensor
POWER
OUTLET
FRONT
FRT POWER
OUTLET 20A ICU/PCB: Front Power Outlet
IBU1 15A ICU: BODY CONTROL MODULE (IBU)
MULTI
MEDIA 20A ICU: AUDIO
POWER
WINDOW RH 25A FRT Power Window RH
TCU 15A PCB/ICU: AT : Speed Sensor Out, Inhibit SW.
BRAKE
SWITCH 10A PCB/ICU: Stop Switch
MEMORY 10A ICU: A/Con (FATC), Cluster
START 7.5A PCB: Inhibitor Switch, Start Relay
FOLDING
MIRROR 10A ICU/PCB: Folding Mirror
MODULE1 7.5A ICU/PCB: Stop Switch
Airbag 10A ICU/PCB: ACU
Inner Compartment Fuse Panel (ICU)
9-60
Maintenance
Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
rating Circuit Protected
DOOR LOCK 20A ICU: Door Lock
ECU E10A ICU/PCB: ECU, A_FLOW_SNSR
DRL 10A ICU: DRL , DRL Position Lamp
MODULE6 10A ICU/PCB: OBD
HAZARD 15A PCB: HAZARD Switch, ICU: IBU (Turn Signal)
MODULE2 10A PCB: ESC Switch, ICU: BCM(IBU)
*for CNG:CNG_SW:IGN1
MODULE3 7.5A PCB/ICU: FATC, AT Lever Indicator,
Head Lamp Projection, Audio Compact, AVN
SPARE1 10A ICU: Spare Fuse
REAR
WIPER 15A PCB: RR Wiper Motor, ICU : Washer Motor
Airbag
INDICATOR 7.5A PCB/ICU: Cluster
IBU2 IBU 10A ICU: BCM (IBU)
ABS 7.5A PCB/ICU: ABS/ESC Unit
FRONT
WIPER 20A PCB/ICU: MFSW, Wiper Motor
A/CON2 7.5A PCB/ICU: MTC, FATC, Dual Switch
CLUSTER 7.5A PCB/ICU: Cluster
ACC 10A PCB/ICU: Crash_VDMS_Extension, USB Charger,
Audio_B, IBU
Inner Compartment Fuse Panel (ICU)
9-61
09
Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
rating Circuit Protected
MDPS 7.5A PCB/ICU: Motor Driven Power Steering Unit
MODULE5 10A PCB/ICU: Crash_VDMS_Extension
MODULE4 7.5A ICU: BCM (IBU)
REAR
POWER
OUTLEt
RR POWER
OUTLET 20A PCB/ICU: RR Power Outlet
A/CON1 7.5A PCB/ICU: FATC, Blower Motor
Inner Compartment Fuse Panel (ICU)
9-62
Maintenance
Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
rating Circuit Protected
TAIL LH 7.5A PCB: Position Lamp LH, Head Lamp LH,
RR Combi Lamp LH
OUTSIDE
MIRROR
HEATED 10A Outside Mirror Heated
POWER
WINDOW LH 25A FRT Power Window LH
SENSOR S10A F_Water Sensor
POWER
OUTLET FRONT FRT POWER
OUTLET 20A ICU/PCB: Front Power Outlet
TAIL RH 7.5A PCB: Position Lamp RH, Head Lamp RH,
RR Combi Lamp RH
POWER
WINDOW RH 25A FRT Power Window RH
TCU 15A PCB/ICU: AT : Speed Sensor Out, Inhibit SW
AMT: AMT Lever.
BRAKE
SWITCH 10A PCB/ICU: Stop Switch
STOP LAMP STOP LAMP 15A PCB: Stop Lamp, RR Combi Lamp, HMSL
START 7.5A PCB: Inhibitor Switch, Start Relay
FOLDING
MIRROR 10A ICU/PCB: Folding Mirror
MODULE1 7.5A ICU/PCB: Stop Switch
IMMOBILIZER 10A PCB: Immobilizer Unit
Airbag 10A ICU/PCB: ACU
Inner Compartment Fuse Panel (ICU)
9-63
09
Inner Compartment Fuse Panel (PCB)
Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
rating Circuit Protected
DOOR LOCK 20A ICU: Door Lock
ECU E10A ICU/PCB: ECU, A_FLOW_SNSR
MODULE6 10A ICU/PCB: OBD
HAZARD 15A PCB: HAZARD Switch, ICU: IBU (Turn Signal)
MODULE2 10A PCB: ESC Switch, ICU: BCM (IBU)
MODULE3 7.5A PCB/ICU: FATC, AT Lever Indicator,
Head Lamp Projection, Audio Compact,
Infotainment system
HEAD LAMP 10A PCB: Head Lamp Relay
REAR WIPER 15A PCB: RR Wiper Motor, ICU : Washer Motor
Airbag
INDICATOR 7.5A PCB/ICU: Cluster
TURN SIGNAL 10A PCB: Hazard Switch
ABS 7.5A PCB/ICU: ABS/ESC Unit
FRONT
WIPER 20A PCB/ICU: MFSW, Wiper Motor
A/CON2 7.5A PCB/ICU: MTC, FATC, Dual Switch
SPARE1 10A PCB: Spare Fuse
9-64
Maintenance
Inner Compartment Fuse Panel (PCB)
Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
rating Circuit Protected
CLUSTER 7.5A PCB/ICU: Cluster
ACC 10A PCB/ICU: Crash_VDMS_Extension,
USB Charger, Audio_B, IBU
MDPS 7.5A PCB/ICU: Motor Driven Power Steering Unit.
MODULE5 10A PCB/ICU: Crash_VDMS_Extension
REAR
POWER
OUTLEt
RR POWER
OUTLET 20A PCB/ICU: RR Power Outlet
A/CON1 7.5A PCB/ICU: FATC, Blower Motor
9-65
09
Engine compartment fuse panel
OAI3089014
OAI3089014
Inside the fuse/relay panel covers, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing
fuse/relay name and capacity.
OAI3089019
OAI3089019
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle.
It is accurate at the time of printing.
When you inspect the fuse panel in your
vehicle, refer to the fuse panel label.
9-66
Maintenance
Engine Compartment Fuse Panel
Item Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
Rating Circuit Protected
RELAY
MAIN RELAY MAIN
RELAY 30A ECU (MT, AT, CNG, BS6)
START 20A ECU, Start Solenoid
BLOWER 35A PCB, ICU
BURGLAR ALARM
HORN 20A IBU
HEAD
LAMP HI 20A Head Lamp Projection,
Head Lamp
HEAD LAMP 20A Head Lamp Fuse
FUEL PUMP 20A ECU (MT, AT, CNG, BS6)
BACK UP LAMP
VACUUM PUMP B/UP LAMP
VACUUM
PUMP 20A VACUUM PUMP, ECU Relay
HORN 20A HORN
AIR
CONDITIONER 20A A/CON, ECU (MT, AT, U2)
COOLING FAN 35A Radiator Fan Motor,
ECU (AT, MT, U2)
MULTI
FUSE
ALTERNATOR ALT
125A K1.0T, K1.2
150A U2 (BS4)
180A U2 (^BS4)
MDPS 80A
50A DC type
Economical type
LP S/B J
FUSE
BLOWER 40A Blower Relay
REAR HEATED 40A RR Heated Relay
COOLING FAN GSL/DSL
30A/40A Cooling Fan Relay
IGNITION1 IG1 30A Starting
BATTERY3 30A ICU
9-67
09
Engine Compartment Fuse Panel
Item Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
Rating Circuit Protected
LP S/B J
FUSE
BATTERY2 30A/50A ICU, PCB
BATTERY1 30A/40A ICU, PCB
BATTERY4 50A ICU
S/B M
FUSE
ABS/ESC2 40A ABS/ESC Unit
POWER
OUTLET POWER
OUTLET 40A ICU, PCB
ABS/ESC1 40A ABS/ESC Unit
ECU1 30A ECU
IGNITION2 IG2 30A Starting, Start Relay
LP MINI
FUSE
BACK UP LAMP1 1B/UP
LAMP 10A Back Up Relay
FRONT WIPER 10A Front Wiper, ECU
ECU3 15A ECU (MT, AT, BS6)
HORN 15A Horn Relay
AIR
CONDITIONER 10A A/Con Relay
HEAD LAMP LH 10A Head Lamp LH,
Head Lamp Projection LH
9-68
Maintenance
Engine Compartment Fuse Panel
Item Fuse Name Symbol Fuse
Rating Circuit Protected
LP MINI
FUSE
HEAD LAMP RH 10A Head Lamp RH,
Head Lamp Projection RH
ECU7 10A Main Relay
*for CNG:ECU7
ECU8 10A Main Relay
HEAD LAMP HI 10A Cluster
ECU2 15A Main Relay
*for CNG:SHUTOFF VALVE111
ECU5 15A Main Relay
*for CNG:ECU4
ECU4 15A Main Relay
*for CNG:INJECTOR_3&4
ECU6 15A Main Relay,
Ignition Coil Extension
BACK UP LAMP2 2B/UP
LAMP 10A Back Up Relay
HEAD LAMP 20A Head Lamp Relay
HEAD LAMP HI 20A Head Lamp HI Relay
ALTERNATOR
MANAGEMENT
SYSTEM AMS 10A ECU (U2)
FUEL PUMP3 3FUEL
PU MP 15A Fuel Pump Relay
VACUUM PUMP VACUUM
PUMP 10A Main Relay
9-69
09
We recommend that you consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer to replace
most vehicle light bulbs. It is difficult
to replace vehicle light bulbs because
other parts of the vehicle must be
removed before you can get to the bulb.
This is especially true for removing the
headlight assembly to get to the bulb(s).
Removing/installing the headlight
assembly can result in damage to the
vehicle.
WARNING
Prior to replacing a light, depress the
foot brake, move the shift lever into the
N (Neutral, for Automatic transmission
vehicle) or neutral (for manual
transmission vehicle), apply the parking
brake, place the ignition switch in the
LOCK/OFF position, and take the key
with you when leaving the vehicle to
avoid sudden movement of the vehicle
and to prevent possible electric shock.
Be aware the bulbs may be hot and may
burn your fingers.
NOTICE
Be sure to replace the burned-out bulb
with one of the same wattage rating.
Otherwise, it may cause damage to the
fuse or electric wiring system.
i Information
The headlight and tail lamp lenses could
appear frosty if the vehicle is washed after
driving or the vehicle is driven at night
in wet weather. This condition is caused
by temperature difference between the
lamp inside and outside and, it does not
indicate a problem with your vehicle.
When moisture condenses in the lamp,
it will be removed after driving with the
headlight on. The removable level may
differ depending on lamp size, lamp
position and environmental condition.
However, if moisture is not removed, we
recommend that your vehicle is inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
LIGHT BULBS
9-70
Maintenance
Headlight, Parking (Position)
Light, Turn Signal Light, Daytime
Running Light bulb replacement
OAI3092001
OAI3092001
Type A
Type A
• 5 Door
• 5 Door
• 4 Door
• 4 Door
OAI3092002
OAI3092002
(1) Headlight (Low/High) *1
(2) Parking (Position) Light
(3) Turn Signal Light
(4) Daytime Running Light
(if equipped) or Daytime Running
Light/Position light (if equipped)
*1 : MFR (Multi Focus Reflector)
Headlight
OAI3092003
OAI3092003
Type B
Type B
• 5 Door
• 5 Door
• 4 Door
• 4 Door
OAI3092004
OAI3092004
(1) Headlight (Low/High) *2
(2) Turn Signal Light
(3) Parking (Position) Light/
Daytime Running Light
(if equipped)
*2 : Bi-Function Projection Headlight
9-71
09
OLMB073042L
OLMB073042L
WARNING
Halogen bulbs
Halogen bulbs contain pressurized
gas that will produce flying pieces of
glass if broken.
Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids. Never touch the glass with
bare hands. Residual oil may cause
the bulb to overheat and burst when
lit. A bulb should be operated only
when installed in a headlight.
If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately and
carefully dispose of it.
Wear eye protection when changing
a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down
before handling it.
i Information
If the headlight aiming adjustment is
necessary after the headlight assembly
is reinstalled, consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Headlight (Low/High)
OAI3092010
OAI3092010
Type A
Type A
Type B
Type B
OAI3092011
OAI3092011
[1]: Dust cover
[2]: Headlight
[3]: Parking (Position) light
[4]: Turn signal light
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative terminal of
the battery.
3. Remove the headlight bulb cover by
turning it counterclockwise.
4. Disconnect the headlight bulb socket-
connector.
5. Unsnap the headlight bulb retaining
wire by depressing the end and
pushing it upward.
6. Remove the bulb from the headlight
assembly.
7. Install a new headlight bulb and snap
the headlight bulb retaining wire into
position by aligning the wire with the
groove on the bulb.
8. Connect the headlight bulb socket
connector.
9. Install the headlight bulb cover by
turning it clockwise.
10. Connect the negative terminal of the
battery.
9-72
Maintenance
i Information
- Bi-Function projection
headlight
This headlight is bi-function type that
switches the low beam to high or the high
beam to low using solenoid system. So,
the moving sound may be heard when the
headlight switches the low beam to high
or the high beam to low and it does not
indicate malfunction of the headlight.
Turn signal light
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative terminal of
the battery.
3. Remove the turn signal light bulb
cover by turning it counterclockwise.
4. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
5. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
6. Install the socket in the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
7. Install the turn signal light bulb cover
by turning it clockwise.
8. Connect the negative terminal of the
battery
Parking (Position) light
1. Remove the socket from the assembly
by pulling it straight out.
2. Remove the bulb from the socket by
pulling it out.
3. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket.
4. Install the socket in the assembly by
pushing it in.
Parking(Position) light/
Daytime running light
(LED Type, If equipped)
Your vehicle is equipped with LED
lamps. LED lamps do not have
replaceable bulbs. If the LED lamp does
not operate, we recommend that the
vehicle be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
We recommend that the headlamp
bulb replacement be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-73
09
Side repeater light replacement
(if equipped)
OAI3089022
OAI3089022
Type A
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that the vehicle be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OAI3089056
OAI3089056
Type B
1. Disconnect the negative terminal of
the battery.
2. Remove the lamp assembly from the
vehicle by prying the lens and pulling
the assembly out.
3. Disconnect the bulb electrical
connector.
4. Separate the socket and the
lens parts by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
socket align with the slots on the lens
part.
5. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
6. Insert a new bulb in the socket.
7. Reassemble the socket and the lens
part.
8. Connect the bulb electrical connector.
9. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
10
.
Connect the negative terminal of the
battery
If the light does not operate, we
recommend that the vehicle be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
9-74
Maintenance
Rear combination light bulb
replacement
OAI3092005
OAI3092005
5 Door
1. Back Up Light
2. Rear Turn Signal Light
3. Stop Light
4. Tail light
5. Reflex Reflector
OAI3092009
OAI3092009
OAI3092008
OAI3092008
1. Open the tailgate
2. Loosen the light assembly retaining
screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.
3. Remove the rear combination light
assembly from the body of the
vehicle.
9-75
09
OAI3092007
OAI3092007
[1]: Back up light
[2]: Rear turn signal light
[3]: Stop light
4. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
5. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
6. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
7. Install the socket in the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
8. Reinstall the light assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
OAI3089065
OAI3089065
4 Door
1. Back Up Light
2. Rear Turn Signal Light
3. Stop Light
4. Tail Light
5. Reflex Reflector
9-76
Maintenance
OAI3089063
OAI3089063
Outside lamp
Outside lamp
OAI3089064
OAI3089064
1. Open the trunk.
2. Loosen the light assembly retaining
screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.
Remove the rear combination light
assembly from the body of the
vehicle.
OAI3089070
OAI3089070
Inside lamp
Inside lamp
1. Open the trunk.
2. Loosen the retaining screw of the
trunk lid cover and then remove the
cover.
OAI3089068
OAI3089068
OAI3089069
OAI3089069
[1]: Back up light
[2]: Rear turn signal light
[3]: Stop light
3. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
4. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
5. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
9-77
09
6. Install the socket in the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
7. Reinstall the light assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
Tail lamp (LED Type)
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that the vehicle be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
High mounted stop light
OAI3089031
OAI3089031
5 Door
5 Door
4 Door
4 Door
OAI3089067
OAI3089067
If the light does not operate, we
recommend that the vehicle be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
License plate light bulb
replacement
OAI3089029
OAI3089029
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver, remove
the light assembly from the body of
the vehicle by prying the housing and
pulling the assembly out.
2. Separate the socket and the
lens part by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
socket align with the slots on the lens
part.
3. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
4. Insert a new bulb in the socket.
5. Reassemble the socket and the
housing part.
6. Reinstall the light assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
9-78
Maintenance
Interior light bulb replacement
OIB074041
OIB074041
Room lamp
Room lamp
Luggage room lamp
Luggage room lamp
• 5 Door
• 5 Door
OAI3083030L
OAI3083030L
• 4 Door
• 4 Door
OAI3089030I
OAI3089030I
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver, gently
pry the lens from the interior light
housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
3. Install a new bulb in the socket.
4. Align the lens tabs with the interior
light housing notches and snap the
lens into place
NOTICE
Be careful not to dirty or damage lens,
lens tab, and plastic housings.
9-79
09
NOTICE
If you park your vehicle near a stainless
steel sign or glass facade building, the
vehicle’s exterior plastic parts such
as a bumper, spoiler, garnish, lamp
or outside rearview mirror might be
damaged due to sunlight reflected
from the sign or building. To prevent
damage of the exterior plastic parts,
you should avoid parking in areas
where light may be reflected or use a
car cover. (The exterior plastic parts
applied to your vehicle may vary.)
Exterior care
Exterior general caution
It is very important to follow the label
directions when using any chemical
cleaner or polish. Read all warning and
caution statements that appear on the
label.
High-pressure washing
• When using high-pressure washers,
make sure to maintain sufficient
distance from the vehicle.
Insufficient clearance or excessive
pressure can lead to component
damage or water penetration.
Do not spray the camera, sensors or
its surrounding area directly with a
high pressure washer. Shock applied
from high pressure water may cause
the device to not operate normally.
Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers) or
connectors as they may be damaged
if they come into contact with high
pressure water.
Finish maintenance
Washing
To help protect your vehicle’s finish
from rust and deterioration, wash it
thoroughly and frequently at least once
a month with lukewarm or cold water.
If you use your vehicle for off-road
driving, you should wash it after each
off-road trip. Pay special attention to the
removal of any accumulation of salt, dirt,
mud, and other foreign materials. Make
sure the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors and rocker panels are kept
clear and clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial pollution and similar deposits
can damage your vehicle’s finish if not
removed immediately.
Even prompt washing with plain water
may not completely remove all these
deposits. A mild soap, safe for use on
painted surfaces, may be used.
After washing, rinse the vehicle
thoroughly with lukewarm or cold water.
Do not allow soap to dry on the finish.
NOTICE
Do not use strong soap, chemical
detergents or hot water, and do not
wash the vehicle in direct sunlight
or when the body of the vehicle is
warm.
Be careful when washing the side
windows of your vehicle.
Especially, with high-pressure water,
water may leak through the windows
and wet the interior.
To prevent damage to the plastic
parts and lamps, do not clean
with chemical solvents or strong
detergents.
APPEARANCE CARE
9-80
Maintenance
WARNING
Wet brakes
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see if
they have been affected by water. If
the braking performance is impaired,
dry the brakes by applying them lightly
while maintaining a slow forward
speed.
OAI3092006
OAI3092006
NOTICE
Water washing in the engine
compartment including high pressure
water washing may cause the failure
of electrical circuits located in the
engine compartment.
Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
(if equipped)
Automatic car wash which uses
rotating brushes should not be used
as this can damage the surface of your
vehicle. A steam cleaner which washes
the vehicle surface at high temperature
may result the oil to adhere and leave
stains that is difficult to remove.
Use a soft cloth (for example,
microfiber towel or sponge) when
washing your vehicle and dry with
a microfiber towel. When you hand
wash your vehicle, you should not use
a cleaner that finishes with wax. If the
vehicle surface is too dirty (sand, dirt,
dust, contaminant, etc.), clean the
surface with water before washing the
car.
Waxing
Wax the vehicle when water will no
longer bead on the paint.
Always wash and dry the vehicle
before waxing. Use a good quality
liquid or paste wax, and follow the
manufacturer’s instructions. Wax all
metal trim to protect it and to maintain
its luster.
Removing oil, tar, and similar materials
with a spot remover will usually strip the
wax from the finish. Be sure to re-wax
these areas even if the rest of the vehicle
does not yet need waxing.
9-81
09
NOTICE
Wiping dust or dirt off the body with
a dry cloth will scratch the finish.
Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or caustic
agents on chrome-plated or anodized
aluminum parts. This may result in
damage to the protective coating
and cause discoloration or paint
deterioration.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
(if equipped)
Do not use any polish protector such as
a detergent, an abrasive and a polish.
In case wax is applied, remove the wax
immediately using a silicon remover
and if any tar or tar contaminant is on
the surface use a tar remover to clean.
However, be careful not to apply too
much pressure on the painted area.
Finish damage repair
Deep scratches or stone chips in the
painted surface must be repaired
promptly. Exposed metal will quickly
rust and may develop into a major repair
expense.
i Information
If your vehicle is damaged and requires
any metal repair or replacement, be sure
the body shop applies anti-corrosion
materials to the parts repaired or
replaced.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
(if equipped)
In case of matte paint finish vehicles,
it is impossible to modify only the
damaged area and repair of the whole
part is necessary. If the vehicle is
damaged and painting is required,
we recommend that you have your
vehicle maintained and repaired by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Take
extreme care, as it is difficult to restore
the quality after the repair.
9-82
Maintenance
Bright-metal maintenance
To remove road tar and insects, use
a tar remover, not a scraper or other
sharp object.
To protect the surfaces of bright-metal
parts from corrosion, apply a coating
of wax or chrome preservative and rub
to a high luster.
During winter weather or in coastal
areas, cover the bright metal parts
with a heavier coating of wax or
preservative. If necessary, coat the
parts with non-corrosive petroleum
jelly or other protective compound.
Underbody maintenance
Corrosive materials used for ice and
snow removal and dust control may
collect on the underbody. If these
materials are not removed, accelerated
rusting can occur on the underbody
parts such as the fuel lines, frame,
floor pan and exhaust system, even
though they have been treated with rust
protection.
Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbody
and wheel openings with lukewarm
or cold water once a month, after off-
road driving and at the end of each
winter. Pay special attention to these
areas because it is difficult to see all
the mud and dirt. It will do more harm
than good to wet down the road grime
without removing it. The lower edges
of the doors, rocker panels, and frame
members have drain holes that should
not clog with dirt; trapped water in these
areas can cause rusting.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see if
they have been affected by water. If
the braking performance is impaired,
dry the brakes by applying them lightly
while maintaining a slow forward
speed.
Aluminum wheel maintenance
The aluminum wheels are coated with a
clear protective finish.
Do not use any abrasive cleaner,
polishing compound, solvent, or wire
brushes on aluminum wheels. They
may scratch or damage the finish.
Clean the wheel when it has cooled.
Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly with
water. Also, be sure to clean the
wheels after driving on salted roads.
This helps prevent corrosion.
Avoid washing the wheels with high-
speed car wash brushes.
Do not use any alkaline or acid
detergent. It may damage and corrode
the aluminum wheels coated with a
clear protective finish.
9-83
09
Corrosion protection
Protecting your vehicle from corro-
sion
By using the most advanced design
and construction practices to combat
corrosion, we produce vehicles of the
highest quality. However, this is only
part of the job. To achieve the long-term
corrosion resistance your vehicle can
deliver, the owner’s cooperation and
assistance is also required.
Common causes of corrosion
The most common causes of corrosion
on your vehicle are:
Road salt, dirt and moisture that is
allowed to accumulate underneath the
vehicle.
• Removal of paint or protective
coatings by stones, gravel, abrasion
or minor scrapes and dents which
leave unprotected metal exposed to
corrosion.
High-corrosion areas
If you live in an area where your vehicle
is regularly exposed to corrosive
materials, corrosion protection is
particularly important. Some of the
common causes of accelerated
corrosion are road salts, dust control
chemicals, ocean air and industrial
pollution.
Moisture breeds corrosion
Moisture creates the conditions in
which corrosion is most likely to occur.
For example, corrosion is accelerated
by high humidity, particularly when
temperatures are just above freezing. In
such conditions, the corrosive material is
kept in contact with the vehicle’s surface
by moisture that slowly evaporates.
Mud is particularly corrosive because
it dries slowly and holds moisture in
contact with the vehicle. Although the
mud appears to be dry, it can still retain
moisture and promote corrosion.
High temperatures can also accelerate
corrosion of parts that are not properly
ventilated so the moisture can be
dispersed. For all these reasons, it is
particularly important to keep your
vehicle clean and free of mud or
accumulations of other materials. This
applies not only to the visible surfaces
but particularly to the underside of the
vehicle.
To help prevent corrosion
You can help prevent corrosion from
getting started by observing the
following:
9-84
Maintenance
Keep your vehicle clean
The best way to prevent corrosion is
to keep your vehicle clean and free of
corrosive materials. Attention to the
underside of the vehicle is particularly
important.
If you live in a high-corrosion area —
where road salts are used, near the
ocean, areas with industrial pollution,
acid rain, etc.—, you should take extra
care to prevent corrosion. In winter,
hose off the underside of your vehicle
at least once a month and be sure to
clean the underside thoroughly when
winter is over.
• When cleaning underneath the
vehicle, give particular attention to the
components under the fenders and
other areas that are hidden from view.
Do a thorough job; just dampening the
accumulated mud rather than washing
it away will accelerate corrosion rather
than prevent it. Water under high
pressure and steam are particularly
effective in removing accumulated
mud and corrosive materials.
When cleaning lower door panels,
rocker panels and frame members, be
sure that drain holes are kept open so
that moisture can escape and not be
trapped inside to accelerate corrosion.
Keep your garage dry
Don’t park your vehicle in a damp,
poorly ventilated garage. This creates
a favorable environment for corrosion.
This is particularly true if you wash your
vehicle in the garage or drive it into the
garage when it is still wet or covered
with snow, ice or mud. Even a heated
garage can contribute to corrosion
unless it is well ventilated so moisture is
dispersed.
Keep paint and trim in good condition
Scratches or chips in the finish should
be covered with “touch-up” paint as
soon as possible to reduce the possibility
of corrosion. If bare metal is showing
through, the attention of a qualified
body and paint shop is recommended.
Bird droppings : Bird droppings are
highly corrosive and may damage
painted surfaces in just a few hours.
Always remove bird droppings as soon
as possible.
Don’t neglect the interior
Moisture can collect under the floor
mats and carpeting and cause corrosion.
Check under the mats periodically to be
sure the carpeting is dry. Use particular
care if you carry fertilizers, cleaning
materials or chemicals in the vehicle.
These should be carried only in proper
containers and any spills or leaks should
be cleaned up, flushed with clean water
and thoroughly dried.
9-85
09
Interior care
Interior general precautions
Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand cleaner,
and air freshener from contacting the
interior parts because they may cause
damage or discoloration. If they do
contact the interior parts, wipe them
off immediately. See the instructions
that follow for the proper way to clean
vehicle interior surfaces.
NOTICE
Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
NOTICE
When cleaning leather products
(steering wheel, seats etc.), use neutral
detergents or low alcohol content
solutions. If you use high alcohol
content solutions or acid/alkaline
detergents, the color of the leather may
fade or the surface may get stripped
off.
Cleaning the upholstery and interior
trim
Vehicle interior surfaces (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from interior
surfaces with a whisk broom or a
vacuum cleaner.
If necessary, clean interior surfaces with
a mixture of warm water and mild non-
detergent cleaner (test all cleaners on a
concealed area before use).
Fabric (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from
fabric with a whisk broom or vacuum
cleaner. Clean with a mild soap solution
recommended for upholstery or carpets.
Remove fresh spots immediately with
a fabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots
do not receive immediate attention,
the fabric can be stained and its color
can be affected. Also, its fire-resistant
properties can be reduced if the material
is not properly maintained.
NOTICE
Using anything but recommended
cleaners and procedures may affect the
fabric’s appearance and fire-resistant
properties.
9-86
Maintenance
Leather (if equipped)
Feature of Seat Leather
- Leather is made from the outer skin
of an animal, which goes through a
special process to be available for
use. Since it is a natural object, each
part differs in thickness or density.
Wrinkles may appear as a natural
result of stretching and shrinking
depending on the temperature and
humidity.
- The seat is made of stretchable
fabric to improve comfort.
- The parts contacting the body are
curved and the side supporting
area is high which provides driving
comfort and stability.
- Wrinkles may appear naturally
from usage. It is not a fault of the
products.
CAUTION
Wrinkles or abrasions which appear
naturally from usage are not covered
by warranty.
Belts with metallic accessories,
zippers or keys inside the back
pocket may damage the seat fabric.
Make sure not to wet the seat. It may
change the nature of natural leather.
Jeans or clothes which could bleach
may contaminate the surface of the
seat covering fabric.
Caring for the leather seats
- Vacuum the seat periodically to
remove dust and sand on the seat. It
will prevent abrasion or damage of
the leather and maintain its quality.
- Wipe the natural leather seat cover
often with dry or soft cloth.
- Use of proper leather protective may
prevent abrasion of the cover and
helps maintain the color. Be sure to
read the instructions and consult a
specialist when using leather coating
or protective agent.
- Light colored (beige, cream beige)
leather is easily contaminated and
the stain is noticeable. Clean the
seats frequently.
- Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may
cause the surface to crack.
9-87
09
• Cleaning the leather seats
- Remove all contaminations instantly.
Refer to instructions below for
removal of each contaminant.
- Cosmetic products (sunscreen,
foundation, etc.)
Apply cleansing cream on a cloth
and wipe the contaminate spot. Wipe
off the cream with a wet cloth and
remove water with a dry cloth.
- Beverages (coffee, soft drink, etc.)
Apply a small amount of neutral
detergent and wipe until
contaminations do not smear.
- Oil
Remove oil instantly with absorbable
cloth and wipe with stain remover
used only for natural leather.
- Chewing gum
Harden the gum with ice and remove
gradually.
Cleaning the lap/shoulder belt
webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any
mild soap solution recommended for
cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow
the instructions provided with the soap.
Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing
because this may weaken it.
Cleaning the interior window glass
If the interior glass surfaces of the
vehicle become fogged (that is, covered
with an oily, greasy or waxy film), they
should be cleaned with glass cleaner.
Follow the directions on the glass
cleaner container.
NOTICE
Do not scrape or scratch the inside of
the rear window. This may result in
damage to the rear window defroster
grid.
9-88
Maintenance
The emission control system of your
vehicle is covered by a written limited
warranty. Please see the warranty
information contained in the Service
Passport in your vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emission control system to meet all
emission regulations.
There are three emission control systems
which are as follows.
(1) Crankcase emission control system
(2) Evaporative emission control system
(3) Exhaust emission control system
In order to assure the proper function
of the emission control systems, it
is recommended that you have your
car inspected and maintained by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer in
accordance with the maintenance
schedule in this manual.
1. Crankcase emission control
system
The positive crankcase ventilation
system is employed to prevent air
pollution caused by blow-by gases
being emitted from the crankcase. This
system supplies fresh filtered air to the
crankcase through the air intake hose.
Inside the crankcase, the fresh air mixes
with blow-by gases, which then pass
through the PCV valve into the induction
system.
2. Evaporative emission control
system
The Evaporative Emission Control
System is designed to prevent
fuel vapors from escaping into the
atmosphere.
Canister
Fuel vapors generated inside the fuel
tank are absorbed and stored in the
onboard canister. When the engine is
running, the fuel vapors absorbed in
the canister are drawn into the surge
tank through the purge control solenoid
valve.
Purge Control Solenoid Valve
(PCSV)
The purge control solenoid valve
is controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM); when the engine coolant
temperature is low during idling, the
PCSV closes so that evaporated fuel
is not taken into the engine. After
the engine warms up during ordinary
driving, the PCSV opens to introduce
evaporated fuel to the engine.
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
9-89
09
3. Exhaust emission control
system
The Exhaust Emission Control System is
a highly effective system which controls
exhaust emissions while maintaining
good vehicle performance.
Engine exhaust gas precautions
(carbon monoxide)
Carbon monoxide can be present with
other exhaust fumes. Therefore, if
you smell exhaust fumes of any kind
inside your vehicle, have it inspected
and repaired immediately. If you ever
suspect exhaust fumes are coming
into your vehicle, drive it only with
all the windows fully open. Have
your vehicle checked and repaired
immediately.
WARNING
Exhaust
Engine exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide (CO). Though colorless
and odorless, it is dangerous and
could be lethal if inhaled. Follow the
instructions on this page to avoid CO
poisoning.
Do not operate the engine in confined
or closed areas (such as garages) any
more than what is necessary to move
the vehicle in or out of the area.
When the vehicle is stopped in an
open area for more than a short time
with the engine running, adjust the
ventilation system (as needed) to draw
outside air into the vehicle.
Never sit in a parked or stopped
vehicle for any extended time with the
engine running.
When the engine stalls or fails to
start, excessive attempts to restart
the engine may cause damage to the
emission control system.
9-90
Maintenance
Operating precautions for catalytic
converters (if equipped)
WARNING
Fire
A hot exhaust system can ignite
flammable items under your vehicle.
Do not park, idle, or drive the vehicle
over or near flammable objects, such
as grass, vegetation, paper, leaves,
etc.
The exhaust system and catalytic
system are very hot while the engine
is running or immediately after the
engine is turned off. Keep away from
the exhaust system and catalytic, you
may get burned. Also, do not remove
the heat sink around the exhaust
system, do not seal the bottom of the
vehicle or do not coat the vehicle for
corrosion control. It may present a
fire risk under certain conditions.
Your vehicle is equipped with a catalytic
converter emission control device.
Therefore, the following precautions
must be observed:
Use only UNLEADED FUEL for gasoline
engine.
Do not operate the vehicle when
there are signs of engine malfunction,
such as misfire or a noticeable loss of
performance.
Do not misuse or abuse the engine.
Examples of misuse are coasting with
the ignition off and descending steep
grades in gear with the ignition off.
Do not operate the engine at high idle
speed for extended periods (5 minutes
or more).
Do not modify or tamper with any
part of the engine or emission
control system. All inspections and
adjustments must be made by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level. Running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire, damaging
the catalytic converter.
Failure to observe these precautions
could result in damage to the catalytic
converter and to your vehicle.
Additionally, such actions could void
your warranties.
9-91
09
Gasoline particulate filter (GPF)
(if equipped)
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)
systemremoves the soot in the exhaust
gas.The GPF system automatically
burns (or oxidizes) the accumulated
soot in accordance with driving
situations, unlike a disposable air filter.
In other words, the accumulated soot is
automatically purged out by the engine
control system and by the high exhaust
gas temperature at normal/ high driving
speeds.However, when the vehicle is
continually driven at repeated short
distances or driven at low speed for a
long time, the accumulated soot may
not be automatically removed because
of low exhaust gas temperature. In this
case, the accumulated soot may reach
a certain amount regardless of the
soot oxidization process, then the GPF
lamp ( ) will illuminate.The Gasoline
Particulate Filter (GPF)lamp stops
illuminating, when the driving speed
exceeds 80 km/h (50 mph) with engine
RPM 1,500 ~ 4,000 and the gear in the
3rd position or above for approximately
30 minutes.When the GPF lamp starts
to blink or the warning message “Check
exhaust system” pops up even though
the vehicle was driven as mentioned
above, we recommend that you have the
GPF system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.With GPF lamp blinking
for an extended period of time, it may
damage the GPF system and lower the
fuel economy.
CAUTION
We recommend you to use only the
regulated gasoline fuels, when your
vehicle is equipped with the GPF
system.When you use other gasoline
fuels which contain unspecified
additives, they may damage the GPF
system and cause exhaust emission
problems.
9-92
Maintenance
376

Hulp nodig? Stel uw vraag in het forum

Spelregels

Misbruik melden

Gebruikershandleiding.com neemt misbruik van zijn services uitermate serieus. U kunt hieronder aangeven waarom deze vraag ongepast is. Wij controleren de vraag en zonodig wordt deze verwijderd.

Product:

Bijvoorbeeld antisemitische inhoud, racistische inhoud, of materiaal dat gewelddadige fysieke handelingen tot gevolg kan hebben.

Bijvoorbeeld een creditcardnummer, een persoonlijk identificatienummer, of een geheim adres. E-mailadressen en volledige namen worden niet als privégegevens beschouwd.

Spelregels forum

Om tot zinvolle vragen te komen hanteren wij de volgende spelregels:

Belangrijk! Als er een antwoord wordt gegeven op uw vraag, dan is het voor de gever van het antwoord nuttig om te weten als u er wel (of niet) mee geholpen bent! Wij vragen u dus ook te reageren op een antwoord.

Belangrijk! Antwoorden worden ook per e-mail naar abonnees gestuurd. Laat uw emailadres achter op deze site, zodat u op de hoogte blijft. U krijgt dan ook andere vragen en antwoorden te zien.

Abonneren

Abonneer u voor het ontvangen van emails voor uw Hyundai Aura 2023 bij:


U ontvangt een email met instructies om u voor één of beide opties in te schrijven.


Ontvang uw handleiding per email

Vul uw emailadres in en ontvang de handleiding van Hyundai Aura 2023 in de taal/talen: Engels als bijlage per email.

De handleiding is 4.97 mb groot.

 

U ontvangt de handleiding per email binnen enkele minuten. Als u geen email heeft ontvangen, dan heeft u waarschijnlijk een verkeerd emailadres ingevuld of is uw mailbox te vol. Daarnaast kan het zijn dat uw internetprovider een maximum heeft aan de grootte per email. Omdat hier een handleiding wordt meegestuurd, kan het voorkomen dat de email groter is dan toegestaan bij uw provider.

Stel vragen via chat aan uw handleiding

Stel uw vraag over deze PDF

Uw handleiding is per email verstuurd. Controleer uw email

Als u niet binnen een kwartier uw email met handleiding ontvangen heeft, kan het zijn dat u een verkeerd emailadres heeft ingevuld of dat uw emailprovider een maximum grootte per email heeft ingesteld die kleiner is dan de grootte van de handleiding.

Er is een email naar u verstuurd om uw inschrijving definitief te maken.

Controleer uw email en volg de aanwijzingen op om uw inschrijving definitief te maken

U heeft geen emailadres opgegeven

Als u de handleiding per email wilt ontvangen, vul dan een geldig emailadres in.

Uw vraag is op deze pagina toegevoegd

Wilt u een email ontvangen bij een antwoord en/of nieuwe vragen? Vul dan hier uw emailadres in.



Info